| \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- |
| @c %**start of header |
| @setfilename gmp.info |
| @documentencoding ISO-8859-1 |
| @include version.texi |
| @settitle GNU MP @value{VERSION} |
| @synindex tp fn |
| @iftex |
| @afourpaper |
| @end iftex |
| @comment %**end of header |
| |
| @copying |
| This manual describes how to install and use the GNU multiple precision |
| arithmetic library, version @value{VERSION}. |
| |
| Copyright 1991, 1993-2016, 2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
| |
| Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under |
| the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later |
| version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, |
| with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual'', and with the Back-Cover |
| Texts being ``You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU |
| software''. A copy of the license is included in |
| @ref{GNU Free Documentation License}. |
| @end copying |
| @c Note the @ref above must be on one line, a line break in an @ref within |
| @c @copying will bomb in recent texinfo.tex (eg. 2004-04-07.08 which comes |
| @c with texinfo 4.7), with messages about missing @endcsname. |
| |
| |
| @c Texinfo version 4.2 or up will be needed to process this file. |
| @c |
| @c The version number and edition number are taken from version.texi provided |
| @c by automake (note that it's regenerated only if you configure with |
| @c --enable-maintainer-mode). |
| @c |
| @c Notes discussing the present version number of GMP in relation to previous |
| @c ones (for instance in the "Compatibility" section) must be updated at |
| @c manually though. |
| @c |
| @c @cindex entries have been made for function categories and programming |
| @c topics. The "mpn" section is not included in this, because a beginner |
| @c looking for "GCD" or something is only going to be confused by pointers to |
| @c low level routines. |
| @c |
| @c @cindex entries are present for processors and systems when there's |
| @c particular notes concerning them, but not just for everything GMP |
| @c supports. |
| @c |
| @c Index entries for files use @code rather than @file, @samp or @option, |
| @c since the latter come out with quotes in TeX, which are nice in the text |
| @c but don't look so good in index columns. |
| @c |
| @c Tex: |
| @c |
| @c A suitable texinfo.tex is supplied, a newer one should work equally well. |
| @c |
| @c HTML: |
| @c |
| @c Nothing special is done for links to external manuals, they just come out |
| @c in the usual makeinfo style, eg. "../libc/Locales.html". If you have |
| @c local copies of such manuals then this is a good thing, if not then you |
| @c may want to search-and-replace to some online source. |
| @c |
| |
| @dircategory GNU libraries |
| @direntry |
| * gmp: (gmp). GNU Multiple Precision Arithmetic Library. |
| @end direntry |
| |
| @c html <meta name="description" content="..."> |
| @documentdescription |
| How to install and use the GNU multiple precision arithmetic library, version @value{VERSION}. |
| @end documentdescription |
| |
| @c smallbook |
| @finalout |
| @setchapternewpage on |
| |
| @ifnottex |
| @node Top, Copying, (dir), (dir) |
| @top GNU MP |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @iftex |
| @titlepage |
| @title GNU MP |
| @subtitle The GNU Multiple Precision Arithmetic Library |
| @subtitle Edition @value{EDITION} |
| @subtitle @value{UPDATED} |
| |
| @author by Torbj@"orn Granlund and the GMP development team |
| @c @email{tg@@gmplib.org} |
| |
| @c Include the Distribution inside the titlepage so |
| @c that headings are turned off. |
| |
| @tex |
| \global\parindent=0pt |
| \global\parskip=8pt |
| \global\baselineskip=13pt |
| @end tex |
| |
| @page |
| @vskip 0pt plus 1filll |
| @end iftex |
| |
| @insertcopying |
| @ifnottex |
| @sp 1 |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @iftex |
| @end titlepage |
| @headings double |
| @end iftex |
| |
| @c Don't bother with contents for html, the menus seem adequate. |
| @ifnothtml |
| @contents |
| @end ifnothtml |
| |
| @menu |
| * Copying:: GMP Copying Conditions (LGPL). |
| * Introduction to GMP:: Brief introduction to GNU MP. |
| * Installing GMP:: How to configure and compile the GMP library. |
| * GMP Basics:: What every GMP user should know. |
| * Reporting Bugs:: How to usefully report bugs. |
| * Integer Functions:: Functions for arithmetic on signed integers. |
| * Rational Number Functions:: Functions for arithmetic on rational numbers. |
| * Floating-point Functions:: Functions for arithmetic on floats. |
| * Low-level Functions:: Fast functions for natural numbers. |
| * Random Number Functions:: Functions for generating random numbers. |
| * Formatted Output:: @code{printf} style output. |
| * Formatted Input:: @code{scanf} style input. |
| * C++ Class Interface:: Class wrappers around GMP types. |
| * Custom Allocation:: How to customize the internal allocation. |
| * Language Bindings:: Using GMP from other languages. |
| * Algorithms:: What happens behind the scenes. |
| * Internals:: How values are represented behind the scenes. |
| |
| * Contributors:: Who brings you this library? |
| * References:: Some useful papers and books to read. |
| * GNU Free Documentation License:: |
| * Concept Index:: |
| * Function Index:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @c @m{T,N} is $T$ in tex or @math{N} otherwise. Commas in N or T don't work, |
| @c but @C{} can be used instead. |
| @iftex |
| @macro m {T,N} |
| @tex$\T\$@end tex |
| @end macro |
| @end iftex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro m {T,N} |
| @math{\N\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c @mm{T,N} is $T$ tex and html and @math{N} in info. Commas in N or T don't |
| @c work, but @C{} can be used instead. |
| @iftex |
| @macro mm {T,N} |
| @tex$\T\$@end tex |
| @end macro |
| @end iftex |
| |
| @ifhtml |
| @macro mm {T,N} |
| @math{\T\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifhtml |
| |
| @ifinfo |
| @macro mm {T,N} |
| @math{\N\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifinfo |
| |
| |
| @macro C {} |
| , |
| @end macro |
| |
| @c @ms{V,N} is $V_N$ in tex or just vn otherwise. This suits simple |
| @c subscripts like @ms{x,0}. |
| @iftex |
| @macro ms {V,N} |
| @tex$\V\_{\N\}$@end tex |
| @end macro |
| @end iftex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro ms {V,N} |
| \V\\N\ |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c @nicode{S} is plain S in info, or @code{S} elsewhere. This can be used |
| @c when the quotes that @code{} gives in info aren't wanted, but the |
| @c fontification in tex or html is wanted. Doesn't work as @nicode{'\\0'} |
| @c though (gives two backslashes in tex). |
| @ifinfo |
| @macro nicode {S} |
| \S\ |
| @end macro |
| @end ifinfo |
| @ifnotinfo |
| @macro nicode {S} |
| @code{\S\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnotinfo |
| |
| @c @nisamp{S} is plain S in info, or @samp{S} elsewhere. This can be used |
| @c when the quotes that @samp{} gives in info aren't wanted, but the |
| @c fontification in tex or html is wanted. |
| @ifinfo |
| @macro nisamp {S} |
| \S\ |
| @end macro |
| @end ifinfo |
| @ifnotinfo |
| @macro nisamp {S} |
| @samp{\S\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnotinfo |
| |
| @c Usage: @GMPtimes{} |
| @c Give either \times or the word "times". |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPtimes{\times} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro GMPtimes |
| times |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @GMPmultiply{} |
| @c Give * in info, or nothing in tex. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPmultiply{} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro GMPmultiply |
| * |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @GMPabs{x} |
| @c Give either |x| in tex, or abs(x) in info or html. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPabs#1{|#1|} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro GMPabs {X} |
| @abs{}(\X\) |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @GMPfloor{x} |
| @c Give either \lfloor x\rfloor in tex, or floor(x) in info or html. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPfloor#1{\lfloor #1\rfloor} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro GMPfloor {X} |
| floor(\X\) |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @GMPceil{x} |
| @c Give either \lceil x\rceil in tex, or ceil(x) in info or html. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPceil#1{\lceil #1 \rceil} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro GMPceil {X} |
| ceil(\X\) |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Math operators already available in tex, made available in info too. |
| @c For example @bmod{} can be used in both tex and info. |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro bmod |
| mod |
| @end macro |
| @macro gcd |
| gcd |
| @end macro |
| @macro ge |
| >= |
| @end macro |
| @macro le |
| <= |
| @end macro |
| @macro log |
| log |
| @end macro |
| @macro min |
| min |
| @end macro |
| @macro leftarrow |
| <- |
| @end macro |
| @macro rightarrow |
| -> |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c New math operators. |
| @c @abs{} can be used in both tex and info, or just \abs in tex. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\abs{\mathop{\rm abs}} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro abs |
| abs |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c @cross{} is a \times symbol in tex, or an "x" in info. In tex it works |
| @c inside or outside $ $. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\cross{\ifmmode\times\else$\times$\fi} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro cross |
| x |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c @times{} made available as a "*" in info and html (already works in tex). |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro times |
| * |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @W{text} |
| @c Like @w{} but working in math mode too. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\W#1{\ifmmode{#1}\else\w{#1}\fi} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro W {S} |
| @w{\S\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: \GMPdisplay{text} |
| @c Put the given text in an @display style indent, but without turning off |
| @c paragraph reflow etc. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPdisplay#1{% |
| \noindent |
| \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
| #1\par} |
| @end tex |
| |
| @c Usage: \GMPhat |
| @c A new \hat that will work in math mode, unlike the texinfo redefined |
| @c version. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPhat{\mathaccent"705E} |
| @end tex |
| |
| @c Usage: \GMPraise{text} |
| @c For use in a $ $ math expression as an alternative to "^". This is good |
| @c for @code{} in an exponent, since there seems to be no superscript font |
| @c for that. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\GMPraise#1{\mskip0.5\thinmuskip\hbox{\raise0.8ex\hbox{#1}}} |
| @end tex |
| |
| @c Usage: @texlinebreak{} |
| @c A line break as per @*, but only in tex. |
| @iftex |
| @macro texlinebreak |
| @* |
| @end macro |
| @end iftex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro texlinebreak |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @maybepagebreak |
| @c Allow tex to insert a page break, if it feels the urge. |
| @c Normally blocks of @deftypefun/funx are kept together, which can lead to |
| @c some poor page break positioning if it's a big block, like the sets of |
| @c division functions etc. |
| @tex |
| \gdef\maybepagebreak{\penalty0} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro maybepagebreak |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @c Usage: @GMPreftop{info,title} |
| @c Usage: @GMPpxreftop{info,title} |
| @c |
| @c Like @ref{} and @pxref{}, but designed for a reference to the top of a |
| @c document, not a particular section. The TeX output for plain @ref insists |
| @c on printing a particular section, GMPreftop gives just the title. |
| @c |
| @c The texinfo manual recommends putting a likely section name in references |
| @c like this, eg. "Introduction", but it seems better to just give the title. |
| @c |
| @iftex |
| @macro GMPreftop{info,title} |
| @i{\title\} |
| @end macro |
| @macro GMPpxreftop{info,title} |
| see @i{\title\} |
| @end macro |
| @end iftex |
| @c |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro GMPreftop{info,title} |
| @ref{Top,\title\,\title\,\info\,\title\} |
| @end macro |
| @macro GMPpxreftop{info,title} |
| @pxref{Top,\title\,\title\,\info\,\title\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| |
| @node Copying, Introduction to GMP, Top, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @unnumbered GNU MP Copying Conditions |
| @cindex Copying conditions |
| @cindex Conditions for copying GNU MP |
| @cindex License conditions |
| |
| This library is @dfn{free}; this means that everyone is free to use it and |
| free to redistribute it on a free basis. The library is not in the public |
| domain; it is copyrighted and there are restrictions on its distribution, but |
| these restrictions are designed to permit everything that a good cooperating |
| citizen would want to do. What is not allowed is to try to prevent others |
| from further sharing any version of this library that they might get from |
| you.@refill |
| |
| Specifically, we want to make sure that you have the right to give away copies |
| of the library, that you receive source code or else can get it if you want |
| it, that you can change this library or use pieces of it in new free programs, |
| and that you know you can do these things.@refill |
| |
| To make sure that everyone has such rights, we have to forbid you to deprive |
| anyone else of these rights. For example, if you distribute copies of the GNU |
| MP library, you must give the recipients all the rights that you have. You |
| must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you |
| must tell them their rights.@refill |
| |
| Also, for our own protection, we must make certain that everyone finds out |
| that there is no warranty for the GNU MP library. If it is modified by |
| someone else and passed on, we want their recipients to know that what they |
| have is not what we distributed, so that any problems introduced by others |
| will not reflect on our reputation.@refill |
| |
| More precisely, the GNU MP library is dual licensed, under the conditions of |
| the GNU Lesser General Public License version 3 (see |
| @file{COPYING.LESSERv3}), or the GNU General Public License version 2 (see |
| @file{COPYINGv2}). This is the recipient's choice, and the recipient also has |
| the additional option of applying later versions of these licenses. (The |
| reason for this dual licensing is to make it possible to use the library with |
| programs which are licensed under GPL version 2, but which for historical or |
| other reasons do not allow use under later versions of the GPL). |
| |
| Programs which are not part of the library itself, such as demonstration |
| programs and the GMP testsuite, are licensed under the terms of the GNU |
| General Public License version 3 (see @file{COPYINGv3}), or any later |
| version. |
| |
| |
| @node Introduction to GMP, Installing GMP, Copying, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Introduction to GNU MP |
| @cindex Introduction |
| |
| GNU MP is a portable library written in C for arbitrary precision arithmetic |
| on integers, rational numbers, and floating-point numbers. It aims to provide |
| the fastest possible arithmetic for all applications that need higher |
| precision than is directly supported by the basic C types. |
| |
| Many applications use just a few hundred bits of precision; but some |
| applications may need thousands or even millions of bits. GMP is designed to |
| give good performance for both, by choosing algorithms based on the sizes of |
| the operands, and by carefully keeping the overhead at a minimum. |
| |
| The speed of GMP is achieved by using fullwords as the basic arithmetic type, |
| by using sophisticated algorithms, by including carefully optimized assembly |
| code for the most common inner loops for many different CPUs, and by a general |
| emphasis on speed (as opposed to simplicity or elegance). |
| |
| There is assembly code for these CPUs: |
| @cindex CPU types |
| ARM Cortex-A9, Cortex-A15, and generic ARM, |
| DEC Alpha 21064, 21164, and 21264, |
| AMD K8 and K10 (sold under many brands, e.g. Athlon64, Phenom, Opteron) |
| Bulldozer, and Bobcat, |
| Intel Pentium, Pentium Pro/II/III, Pentium 4, Core2, Nehalem, Sandy bridge, Haswell, generic x86, |
| Intel IA-64, |
| Motorola/IBM PowerPC 32 and 64 such as POWER970, POWER5, POWER6, and POWER7, |
| MIPS 32-bit and 64-bit, |
| SPARC 32-bit ad 64-bit with special support for all UltraSPARC models. |
| There is also assembly code for many obsolete CPUs. |
| |
| |
| @cindex Home page |
| @cindex Web page |
| @noindent |
| For up-to-date information on GMP, please see the GMP web pages at |
| |
| @display |
| @uref{https://gmplib.org/} |
| @end display |
| |
| @cindex Latest version of GMP |
| @cindex Anonymous FTP of latest version |
| @cindex FTP of latest version |
| @noindent |
| The latest version of the library is available at |
| |
| @display |
| @uref{https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/gmp/} |
| @end display |
| |
| Many sites around the world mirror @samp{ftp.gnu.org}, please use a mirror |
| near you, see @uref{https://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html} for a full list. |
| |
| @cindex Mailing lists |
| There are three public mailing lists of interest. One for release |
| announcements, one for general questions and discussions about usage of the GMP |
| library and one for bug reports. For more information, see |
| |
| @display |
| @uref{https://gmplib.org/mailman/listinfo/}. |
| @end display |
| |
| The proper place for bug reports is @email{gmp-bugs@@gmplib.org}. See |
| @ref{Reporting Bugs} for information about reporting bugs. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @section How to use this Manual |
| @cindex About this manual |
| |
| Everyone should read @ref{GMP Basics}. If you need to install the library |
| yourself, then read @ref{Installing GMP}. If you have a system with multiple |
| ABIs, then read @ref{ABI and ISA}, for the compiler options that must be used |
| on applications. |
| |
| The rest of the manual can be used for later reference, although it is |
| probably a good idea to glance through it. |
| |
| |
| @node Installing GMP, GMP Basics, Introduction to GMP, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Installing GMP |
| @cindex Installing GMP |
| @cindex Configuring GMP |
| @cindex Building GMP |
| |
| GMP has an autoconf/automake/libtool based configuration system. On a |
| Unix-like system a basic build can be done with |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure |
| make |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| Some self-tests can be run with |
| |
| @example |
| make check |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| And you can install (under @file{/usr/local} by default) with |
| |
| @example |
| make install |
| @end example |
| |
| If you experience problems, please report them to @email{gmp-bugs@@gmplib.org}. |
| See @ref{Reporting Bugs}, for information on what to include in useful bug |
| reports. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Build Options:: |
| * ABI and ISA:: |
| * Notes for Package Builds:: |
| * Notes for Particular Systems:: |
| * Known Build Problems:: |
| * Performance optimization:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Build Options, ABI and ISA, Installing GMP, Installing GMP |
| @section Build Options |
| @cindex Build options |
| |
| All the usual autoconf configure options are available, run @samp{./configure |
| --help} for a summary. The file @file{INSTALL.autoconf} has some generic |
| installation information too. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item Tools |
| @cindex Non-Unix systems |
| @samp{configure} requires various Unix-like tools. See @ref{Notes for |
| Particular Systems}, for some options on non-Unix systems. |
| |
| It might be possible to build without the help of @samp{configure}, certainly |
| all the code is there, but unfortunately you'll be on your own. |
| |
| @item Build Directory |
| @cindex Build directory |
| To compile in a separate build directory, @command{cd} to that directory, and |
| prefix the configure command with the path to the GMP source directory. For |
| example |
| |
| @example |
| cd /my/build/dir |
| /my/sources/gmp-@value{VERSION}/configure |
| @end example |
| |
| Not all @samp{make} programs have the necessary features (@code{VPATH}) to |
| support this. In particular, SunOS and Slowaris @command{make} have bugs that |
| make them unable to build in a separate directory. Use GNU @command{make} |
| instead. |
| |
| @item @option{--prefix} and @option{--exec-prefix} |
| @cindex Prefix |
| @cindex Exec prefix |
| @cindex Install prefix |
| @cindex @code{--prefix} |
| @cindex @code{--exec-prefix} |
| The @option{--prefix} option can be used in the normal way to direct GMP to |
| install under a particular tree. The default is @samp{/usr/local}. |
| |
| @option{--exec-prefix} can be used to direct architecture-dependent files like |
| @file{libgmp.a} to a different location. This can be used to share |
| architecture-independent parts like the documentation, but separate the |
| dependent parts. Note however that @file{gmp.h} is |
| architecture-dependent since it encodes certain aspects of @file{libgmp}, so |
| it will be necessary to ensure both @file{$prefix/include} and |
| @file{$exec_prefix/include} are available to the compiler. |
| |
| @item @option{--disable-shared}, @option{--disable-static} |
| @cindex @code{--disable-shared} |
| @cindex @code{--disable-static} |
| By default both shared and static libraries are built (where possible), but |
| one or other can be disabled. Shared libraries result in smaller executables |
| and permit code sharing between separate running processes, but on some CPUs |
| are slightly slower, having a small cost on each function call. |
| |
| @item Native Compilation, @option{--build=CPU-VENDOR-OS} |
| @cindex Native compilation |
| @cindex Build system |
| @cindex @code{--build} |
| For normal native compilation, the system can be specified with |
| @samp{--build}. By default @samp{./configure} uses the output from running |
| @samp{./config.guess}. On some systems @samp{./config.guess} can determine |
| the exact CPU type, on others it will be necessary to give it explicitly. For |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --build=ultrasparc-sun-solaris2.7 |
| @end example |
| |
| In all cases the @samp{OS} part is important, since it controls how libtool |
| generates shared libraries. Running @samp{./config.guess} is the simplest way |
| to see what it should be, if you don't know already. |
| |
| @item Cross Compilation, @option{--host=CPU-VENDOR-OS} |
| @cindex Cross compiling |
| @cindex Host system |
| @cindex @code{--host} |
| When cross-compiling, the system used for compiling is given by @samp{--build} |
| and the system where the library will run is given by @samp{--host}. For |
| example when using a FreeBSD Athlon system to build GNU/Linux m68k binaries, |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --build=athlon-pc-freebsd3.5 --host=m68k-mac-linux-gnu |
| @end example |
| |
| Compiler tools are sought first with the host system type as a prefix. For |
| example @command{m68k-mac-linux-gnu-ranlib} is tried, then plain |
| @command{ranlib}. This makes it possible for a set of cross-compiling tools |
| to co-exist with native tools. The prefix is the argument to @samp{--host}, |
| and this can be an alias, such as @samp{m68k-linux}. But note that tools |
| don't have to be setup this way, it's enough to just have a @env{PATH} with a |
| suitable cross-compiling @command{cc} etc. |
| |
| Compiling for a different CPU in the same family as the build system is a form |
| of cross-compilation, though very possibly this would merely be special |
| options on a native compiler. In any case @samp{./configure} avoids depending |
| on being able to run code on the build system, which is important when |
| creating binaries for a newer CPU since they very possibly won't run on the |
| build system. |
| |
| In all cases the compiler must be able to produce an executable (of whatever |
| format) from a standard C @code{main}. Although only object files will go to |
| make up @file{libgmp}, @samp{./configure} uses linking tests for various |
| purposes, such as determining what functions are available on the host system. |
| |
| Currently a warning is given unless an explicit @samp{--build} is used when |
| cross-compiling, because it may not be possible to correctly guess the build |
| system type if the @env{PATH} has only a cross-compiling @command{cc}. |
| |
| Note that the @samp{--target} option is not appropriate for GMP@. It's for use |
| when building compiler tools, with @samp{--host} being where they will run, |
| and @samp{--target} what they'll produce code for. Ordinary programs or |
| libraries like GMP are only interested in the @samp{--host} part, being where |
| they'll run. (Some past versions of GMP used @samp{--target} incorrectly.) |
| |
| @item CPU types |
| @cindex CPU types |
| In general, if you want a library that runs as fast as possible, you should |
| configure GMP for the exact CPU type your system uses. However, this may mean |
| the binaries won't run on older members of the family, and might run slower on |
| other members, older or newer. The best idea is always to build GMP for the |
| exact machine type you intend to run it on. |
| |
| The following CPUs have specific support. See @file{configure.ac} for details |
| of what code and compiler options they select. |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| |
| @c Keep this formatting, it's easy to read and it can be grepped to |
| @c automatically test that CPUs listed get through ./config.sub |
| |
| @item |
| Alpha: |
| @nisamp{alpha}, |
| @nisamp{alphaev5}, |
| @nisamp{alphaev56}, |
| @nisamp{alphapca56}, |
| @nisamp{alphapca57}, |
| @nisamp{alphaev6}, |
| @nisamp{alphaev67}, |
| @nisamp{alphaev68} |
| @nisamp{alphaev7} |
| |
| @item |
| Cray: |
| @nisamp{c90}, |
| @nisamp{j90}, |
| @nisamp{t90}, |
| @nisamp{sv1} |
| |
| @item |
| HPPA: |
| @nisamp{hppa1.0}, |
| @nisamp{hppa1.1}, |
| @nisamp{hppa2.0}, |
| @nisamp{hppa2.0n}, |
| @nisamp{hppa2.0w}, |
| @nisamp{hppa64} |
| |
| @item |
| IA-64: |
| @nisamp{ia64}, |
| @nisamp{itanium}, |
| @nisamp{itanium2} |
| |
| @item |
| MIPS: |
| @nisamp{mips}, |
| @nisamp{mips3}, |
| @nisamp{mips64} |
| |
| @item |
| Motorola: |
| @nisamp{m68k}, |
| @nisamp{m68000}, |
| @nisamp{m68010}, |
| @nisamp{m68020}, |
| @nisamp{m68030}, |
| @nisamp{m68040}, |
| @nisamp{m68060}, |
| @nisamp{m68302}, |
| @nisamp{m68360}, |
| @nisamp{m88k}, |
| @nisamp{m88110} |
| |
| @item |
| POWER: |
| @nisamp{power}, |
| @nisamp{power1}, |
| @nisamp{power2}, |
| @nisamp{power2sc} |
| |
| @item |
| PowerPC: |
| @nisamp{powerpc}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc64}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc401}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc403}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc405}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc505}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc601}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc602}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc603}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc603e}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc604}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc604e}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc620}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc630}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc740}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc7400}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc7450}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc750}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc801}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc821}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc823}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc860}, |
| @nisamp{powerpc970} |
| |
| @item |
| SPARC: |
| @nisamp{sparc}, |
| @nisamp{sparcv8}, |
| @nisamp{microsparc}, |
| @nisamp{supersparc}, |
| @nisamp{sparcv9}, |
| @nisamp{ultrasparc}, |
| @nisamp{ultrasparc2}, |
| @nisamp{ultrasparc2i}, |
| @nisamp{ultrasparc3}, |
| @nisamp{sparc64} |
| |
| @item |
| x86 family: |
| @nisamp{i386}, |
| @nisamp{i486}, |
| @nisamp{i586}, |
| @nisamp{pentium}, |
| @nisamp{pentiummmx}, |
| @nisamp{pentiumpro}, |
| @nisamp{pentium2}, |
| @nisamp{pentium3}, |
| @nisamp{pentium4}, |
| @nisamp{k6}, |
| @nisamp{k62}, |
| @nisamp{k63}, |
| @nisamp{athlon}, |
| @nisamp{amd64}, |
| @nisamp{viac3}, |
| @nisamp{viac32} |
| |
| @item |
| Other: |
| @nisamp{arm}, |
| @nisamp{sh}, |
| @nisamp{sh2}, |
| @nisamp{vax}, |
| @end itemize |
| |
| CPUs not listed will use generic C code. |
| |
| @item Generic C Build |
| @cindex Generic C |
| If some of the assembly code causes problems, or if otherwise desired, the |
| generic C code can be selected with the configure @option{--disable-assembly}. |
| |
| Note that this will run quite slowly, but it should be portable and should at |
| least make it possible to get something running if all else fails. |
| |
| @item Fat binary, @option{--enable-fat} |
| @cindex Fat binary |
| @cindex @code{--enable-fat} |
| Using @option{--enable-fat} selects a ``fat binary'' build on x86, where |
| optimized low level subroutines are chosen at runtime according to the CPU |
| detected. This means more code, but gives good performance on all x86 chips. |
| (This option might become available for more architectures in the future.) |
| |
| @item @option{ABI} |
| @cindex ABI |
| On some systems GMP supports multiple ABIs (application binary interfaces), |
| meaning data type sizes and calling conventions. By default GMP chooses the |
| best ABI available, but a particular ABI can be selected. For example |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --host=mips64-sgi-irix6 ABI=n32 |
| @end example |
| |
| See @ref{ABI and ISA}, for the available choices on relevant CPUs, and what |
| applications need to do. |
| |
| @item @option{CC}, @option{CFLAGS} |
| @cindex C compiler |
| @cindex @code{CC} |
| @cindex @code{CFLAGS} |
| By default the C compiler used is chosen from among some likely candidates, |
| with @command{gcc} normally preferred if it's present. The usual |
| @samp{CC=whatever} can be passed to @samp{./configure} to choose something |
| different. |
| |
| For various systems, default compiler flags are set based on the CPU and |
| compiler. The usual @samp{CFLAGS="-whatever"} can be passed to |
| @samp{./configure} to use something different or to set good flags for systems |
| GMP doesn't otherwise know. |
| |
| The @samp{CC} and @samp{CFLAGS} used are printed during @samp{./configure}, |
| and can be found in each generated @file{Makefile}. This is the easiest way |
| to check the defaults when considering changing or adding something. |
| |
| Note that when @samp{CC} and @samp{CFLAGS} are specified on a system |
| supporting multiple ABIs it's important to give an explicit |
| @samp{ABI=whatever}, since GMP can't determine the ABI just from the flags and |
| won't be able to select the correct assembly code. |
| |
| If just @samp{CC} is selected then normal default @samp{CFLAGS} for that |
| compiler will be used (if GMP recognises it). For example @samp{CC=gcc} can |
| be used to force the use of GCC, with default flags (and default ABI). |
| |
| @item @option{CPPFLAGS} |
| @cindex @code{CPPFLAGS} |
| Any flags like @samp{-D} defines or @samp{-I} includes required by the |
| preprocessor should be set in @samp{CPPFLAGS} rather than @samp{CFLAGS}. |
| Compiling is done with both @samp{CPPFLAGS} and @samp{CFLAGS}, but |
| preprocessing uses just @samp{CPPFLAGS}. This distinction is because most |
| preprocessors won't accept all the flags the compiler does. Preprocessing is |
| done separately in some configure tests. |
| |
| @item @option{CC_FOR_BUILD} |
| @cindex @code{CC_FOR_BUILD} |
| Some build-time programs are compiled and run to generate host-specific data |
| tables. @samp{CC_FOR_BUILD} is the compiler used for this. It doesn't need |
| to be in any particular ABI or mode, it merely needs to generate executables |
| that can run. The default is to try the selected @samp{CC} and some likely |
| candidates such as @samp{cc} and @samp{gcc}, looking for something that works. |
| |
| No flags are used with @samp{CC_FOR_BUILD} because a simple invocation like |
| @samp{cc foo.c} should be enough. If some particular options are required |
| they can be included as for instance @samp{CC_FOR_BUILD="cc -whatever"}. |
| |
| @item C++ Support, @option{--enable-cxx} |
| @cindex C++ support |
| @cindex @code{--enable-cxx} |
| C++ support in GMP can be enabled with @samp{--enable-cxx}, in which case a |
| C++ compiler will be required. As a convenience @samp{--enable-cxx=detect} |
| can be used to enable C++ support only if a compiler can be found. The C++ |
| support consists of a library @file{libgmpxx.la} and header file |
| @file{gmpxx.h} (@pxref{Headers and Libraries}). |
| |
| A separate @file{libgmpxx.la} has been adopted rather than having C++ objects |
| within @file{libgmp.la} in order to ensure dynamic linked C programs aren't |
| bloated by a dependency on the C++ standard library, and to avoid any chance |
| that the C++ compiler could be required when linking plain C programs. |
| |
| @file{libgmpxx.la} will use certain internals from @file{libgmp.la} and can |
| only be expected to work with @file{libgmp.la} from the same GMP version. |
| Future changes to the relevant internals will be accompanied by renaming, so a |
| mismatch will cause unresolved symbols rather than perhaps mysterious |
| misbehaviour. |
| |
| In general @file{libgmpxx.la} will be usable only with the C++ compiler that |
| built it, since name mangling and runtime support are usually incompatible |
| between different compilers. |
| |
| @item @option{CXX}, @option{CXXFLAGS} |
| @cindex C++ compiler |
| @cindex @code{CXX} |
| @cindex @code{CXXFLAGS} |
| When C++ support is enabled, the C++ compiler and its flags can be set with |
| variables @samp{CXX} and @samp{CXXFLAGS} in the usual way. The default for |
| @samp{CXX} is the first compiler that works from a list of likely candidates, |
| with @command{g++} normally preferred when available. The default for |
| @samp{CXXFLAGS} is to try @samp{CFLAGS}, @samp{CFLAGS} without @samp{-g}, then |
| for @command{g++} either @samp{-g -O2} or @samp{-O2}, or for other compilers |
| @samp{-g} or nothing. Trying @samp{CFLAGS} this way is convenient when using |
| @samp{gcc} and @samp{g++} together, since the flags for @samp{gcc} will |
| usually suit @samp{g++}. |
| |
| It's important that the C and C++ compilers match, meaning their startup and |
| runtime support routines are compatible and that they generate code in the |
| same ABI (if there's a choice of ABIs on the system). @samp{./configure} |
| isn't currently able to check these things very well itself, so for that |
| reason @samp{--disable-cxx} is the default, to avoid a build failure due to a |
| compiler mismatch. Perhaps this will change in the future. |
| |
| Incidentally, it's normally not good enough to set @samp{CXX} to the same as |
| @samp{CC}. Although @command{gcc} for instance recognises @file{foo.cc} as |
| C++ code, only @command{g++} will invoke the linker the right way when |
| building an executable or shared library from C++ object files. |
| |
| @item Temporary Memory, @option{--enable-alloca=<choice>} |
| @cindex Temporary memory |
| @cindex Stack overflow |
| @cindex @code{alloca} |
| @cindex @code{--enable-alloca} |
| GMP allocates temporary workspace using one of the following three methods, |
| which can be selected with for instance |
| @samp{--enable-alloca=malloc-reentrant}. |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| @samp{alloca} - C library or compiler builtin. |
| @item |
| @samp{malloc-reentrant} - the heap, in a re-entrant fashion. |
| @item |
| @samp{malloc-notreentrant} - the heap, with global variables. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| For convenience, the following choices are also available. |
| @samp{--disable-alloca} is the same as @samp{no}. |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| @samp{yes} - a synonym for @samp{alloca}. |
| @item |
| @samp{no} - a synonym for @samp{malloc-reentrant}. |
| @item |
| @samp{reentrant} - @code{alloca} if available, otherwise |
| @samp{malloc-reentrant}. This is the default. |
| @item |
| @samp{notreentrant} - @code{alloca} if available, otherwise |
| @samp{malloc-notreentrant}. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @code{alloca} is reentrant and fast, and is recommended. It actually allocates |
| just small blocks on the stack; larger ones use malloc-reentrant. |
| |
| @samp{malloc-reentrant} is, as the name suggests, reentrant and thread safe, |
| but @samp{malloc-notreentrant} is faster and should be used if reentrancy is |
| not required. |
| |
| The two malloc methods in fact use the memory allocation functions selected by |
| @code{mp_set_memory_functions}, these being @code{malloc} and friends by |
| default. @xref{Custom Allocation}. |
| |
| An additional choice @samp{--enable-alloca=debug} is available, to help when |
| debugging memory related problems (@pxref{Debugging}). |
| |
| @item FFT Multiplication, @option{--disable-fft} |
| @cindex FFT multiplication |
| @cindex @code{--disable-fft} |
| By default multiplications are done using Karatsuba, 3-way Toom, higher degree |
| Toom, and Fermat FFT@. The FFT is only used on large to very large operands |
| and can be disabled to save code size if desired. |
| |
| @item Assertion Checking, @option{--enable-assert} |
| @cindex Assertion checking |
| @cindex @code{--enable-assert} |
| This option enables some consistency checking within the library. This can be |
| of use while debugging, @pxref{Debugging}. |
| |
| @item Execution Profiling, @option{--enable-profiling=prof/gprof/instrument} |
| @cindex Execution profiling |
| @cindex @code{--enable-profiling} |
| Enable profiling support, in one of various styles, @pxref{Profiling}. |
| |
| @item @option{MPN_PATH} |
| @cindex @code{MPN_PATH} |
| Various assembly versions of each mpn subroutines are provided. For a given |
| CPU, a search is made though a path to choose a version of each. For example |
| @samp{sparcv8} has |
| |
| @example |
| MPN_PATH="sparc32/v8 sparc32 generic" |
| @end example |
| |
| which means look first for v8 code, then plain sparc32 (which is v7), and |
| finally fall back on generic C@. Knowledgeable users with special requirements |
| can specify a different path. Normally this is completely unnecessary. |
| |
| @item Documentation |
| @cindex Documentation formats |
| @cindex Texinfo |
| The source for the document you're now reading is @file{doc/gmp.texi}, in |
| Texinfo format, see @GMPreftop{texinfo, Texinfo}. |
| |
| @cindex Postscript |
| @cindex DVI |
| @cindex PDF |
| Info format @samp{doc/gmp.info} is included in the distribution. The usual |
| automake targets are available to make PostScript, DVI, PDF and HTML (these |
| will require various @TeX{} and Texinfo tools). |
| |
| @cindex DocBook |
| @cindex XML |
| DocBook and XML can be generated by the Texinfo @command{makeinfo} program |
| too, see @ref{makeinfo options,, Options for @command{makeinfo}, texinfo, |
| Texinfo}. |
| |
| Some supplementary notes can also be found in the @file{doc} subdirectory. |
| |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node ABI and ISA, Notes for Package Builds, Build Options, Installing GMP |
| @section ABI and ISA |
| @cindex ABI |
| @cindex Application Binary Interface |
| @cindex ISA |
| @cindex Instruction Set Architecture |
| |
| ABI (Application Binary Interface) refers to the calling conventions between |
| functions, meaning what registers are used and what sizes the various C data |
| types are. ISA (Instruction Set Architecture) refers to the instructions and |
| registers a CPU has available. |
| |
| Some 64-bit ISA CPUs have both a 64-bit ABI and a 32-bit ABI defined, the |
| latter for compatibility with older CPUs in the family. GMP supports some |
| CPUs like this in both ABIs. In fact within GMP @samp{ABI} means a |
| combination of chip ABI, plus how GMP chooses to use it. For example in some |
| 32-bit ABIs, GMP may support a limb as either a 32-bit @code{long} or a 64-bit |
| @code{long long}. |
| |
| By default GMP chooses the best ABI available for a given system, and this |
| generally gives significantly greater speed. But an ABI can be chosen |
| explicitly to make GMP compatible with other libraries, or particular |
| application requirements. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure ABI=32 |
| @end example |
| |
| In all cases it's vital that all object code used in a given program is |
| compiled for the same ABI. |
| |
| Usually a limb is implemented as a @code{long}. When a @code{long long} limb |
| is used this is encoded in the generated @file{gmp.h}. This is convenient for |
| applications, but it does mean that @file{gmp.h} will vary, and can't be just |
| copied around. @file{gmp.h} remains compiler independent though, since all |
| compilers for a particular ABI will be expected to use the same limb type. |
| |
| Currently no attempt is made to follow whatever conventions a system has for |
| installing library or header files built for a particular ABI@. This will |
| probably only matter when installing multiple builds of GMP, and it might be |
| as simple as configuring with a special @samp{libdir}, or it might require |
| more than that. Note that builds for different ABIs need to done separately, |
| with a fresh @command{./configure} and @command{make} each. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @table @asis |
| @need 1000 |
| @item AMD64 (@samp{x86_64}) |
| @cindex AMD64 |
| On AMD64 systems supporting both 32-bit and 64-bit modes for applications, the |
| following ABI choices are available. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{ABI=64} |
| The 64-bit ABI uses 64-bit limbs and pointers and makes full use of the chip |
| architecture. This is the default. Applications will usually not need |
| special compiler flags, but for reference the option is |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -m64 |
| @end example |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=32} |
| The 32-bit ABI is the usual i386 conventions. This will be slower, and is not |
| recommended except for inter-operating with other code not yet 64-bit capable. |
| Applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -m32 |
| @end example |
| |
| (In GCC 2.95 and earlier there's no @samp{-m32} option, it's the only mode.) |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=x32} |
| The x32 ABI uses 64-bit limbs but 32-bit pointers. Like the 64-bit ABI, it |
| makes full use of the chip's arithmetic capabilities. This ABI is not |
| supported by all operating systems. |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -mx32 |
| @end example |
| |
| @end table |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @need 1000 |
| @item HPPA 2.0 (@samp{hppa2.0*}, @samp{hppa64}) |
| @cindex HPPA |
| @cindex HP-UX |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{ABI=2.0w} |
| The 2.0w ABI uses 64-bit limbs and pointers and is available on HP-UX 11 or |
| up. Applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc [built for 2.0w] |
| cc +DD64 |
| @end example |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=2.0n} |
| The 2.0n ABI means the 32-bit HPPA 1.0 ABI and all its normal calling |
| conventions, but with 64-bit instructions permitted within functions. GMP |
| uses a 64-bit @code{long long} for a limb. This ABI is available on hppa64 |
| GNU/Linux and on HP-UX 10 or higher. Applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc [built for 2.0n] |
| cc +DA2.0 +e |
| @end example |
| |
| Note that current versions of GCC (eg.@: 3.2) don't generate 64-bit |
| instructions for @code{long long} operations and so may be slower than for |
| 2.0w. (The GMP assembly code is the same though.) |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=1.0} |
| HPPA 2.0 CPUs can run all HPPA 1.0 and 1.1 code in the 32-bit HPPA 1.0 ABI@. |
| No special compiler options are needed for applications. |
| @end table |
| |
| All three ABIs are available for CPU types @samp{hppa2.0w}, @samp{hppa2.0} and |
| @samp{hppa64}, but for CPU type @samp{hppa2.0n} only 2.0n or 1.0 are |
| considered. |
| |
| Note that GCC on HP-UX has no options to choose between 2.0n and 2.0w modes, |
| unlike HP @command{cc}. Instead it must be built for one or the other ABI@. |
| GMP will detect how it was built, and skip to the corresponding @samp{ABI}. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @need 1500 |
| @item IA-64 under HP-UX (@samp{ia64*-*-hpux*}, @samp{itanium*-*-hpux*}) |
| @cindex IA-64 |
| @cindex HP-UX |
| HP-UX supports two ABIs for IA-64. GMP performance is the same in both. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{ABI=32} |
| In the 32-bit ABI, pointers, @code{int}s and @code{long}s are 32 bits and GMP |
| uses a 64 bit @code{long long} for a limb. Applications can be compiled |
| without any special flags since this ABI is the default in both HP C and GCC, |
| but for reference the flags are |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -milp32 |
| cc +DD32 |
| @end example |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=64} |
| In the 64-bit ABI, @code{long}s and pointers are 64 bits and GMP uses a |
| @code{long} for a limb. Applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -mlp64 |
| cc +DD64 |
| @end example |
| @end table |
| |
| On other IA-64 systems, GNU/Linux for instance, @samp{ABI=64} is the only |
| choice. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @need 1000 |
| @item MIPS under IRIX 6 (@samp{mips*-*-irix[6789]}) |
| @cindex MIPS |
| @cindex IRIX |
| IRIX 6 always has a 64-bit MIPS 3 or better CPU, and supports ABIs o32, n32, |
| and 64. n32 or 64 are recommended, and GMP performance will be the same in |
| each. The default is n32. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{ABI=o32} |
| The o32 ABI is 32-bit pointers and integers, and no 64-bit operations. GMP |
| will be slower than in n32 or 64, this option only exists to support old |
| compilers, eg.@: GCC 2.7.2. Applications can be compiled with no special |
| flags on an old compiler, or on a newer compiler with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -mabi=32 |
| cc -32 |
| @end example |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=n32} |
| The n32 ABI is 32-bit pointers and integers, but with a 64-bit limb using a |
| @code{long long}. Applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -mabi=n32 |
| cc -n32 |
| @end example |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=64} |
| The 64-bit ABI is 64-bit pointers and integers. Applications must be compiled |
| with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -mabi=64 |
| cc -64 |
| @end example |
| @end table |
| |
| Note that MIPS GNU/Linux, as of kernel version 2.2, doesn't have the necessary |
| support for n32 or 64 and so only gets a 32-bit limb and the MIPS 2 code. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @need 1000 |
| @item PowerPC 64 (@samp{powerpc64}, @samp{powerpc620}, @samp{powerpc630}, @samp{powerpc970}, @samp{power4}, @samp{power5}) |
| @cindex PowerPC |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{ABI=mode64} |
| @cindex AIX |
| The AIX 64 ABI uses 64-bit limbs and pointers and is the default on PowerPC 64 |
| @samp{*-*-aix*} systems. Applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -maix64 |
| xlc -q64 |
| @end example |
| |
| On 64-bit GNU/Linux, BSD, and Mac OS X/Darwin systems, the applications must |
| be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -m64 |
| @end example |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=mode32} |
| The @samp{mode32} ABI uses a 64-bit @code{long long} limb but with the chip |
| still in 32-bit mode and using 32-bit calling conventions. This is the default |
| for systems where the true 64-bit ABI is unavailable. No special compiler |
| options are typically needed for applications. This ABI is not available under |
| AIX. |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=32} |
| This is the basic 32-bit PowerPC ABI, with a 32-bit limb. No special compiler |
| options are needed for applications. |
| @end table |
| |
| GMP's speed is greatest for the @samp{mode64} ABI, the @samp{mode32} ABI is 2nd |
| best. In @samp{ABI=32} only the 32-bit ISA is used and this doesn't make full |
| use of a 64-bit chip. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @need 1000 |
| @item Sparc V9 (@samp{sparc64}, @samp{sparcv9}, @samp{ultrasparc*}) |
| @cindex Sparc V9 |
| @cindex Solaris |
| @cindex Sun |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{ABI=64} |
| The 64-bit V9 ABI is available on the various BSD sparc64 ports, recent |
| versions of Sparc64 GNU/Linux, and Solaris 2.7 and up (when the kernel is in |
| 64-bit mode). GCC 3.2 or higher, or Sun @command{cc} is required. On |
| GNU/Linux, depending on the default @command{gcc} mode, applications must be |
| compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -m64 |
| @end example |
| |
| On Solaris applications must be compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -m64 -mptr64 -Wa,-xarch=v9 -mcpu=v9 |
| cc -xarch=v9 |
| @end example |
| |
| On the BSD sparc64 systems no special options are required, since 64-bits is |
| the only ABI available. |
| |
| @item @samp{ABI=32} |
| For the basic 32-bit ABI, GMP still uses as much of the V9 ISA as it can. In |
| the Sun documentation this combination is known as ``v8plus''. On GNU/Linux, |
| depending on the default @command{gcc} mode, applications may need to be |
| compiled with |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -m32 |
| @end example |
| |
| On Solaris, no special compiler options are required for applications, though |
| using something like the following is recommended. (@command{gcc} 2.8 and |
| earlier only support @samp{-mv8} though.) |
| |
| @example |
| gcc -mv8plus |
| cc -xarch=v8plus |
| @end example |
| @end table |
| |
| GMP speed is greatest in @samp{ABI=64}, so it's the default where available. |
| The speed is partly because there are extra registers available and partly |
| because 64-bits is considered the more important case and has therefore had |
| better code written for it. |
| |
| Don't be confused by the names of the @samp{-m} and @samp{-x} compiler |
| options, they're called @samp{arch} but effectively control both ABI and ISA@. |
| |
| On Solaris 2.6 and earlier, only @samp{ABI=32} is available since the kernel |
| doesn't save all registers. |
| |
| On Solaris 2.7 with the kernel in 32-bit mode, a normal native build will |
| reject @samp{ABI=64} because the resulting executables won't run. |
| @samp{ABI=64} can still be built if desired by making it look like a |
| cross-compile, for example |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --build=none --host=sparcv9-sun-solaris2.7 ABI=64 |
| @end example |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Notes for Package Builds, Notes for Particular Systems, ABI and ISA, Installing GMP |
| @section Notes for Package Builds |
| @cindex Build notes for binary packaging |
| @cindex Packaged builds |
| |
| GMP should present no great difficulties for packaging in a binary |
| distribution. |
| |
| @cindex Libtool versioning |
| @cindex Shared library versioning |
| Libtool is used to build the library and @samp{-version-info} is set |
| appropriately, having started from @samp{3:0:0} in GMP 3.0 (@pxref{Versioning, |
| Library interface versions, Library interface versions, libtool, GNU |
| Libtool}). |
| |
| The GMP 4 series will be upwardly binary compatible in each release and will |
| be upwardly binary compatible with all of the GMP 3 series. Additional |
| function interfaces may be added in each release, so on systems where libtool |
| versioning is not fully checked by the loader an auxiliary mechanism may be |
| needed to express that a dynamic linked application depends on a new enough |
| GMP. |
| |
| An auxiliary mechanism may also be needed to express that @file{libgmpxx.la} |
| (from @option{--enable-cxx}, @pxref{Build Options}) requires @file{libgmp.la} |
| from the same GMP version, since this is not done by the libtool versioning, |
| nor otherwise. A mismatch will result in unresolved symbols from the linker, |
| or perhaps the loader. |
| |
| When building a package for a CPU family, care should be taken to use |
| @samp{--host} (or @samp{--build}) to choose the least common denominator among |
| the CPUs which might use the package. For example this might mean plain |
| @samp{sparc} (meaning V7) for SPARCs. |
| |
| For x86s, @option{--enable-fat} sets things up for a fat binary build, making a |
| runtime selection of optimized low level routines. This is a good choice for |
| packaging to run on a range of x86 chips. |
| |
| Users who care about speed will want GMP built for their exact CPU type, to |
| make best use of the available optimizations. Providing a way to suitably |
| rebuild a package may be useful. This could be as simple as making it |
| possible for a user to omit @samp{--build} (and @samp{--host}) so |
| @samp{./config.guess} will detect the CPU@. But a way to manually specify a |
| @samp{--build} will be wanted for systems where @samp{./config.guess} is |
| inexact. |
| |
| On systems with multiple ABIs, a packaged build will need to decide which |
| among the choices is to be provided, see @ref{ABI and ISA}. A given run of |
| @samp{./configure} etc will only build one ABI@. If a second ABI is also |
| required then a second run of @samp{./configure} etc must be made, starting |
| from a clean directory tree (@samp{make distclean}). |
| |
| As noted under ``ABI and ISA'', currently no attempt is made to follow system |
| conventions for install locations that vary with ABI, such as |
| @file{/usr/lib/sparcv9} for @samp{ABI=64} as opposed to @file{/usr/lib} for |
| @samp{ABI=32}. A package build can override @samp{libdir} and other standard |
| variables as necessary. |
| |
| Note that @file{gmp.h} is a generated file, and will be architecture and ABI |
| dependent. When attempting to install two ABIs simultaneously it will be |
| important that an application compile gets the correct @file{gmp.h} for its |
| desired ABI@. If compiler include paths don't vary with ABI options then it |
| might be necessary to create a @file{/usr/include/gmp.h} which tests |
| preprocessor symbols and chooses the correct actual @file{gmp.h}. |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Notes for Particular Systems, Known Build Problems, Notes for Package Builds, Installing GMP |
| @section Notes for Particular Systems |
| @cindex Build notes for particular systems |
| @cindex Particular systems |
| @cindex Systems |
| @table @asis |
| |
| @c This section is more or less meant for notes about performance or about |
| @c build problems that have been worked around but might leave a user |
| @c scratching their head. Fun with different ABIs on a system belongs in the |
| @c above section. |
| |
| @item AIX 3 and 4 |
| @cindex AIX |
| On systems @samp{*-*-aix[34]*} shared libraries are disabled by default, since |
| some versions of the native @command{ar} fail on the convenience libraries |
| used. A shared build can be attempted with |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --enable-shared --disable-static |
| @end example |
| |
| Note that the @samp{--disable-static} is necessary because in a shared build |
| libtool makes @file{libgmp.a} a symlink to @file{libgmp.so}, apparently for |
| the benefit of old versions of @command{ld} which only recognise @file{.a}, |
| but unfortunately this is done even if a fully functional @command{ld} is |
| available. |
| |
| @item ARM |
| @cindex ARM |
| On systems @samp{arm*-*-*}, versions of GCC up to and including 2.95.3 have a |
| bug in unsigned division, giving wrong results for some operands. GMP |
| @samp{./configure} will demand GCC 2.95.4 or later. |
| |
| @item Compaq C++ |
| @cindex Compaq C++ |
| Compaq C++ on OSF 5.1 has two flavours of @code{iostream}, a standard one and |
| an old pre-standard one (see @samp{man iostream_intro}). GMP can only use the |
| standard one, which unfortunately is not the default but must be selected by |
| defining @code{__USE_STD_IOSTREAM}. Configure with for instance |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --enable-cxx CPPFLAGS=-D__USE_STD_IOSTREAM |
| @end example |
| |
| @item Floating Point Mode |
| @cindex Floating point mode |
| @cindex Hardware floating point mode |
| @cindex Precision of hardware floating point |
| @cindex x87 |
| On some systems, the hardware floating point has a control mode which can set |
| all operations to be done in a particular precision, for instance single, |
| double or extended on x86 systems (x87 floating point). The GMP functions |
| involving a @code{double} cannot be expected to operate to their full |
| precision when the hardware is in single precision mode. Of course this |
| affects all code, including application code, not just GMP. |
| |
| @item FreeBSD 7.x, 8.x, 9.0, 9.1, 9.2 |
| @cindex FreeBSD |
| @command{m4} in these releases of FreeBSD has an eval function which ignores |
| its 2nd and 3rd arguments, which makes it unsuitable for @file{.asm} file |
| processing. @samp{./configure} will detect the problem and either abort or |
| choose another m4 in the @env{PATH}. The bug is fixed in FreeBSD 9.3 and 10.0, |
| so either upgrade or use GNU m4. Note that the FreeBSD package system installs |
| GNU m4 under the name @samp{gm4}, which GMP cannot guess. |
| |
| @item FreeBSD 7.x, 8.x, 9.x |
| @cindex FreeBSD |
| GMP releases starting with 6.0 do not support @samp{ABI=32} on FreeBSD/amd64 |
| prior to release 10.0 of the system. The cause is a broken @code{limits.h}, |
| which GMP no longer works around. |
| |
| @item MS-DOS and MS Windows |
| @cindex MS-DOS |
| @cindex MS Windows |
| @cindex Windows |
| @cindex Cygwin |
| @cindex DJGPP |
| @cindex MINGW |
| On an MS-DOS system DJGPP can be used to build GMP, and on an MS Windows |
| system Cygwin, DJGPP and MINGW can be used. All three are excellent ports of |
| GCC and the various GNU tools. |
| |
| @display |
| @uref{https://www.cygwin.com/} |
| @uref{http://www.delorie.com/djgpp/} |
| @uref{http://www.mingw.org/} |
| @end display |
| |
| @cindex Interix |
| @cindex Services for Unix |
| Microsoft also publishes an Interix ``Services for Unix'' which can be used to |
| build GMP on Windows (with a normal @samp{./configure}), but it's not free |
| software. |
| |
| @item MS Windows DLLs |
| @cindex DLLs |
| @cindex MS Windows |
| @cindex Windows |
| On systems @samp{*-*-cygwin*}, @samp{*-*-mingw*} and @samp{*-*-pw32*} by |
| default GMP builds only a static library, but a DLL can be built instead using |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --disable-static --enable-shared |
| @end example |
| |
| Static and DLL libraries can't both be built, since certain export directives |
| in @file{gmp.h} must be different. |
| |
| A MINGW DLL build of GMP can be used with Microsoft C@. Libtool doesn't |
| install a @file{.lib} format import library, but it can be created with MS |
| @command{lib} as follows, and copied to the install directory. Similarly for |
| @file{libmp} and @file{libgmpxx}. |
| |
| @example |
| cd .libs |
| lib /def:libgmp-3.dll.def /out:libgmp-3.lib |
| @end example |
| |
| MINGW uses the C runtime library @samp{msvcrt.dll} for I/O, so applications |
| wanting to use the GMP I/O routines must be compiled with @samp{cl /MD} to do |
| the same. If one of the other C runtime library choices provided by MS C is |
| desired then the suggestion is to use the GMP string functions and confine I/O |
| to the application. |
| |
| @item Motorola 68k CPU Types |
| @cindex 68000 |
| @samp{m68k} is taken to mean 68000. @samp{m68020} or higher will give a |
| performance boost on applicable CPUs. @samp{m68360} can be used for CPU32 |
| series chips. @samp{m68302} can be used for ``Dragonball'' series chips, |
| though this is merely a synonym for @samp{m68000}. |
| |
| @item NetBSD 5.x |
| @cindex NetBSD |
| @command{m4} in these releases of NetBSD has an eval function which ignores its |
| 2nd and 3rd arguments, which makes it unsuitable for @file{.asm} file |
| processing. @samp{./configure} will detect the problem and either abort or |
| choose another m4 in the @env{PATH}. The bug is fixed in NetBSD 6, so either |
| upgrade or use GNU m4. Note that the NetBSD package system installs GNU m4 |
| under the name @samp{gm4}, which GMP cannot guess. |
| |
| @item OpenBSD 2.6 |
| @cindex OpenBSD |
| @command{m4} in this release of OpenBSD has a bug in @code{eval} that makes it |
| unsuitable for @file{.asm} file processing. @samp{./configure} will detect |
| the problem and either abort or choose another m4 in the @env{PATH}. The bug |
| is fixed in OpenBSD 2.7, so either upgrade or use GNU m4. |
| |
| @item Power CPU Types |
| @cindex Power/PowerPC |
| In GMP, CPU types @samp{power*} and @samp{powerpc*} will each use instructions |
| not available on the other, so it's important to choose the right one for the |
| CPU that will be used. Currently GMP has no assembly code support for using |
| just the common instruction subset. To get executables that run on both, the |
| current suggestion is to use the generic C code (@option{--disable-assembly}), |
| possibly with appropriate compiler options (like @samp{-mcpu=common} for |
| @command{gcc}). CPU @samp{rs6000} (which is not a CPU but a family of |
| workstations) is accepted by @file{config.sub}, but is currently equivalent to |
| @option{--disable-assembly}. |
| |
| @item Sparc CPU Types |
| @cindex Sparc |
| @samp{sparcv8} or @samp{supersparc} on relevant systems will give a |
| significant performance increase over the V7 code selected by plain |
| @samp{sparc}. |
| |
| @item Sparc App Regs |
| @cindex Sparc |
| The GMP assembly code for both 32-bit and 64-bit Sparc clobbers the |
| ``application registers'' @code{g2}, @code{g3} and @code{g4}, the same way |
| that the GCC default @samp{-mapp-regs} does (@pxref{SPARC Options,, SPARC |
| Options, gcc, Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). |
| |
| This makes that code unsuitable for use with the special V9 |
| @samp{-mcmodel=embmedany} (which uses @code{g4} as a data segment pointer), and |
| for applications wanting to use those registers for special purposes. In these |
| cases the only suggestion currently is to build GMP with |
| @option{--disable-assembly} to avoid the assembly code. |
| |
| @item SunOS 4 |
| @cindex SunOS |
| @command{/usr/bin/m4} lacks various features needed to process @file{.asm} |
| files, and instead @samp{./configure} will automatically use |
| @command{/usr/5bin/m4}, which we believe is always available (if not then use |
| GNU m4). |
| |
| @item x86 CPU Types |
| @cindex x86 |
| @cindex 80x86 |
| @cindex i386 |
| @samp{i586}, @samp{pentium} or @samp{pentiummmx} code is good for its intended |
| P5 Pentium chips, but quite slow when run on Intel P6 class chips (PPro, P-II, |
| P-III)@. @samp{i386} is a better choice when making binaries that must run on |
| both. |
| |
| @item x86 MMX and SSE2 Code |
| @cindex MMX |
| @cindex SSE2 |
| If the CPU selected has MMX code but the assembler doesn't support it, a |
| warning is given and non-MMX code is used instead. This will be an inferior |
| build, since the MMX code that's present is there because it's faster than the |
| corresponding plain integer code. The same applies to SSE2. |
| |
| Old versions of @samp{gas} don't support MMX instructions, in particular |
| version 1.92.3 that comes with FreeBSD 2.2.8 or the more recent OpenBSD 3.1 |
| doesn't. |
| |
| Solaris 2.6 and 2.7 @command{as} generate incorrect object code for register |
| to register @code{movq} instructions, and so can't be used for MMX code. |
| Install a recent @command{gas} if MMX code is wanted on these systems. |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Known Build Problems, Performance optimization, Notes for Particular Systems, Installing GMP |
| @section Known Build Problems |
| @cindex Build problems known |
| |
| @c This section is more or less meant for known build problems that are not |
| @c otherwise worked around and require some sort of manual intervention. |
| |
| You might find more up-to-date information at @uref{https://gmplib.org/}. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item Compiler link options |
| The version of libtool currently in use rather aggressively strips compiler |
| options when linking a shared library. This will hopefully be relaxed in the |
| future, but for now if this is a problem the suggestion is to create a little |
| script to hide them, and for instance configure with |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure CC=gcc-with-my-options |
| @end example |
| |
| @item DJGPP (@samp{*-*-msdosdjgpp*}) |
| @cindex DJGPP |
| The DJGPP port of @command{bash} 2.03 is unable to run the @samp{configure} |
| script, it exits silently, having died writing a preamble to |
| @file{config.log}. Use @command{bash} 2.04 or higher. |
| |
| @samp{make all} was found to run out of memory during the final |
| @file{libgmp.la} link on one system tested, despite having 64Mb available. |
| Running @samp{make libgmp.la} directly helped, perhaps recursing into the |
| various subdirectories uses up memory. |
| |
| @item GNU binutils @command{strip} prior to 2.12 |
| @cindex Stripped libraries |
| @cindex Binutils @command{strip} |
| @cindex GNU @command{strip} |
| @command{strip} from GNU binutils 2.11 and earlier should not be used on the |
| static libraries @file{libgmp.a} and @file{libmp.a} since it will discard all |
| but the last of multiple archive members with the same name, like the three |
| versions of @file{init.o} in @file{libgmp.a}. Binutils 2.12 or higher can be |
| used successfully. |
| |
| The shared libraries @file{libgmp.so} and @file{libmp.so} are not affected by |
| this and any version of @command{strip} can be used on them. |
| |
| @item @command{make} syntax error |
| @cindex SCO |
| @cindex IRIX |
| On certain versions of SCO OpenServer 5 and IRIX 6.5 the native @command{make} |
| is unable to handle the long dependencies list for @file{libgmp.la}. The |
| symptom is a ``syntax error'' on the following line of the top-level |
| @file{Makefile}. |
| |
| @example |
| libgmp.la: $(libgmp_la_OBJECTS) $(libgmp_la_DEPENDENCIES) |
| @end example |
| |
| Either use GNU Make, or as a workaround remove |
| @code{$(libgmp_la_DEPENDENCIES)} from that line (which will make the initial |
| build work, but if any recompiling is done @file{libgmp.la} might not be |
| rebuilt). |
| |
| @item MacOS X (@samp{*-*-darwin*}) |
| @cindex MacOS X |
| @cindex Darwin |
| Libtool currently only knows how to create shared libraries on MacOS X using |
| the native @command{cc} (which is a modified GCC), not a plain GCC@. A |
| static-only build should work though (@samp{--disable-shared}). |
| |
| @item NeXT prior to 3.3 |
| @cindex NeXT |
| The system compiler on old versions of NeXT was a massacred and old GCC, even |
| if it called itself @file{cc}. This compiler cannot be used to build GMP, you |
| need to get a real GCC, and install that. (NeXT may have fixed this in |
| release 3.3 of their system.) |
| |
| @item POWER and PowerPC |
| @cindex Power/PowerPC |
| Bugs in GCC 2.7.2 (and 2.6.3) mean it can't be used to compile GMP on POWER or |
| PowerPC@. If you want to use GCC for these machines, get GCC 2.7.2.1 (or |
| later). |
| |
| @item Sequent Symmetry |
| @cindex Sequent Symmetry |
| Use the GNU assembler instead of the system assembler, since the latter has |
| serious bugs. |
| |
| @item Solaris 2.6 |
| @cindex Solaris |
| The system @command{sed} prints an error ``Output line too long'' when libtool |
| builds @file{libgmp.la}. This doesn't seem to cause any obvious ill effects, |
| but GNU @command{sed} is recommended, to avoid any doubt. |
| |
| @item Sparc Solaris 2.7 with gcc 2.95.2 in @samp{ABI=32} |
| @cindex Solaris |
| A shared library build of GMP seems to fail in this combination, it builds but |
| then fails the tests, apparently due to some incorrect data relocations within |
| @code{gmp_randinit_lc_2exp_size}. The exact cause is unknown, |
| @samp{--disable-shared} is recommended. |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Performance optimization, , Known Build Problems, Installing GMP |
| @section Performance optimization |
| @cindex Optimizing performance |
| |
| @c At some point, this should perhaps move to a separate chapter on optimizing |
| @c performance. |
| |
| For optimal performance, build GMP for the exact CPU type of the target |
| computer, see @ref{Build Options}. |
| |
| Unlike what is the case for most other programs, the compiler typically |
| doesn't matter much, since GMP uses assembly language for the most critical |
| operation. |
| |
| In particular for long-running GMP applications, and applications demanding |
| extremely large numbers, building and running the @code{tuneup} program in the |
| @file{tune} subdirectory, can be important. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| cd tune |
| make tuneup |
| ./tuneup |
| @end example |
| |
| will generate better contents for the @file{gmp-mparam.h} parameter file. |
| |
| To use the results, put the output in the file indicated in the |
| @samp{Parameters for ...} header. Then recompile from scratch. |
| |
| The @code{tuneup} program takes one useful parameter, @samp{-f NNN}, which |
| instructs the program how long to check FFT multiply parameters. If you're |
| going to use GMP for extremely large numbers, you may want to run @code{tuneup} |
| with a large NNN value. |
| |
| |
| @node GMP Basics, Reporting Bugs, Installing GMP, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter GMP Basics |
| @cindex Basics |
| |
| @strong{Using functions, macros, data types, etc.@: not documented in this |
| manual is strongly discouraged. If you do so your application is guaranteed |
| to be incompatible with future versions of GMP.} |
| |
| @menu |
| * Headers and Libraries:: |
| * Nomenclature and Types:: |
| * Function Classes:: |
| * Variable Conventions:: |
| * Parameter Conventions:: |
| * Memory Management:: |
| * Reentrancy:: |
| * Useful Macros and Constants:: |
| * Compatibility with older versions:: |
| * Demonstration Programs:: |
| * Efficiency:: |
| * Debugging:: |
| * Profiling:: |
| * Autoconf:: |
| * Emacs:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Headers and Libraries, Nomenclature and Types, GMP Basics, GMP Basics |
| @section Headers and Libraries |
| @cindex Headers |
| |
| @cindex @file{gmp.h} |
| @cindex Include files |
| @cindex @code{#include} |
| All declarations needed to use GMP are collected in the include file |
| @file{gmp.h}. It is designed to work with both C and C++ compilers. |
| |
| @example |
| #include <gmp.h> |
| @end example |
| |
| @cindex @code{stdio.h} |
| Note however that prototypes for GMP functions with @code{FILE *} parameters |
| are only provided if @code{<stdio.h>} is included too. |
| |
| @example |
| #include <stdio.h> |
| #include <gmp.h> |
| @end example |
| |
| @cindex @code{stdarg.h} |
| Likewise @code{<stdarg.h>} is required for prototypes with @code{va_list} |
| parameters, such as @code{gmp_vprintf}. And @code{<obstack.h>} for prototypes |
| with @code{struct obstack} parameters, such as @code{gmp_obstack_printf}, when |
| available. |
| |
| @cindex Libraries |
| @cindex Linking |
| @cindex @code{libgmp} |
| All programs using GMP must link against the @file{libgmp} library. On a |
| typical Unix-like system this can be done with @samp{-lgmp}, for example |
| |
| @example |
| gcc myprogram.c -lgmp |
| @end example |
| |
| @cindex @code{libgmpxx} |
| GMP C++ functions are in a separate @file{libgmpxx} library. This is built |
| and installed if C++ support has been enabled (@pxref{Build Options}). For |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| g++ mycxxprog.cc -lgmpxx -lgmp |
| @end example |
| |
| @cindex Libtool |
| GMP is built using Libtool and an application can use that to link if desired, |
| @GMPpxreftop{libtool, GNU Libtool}. |
| |
| If GMP has been installed to a non-standard location then it may be necessary |
| to use @samp{-I} and @samp{-L} compiler options to point to the right |
| directories, and some sort of run-time path for a shared library. |
| |
| |
| @node Nomenclature and Types, Function Classes, Headers and Libraries, GMP Basics |
| @section Nomenclature and Types |
| @cindex Nomenclature |
| @cindex Types |
| |
| @cindex Integer |
| @tindex @code{mpz_t} |
| In this manual, @dfn{integer} usually means a multiple precision integer, as |
| defined by the GMP library. The C data type for such integers is @code{mpz_t}. |
| Here are some examples of how to declare such integers: |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_t sum; |
| |
| struct foo @{ mpz_t x, y; @}; |
| |
| mpz_t vec[20]; |
| @end example |
| |
| @cindex Rational number |
| @tindex @code{mpq_t} |
| @dfn{Rational number} means a multiple precision fraction. The C data type |
| for these fractions is @code{mpq_t}. For example: |
| |
| @example |
| mpq_t quotient; |
| @end example |
| |
| @cindex Floating-point number |
| @tindex @code{mpf_t} |
| @dfn{Floating point number} or @dfn{Float} for short, is an arbitrary precision |
| mantissa with a limited precision exponent. The C data type for such objects |
| is @code{mpf_t}. For example: |
| |
| @example |
| mpf_t fp; |
| @end example |
| |
| @tindex @code{mp_exp_t} |
| The floating point functions accept and return exponents in the C type |
| @code{mp_exp_t}. Currently this is usually a @code{long}, but on some systems |
| it's an @code{int} for efficiency. |
| |
| @cindex Limb |
| @tindex @code{mp_limb_t} |
| A @dfn{limb} means the part of a multi-precision number that fits in a single |
| machine word. (We chose this word because a limb of the human body is |
| analogous to a digit, only larger, and containing several digits.) Normally a |
| limb is 32 or 64 bits. The C data type for a limb is @code{mp_limb_t}. |
| |
| @tindex @code{mp_size_t} |
| Counts of limbs of a multi-precision number represented in the C type |
| @code{mp_size_t}. Currently this is normally a @code{long}, but on some |
| systems it's an @code{int} for efficiency, and on some systems it will be |
| @code{long long} in the future. |
| |
| @tindex @code{mp_bitcnt_t} |
| Counts of bits of a multi-precision number are represented in the C type |
| @code{mp_bitcnt_t}. Currently this is always an @code{unsigned long}, but on |
| some systems it will be an @code{unsigned long long} in the future. |
| |
| @cindex Random state |
| @tindex @code{gmp_randstate_t} |
| @dfn{Random state} means an algorithm selection and current state data. The C |
| data type for such objects is @code{gmp_randstate_t}. For example: |
| |
| @example |
| gmp_randstate_t rstate; |
| @end example |
| |
| Also, in general @code{mp_bitcnt_t} is used for bit counts and ranges, and |
| @code{size_t} is used for byte or character counts. |
| |
| |
| @node Function Classes, Variable Conventions, Nomenclature and Types, GMP Basics |
| @section Function Classes |
| @cindex Function classes |
| |
| There are six classes of functions in the GMP library: |
| |
| @enumerate |
| @item |
| Functions for signed integer arithmetic, with names beginning with |
| @code{mpz_}. The associated type is @code{mpz_t}. There are about 150 |
| functions in this class. (@pxref{Integer Functions}) |
| |
| @item |
| Functions for rational number arithmetic, with names beginning with |
| @code{mpq_}. The associated type is @code{mpq_t}. There are about 35 |
| functions in this class, but the integer functions can be used for arithmetic |
| on the numerator and denominator separately. (@pxref{Rational Number |
| Functions}) |
| |
| @item |
| Functions for floating-point arithmetic, with names beginning with |
| @code{mpf_}. The associated type is @code{mpf_t}. There are about 70 |
| functions is this class. (@pxref{Floating-point Functions}) |
| |
| @item |
| Fast low-level functions that operate on natural numbers. These are used by |
| the functions in the preceding groups, and you can also call them directly |
| from very time-critical user programs. These functions' names begin with |
| @code{mpn_}. The associated type is array of @code{mp_limb_t}. There are |
| about 60 (hard-to-use) functions in this class. (@pxref{Low-level Functions}) |
| |
| @item |
| Miscellaneous functions. Functions for setting up custom allocation and |
| functions for generating random numbers. (@pxref{Custom Allocation}, and |
| @pxref{Random Number Functions}) |
| @end enumerate |
| |
| |
| @node Variable Conventions, Parameter Conventions, Function Classes, GMP Basics |
| @section Variable Conventions |
| @cindex Variable conventions |
| @cindex Conventions for variables |
| |
| GMP functions generally have output arguments before input arguments. This |
| notation is by analogy with the assignment operator. |
| |
| GMP lets you use the same variable for both input and output in one call. For |
| example, the main function for integer multiplication, @code{mpz_mul}, can be |
| used to square @code{x} and put the result back in @code{x} with |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_mul (x, x, x); |
| @end example |
| |
| Before you can assign to a GMP variable, you need to initialize it by calling |
| one of the special initialization functions. When you're done with a |
| variable, you need to clear it out, using one of the functions for that |
| purpose. Which function to use depends on the type of variable. See the |
| chapters on integer functions, rational number functions, and floating-point |
| functions for details. |
| |
| A variable should only be initialized once, or at least cleared between each |
| initialization. After a variable has been initialized, it may be assigned to |
| any number of times. |
| |
| For efficiency reasons, avoid excessive initializing and clearing. In |
| general, initialize near the start of a function and clear near the end. For |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| void |
| foo (void) |
| @{ |
| mpz_t n; |
| int i; |
| mpz_init (n); |
| for (i = 1; i < 100; i++) |
| @{ |
| mpz_mul (n, @dots{}); |
| mpz_fdiv_q (n, @dots{}); |
| @dots{} |
| @} |
| mpz_clear (n); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| GMP types like @code{mpz_t} are implemented as one-element arrays of certain |
| structures. Declaring a variable creates an object with the fields GMP needs, |
| but variables are normally manipulated by using the pointer to the object. For |
| both behavior and efficiency reasons, it is discouraged to make copies of the |
| GMP object itself (either directly or via aggregate objects containing such GMP |
| objects). If copies are done, all of them must be used read-only; using a copy |
| as the output of some function will invalidate all the other copies. Note that |
| the actual fields in each @code{mpz_t} etc are for internal use only and should |
| not be accessed directly by code that expects to be compatible with future GMP |
| releases. |
| |
| @node Parameter Conventions, Memory Management, Variable Conventions, GMP Basics |
| @section Parameter Conventions |
| @cindex Parameter conventions |
| @cindex Conventions for parameters |
| |
| When a GMP variable is used as a function parameter, it's effectively a |
| call-by-reference, meaning that when the function stores a value there it will |
| change the original in the caller. Parameters which are input-only can be |
| designated @code{const} to provoke a compiler error or warning on attempting to |
| modify them. |
| |
| When a function is going to return a GMP result, it should designate a |
| parameter that it sets, like the library functions do. More than one value |
| can be returned by having more than one output parameter, again like the |
| library functions. A @code{return} of an @code{mpz_t} etc doesn't return the |
| object, only a pointer, and this is almost certainly not what's wanted. |
| |
| Here's an example accepting an @code{mpz_t} parameter, doing a calculation, |
| and storing the result to the indicated parameter. |
| |
| @example |
| void |
| foo (mpz_t result, const mpz_t param, unsigned long n) |
| @{ |
| unsigned long i; |
| mpz_mul_ui (result, param, n); |
| for (i = 1; i < n; i++) |
| mpz_add_ui (result, result, i*7); |
| @} |
| |
| int |
| main (void) |
| @{ |
| mpz_t r, n; |
| mpz_init (r); |
| mpz_init_set_str (n, "123456", 0); |
| foo (r, n, 20L); |
| gmp_printf ("%Zd\n", r); |
| return 0; |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| Our function @code{foo} works even if its caller passes the same variable for |
| @code{param} and @code{result}, just like the library functions. But |
| sometimes it's tricky to make that work, and an application might not want to |
| bother supporting that sort of thing. |
| |
| Since GMP types are implemented as one-element arrays, using a GMP variable as |
| a parameter passes a pointer to the object. Hence the call-by-reference. |
| |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @node Memory Management, Reentrancy, Parameter Conventions, GMP Basics |
| @section Memory Management |
| @cindex Memory management |
| |
| The GMP types like @code{mpz_t} are small, containing only a couple of sizes, |
| and pointers to allocated data. Once a variable is initialized, GMP takes |
| care of all space allocation. Additional space is allocated whenever a |
| variable doesn't have enough. |
| |
| @code{mpz_t} and @code{mpq_t} variables never reduce their allocated space. |
| Normally this is the best policy, since it avoids frequent reallocation. |
| Applications that need to return memory to the heap at some particular point |
| can use @code{mpz_realloc2}, or clear variables no longer needed. |
| |
| @code{mpf_t} variables, in the current implementation, use a fixed amount of |
| space, determined by the chosen precision and allocated at initialization, so |
| their size doesn't change. |
| |
| All memory is allocated using @code{malloc} and friends by default, but this |
| can be changed, see @ref{Custom Allocation}. Temporary memory on the stack is |
| also used (via @code{alloca}), but this can be changed at build-time if |
| desired, see @ref{Build Options}. |
| |
| |
| @node Reentrancy, Useful Macros and Constants, Memory Management, GMP Basics |
| @section Reentrancy |
| @cindex Reentrancy |
| @cindex Thread safety |
| @cindex Multi-threading |
| |
| @noindent |
| GMP is reentrant and thread-safe, with some exceptions: |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| If configured with @option{--enable-alloca=malloc-notreentrant} (or with |
| @option{--enable-alloca=notreentrant} when @code{alloca} is not available), |
| then naturally GMP is not reentrant. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{mpf_set_default_prec} and @code{mpf_init} use a global variable for the |
| selected precision. @code{mpf_init2} can be used instead, and in the C++ |
| interface an explicit precision to the @code{mpf_class} constructor. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{mpz_random} and the other old random number functions use a global |
| random state and are hence not reentrant. The newer random number functions |
| that accept a @code{gmp_randstate_t} parameter can be used instead. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{gmp_randinit} (obsolete) returns an error indication through a global |
| variable, which is not thread safe. Applications are advised to use |
| @code{gmp_randinit_default} or @code{gmp_randinit_lc_2exp} instead. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{mp_set_memory_functions} uses global variables to store the selected |
| memory allocation functions. |
| |
| @item |
| If the memory allocation functions set by a call to |
| @code{mp_set_memory_functions} (or @code{malloc} and friends by default) are |
| not reentrant, then GMP will not be reentrant either. |
| |
| @item |
| If the standard I/O functions such as @code{fwrite} are not reentrant then the |
| GMP I/O functions using them will not be reentrant either. |
| |
| @item |
| It's safe for two threads to read from the same GMP variable simultaneously, |
| but it's not safe for one to read while another might be writing, nor for |
| two threads to write simultaneously. It's not safe for two threads to |
| generate a random number from the same @code{gmp_randstate_t} simultaneously, |
| since this involves an update of that variable. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Useful Macros and Constants, Compatibility with older versions, Reentrancy, GMP Basics |
| @section Useful Macros and Constants |
| @cindex Useful macros and constants |
| @cindex Constants |
| |
| @deftypevr {Global Constant} {const int} mp_bits_per_limb |
| @findex mp_bits_per_limb |
| @cindex Bits per limb |
| @cindex Limb size |
| The number of bits per limb. |
| @end deftypevr |
| |
| @defmac __GNU_MP_VERSION |
| @defmacx __GNU_MP_VERSION_MINOR |
| @defmacx __GNU_MP_VERSION_PATCHLEVEL |
| @cindex Version number |
| @cindex GMP version number |
| The major and minor GMP version, and patch level, respectively, as integers. |
| For GMP i.j, these numbers will be i, j, and 0, respectively. |
| For GMP i.j.k, these numbers will be i, j, and k, respectively. |
| @end defmac |
| |
| @deftypevr {Global Constant} {const char * const} gmp_version |
| @findex gmp_version |
| The GMP version number, as a null-terminated string, in the form ``i.j.k''. |
| This release is @nicode{"@value{VERSION}"}. Note that the format ``i.j'' was |
| used, before version 4.3.0, when k was zero. |
| @end deftypevr |
| |
| @defmac __GMP_CC |
| @defmacx __GMP_CFLAGS |
| The compiler and compiler flags, respectively, used when compiling GMP, as |
| strings. |
| @end defmac |
| |
| |
| @node Compatibility with older versions, Demonstration Programs, Useful Macros and Constants, GMP Basics |
| @section Compatibility with older versions |
| @cindex Compatibility with older versions |
| @cindex Past GMP versions |
| @cindex Upward compatibility |
| |
| This version of GMP is upwardly binary compatible with all 5.x, 4.x, and 3.x |
| versions, and upwardly compatible at the source level with all 2.x versions, |
| with the following exceptions. |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| @code{mpn_gcd} had its source arguments swapped as of GMP 3.0, for consistency |
| with other @code{mpn} functions. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{mpf_get_prec} counted precision slightly differently in GMP 3.0 and |
| 3.0.1, but in 3.1 reverted to the 2.x style. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{mpn_bdivmod}, documented as preliminary in GMP 4, has been removed. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| There are a number of compatibility issues between GMP 1 and GMP 2 that of |
| course also apply when porting applications from GMP 1 to GMP 5. Please |
| see the GMP 2 manual for details. |
| |
| @c @item Integer division functions round the result differently. The obsolete |
| @c functions (@code{mpz_div}, @code{mpz_divmod}, @code{mpz_mdiv}, |
| @c @code{mpz_mdivmod}, etc) now all use floor rounding (i.e., they round the |
| @c quotient towards |
| @c @ifinfo |
| @c @minus{}infinity). |
| @c @end ifinfo |
| @c @iftex |
| @c @tex |
| @c $-\infty$). |
| @c @end tex |
| @c @end iftex |
| @c There are a lot of functions for integer division, giving the user better |
| @c control over the rounding. |
| |
| @c @item The function @code{mpz_mod} now compute the true @strong{mod} function. |
| |
| @c @item The functions @code{mpz_powm} and @code{mpz_powm_ui} now use |
| @c @strong{mod} for reduction. |
| |
| @c @item The assignment functions for rational numbers do no longer canonicalize |
| @c their results. In the case a non-canonical result could arise from an |
| @c assignment, the user need to insert an explicit call to |
| @c @code{mpq_canonicalize}. This change was made for efficiency. |
| |
| @c @item Output generated by @code{mpz_out_raw} in this release cannot be read |
| @c by @code{mpz_inp_raw} in previous releases. This change was made for making |
| @c the file format truly portable between machines with different word sizes. |
| |
| @c @item Several @code{mpn} functions have changed. But they were intentionally |
| @c undocumented in previous releases. |
| |
| @c @item The functions @code{mpz_cmp_ui}, @code{mpz_cmp_si}, and @code{mpq_cmp_ui} |
| @c are now implemented as macros, and thereby sometimes evaluate their |
| @c arguments multiple times. |
| |
| @c @item The functions @code{mpz_pow_ui} and @code{mpz_ui_pow_ui} now yield 1 |
| @c for 0^0. (In version 1, they yielded 0.) |
| |
| @c In version 1 of the library, @code{mpq_set_den} handled negative |
| @c denominators by copying the sign to the numerator. That is no longer done. |
| |
| @c Pure assignment functions do not canonicalize the assigned variable. It is |
| @c the responsibility of the user to canonicalize the assigned variable before |
| @c any arithmetic operations are performed on that variable. |
| @c Note that this is an incompatible change from version 1 of the library. |
| |
| @c @end enumerate |
| |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @node Demonstration Programs, Efficiency, Compatibility with older versions, GMP Basics |
| @section Demonstration programs |
| @cindex Demonstration programs |
| @cindex Example programs |
| @cindex Sample programs |
| The @file{demos} subdirectory has some sample programs using GMP@. These |
| aren't built or installed, but there's a @file{Makefile} with rules for them. |
| For instance, |
| |
| @example |
| make pexpr |
| ./pexpr 68^975+10 |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| The following programs are provided |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| @cindex Expression parsing demo |
| @cindex Parsing expressions demo |
| @samp{pexpr} is an expression evaluator, the program used on the GMP web page. |
| @item |
| @cindex Expression parsing demo |
| @cindex Parsing expressions demo |
| The @samp{calc} subdirectory has a similar but simpler evaluator using |
| @command{lex} and @command{yacc}. |
| @item |
| @cindex Expression parsing demo |
| @cindex Parsing expressions demo |
| The @samp{expr} subdirectory is yet another expression evaluator, a library |
| designed for ease of use within a C program. See @file{demos/expr/README} for |
| more information. |
| @item |
| @cindex Factorization demo |
| @samp{factorize} is a Pollard-Rho factorization program. |
| @item |
| @samp{isprime} is a command-line interface to the @code{mpz_probab_prime_p} |
| function. |
| @item |
| @samp{primes} counts or lists primes in an interval, using a sieve. |
| @item |
| @samp{qcn} is an example use of @code{mpz_kronecker_ui} to estimate quadratic |
| class numbers. |
| @item |
| @cindex @code{perl} |
| @cindex GMP Perl module |
| @cindex Perl module |
| The @samp{perl} subdirectory is a comprehensive perl interface to GMP@. See |
| @file{demos/perl/INSTALL} for more information. Documentation is in POD |
| format in @file{demos/perl/GMP.pm}. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| As an aside, consideration has been given at various times to some sort of |
| expression evaluation within the main GMP library. Going beyond something |
| minimal quickly leads to matters like user-defined functions, looping, fixnums |
| for control variables, etc, which are considered outside the scope of GMP |
| (much closer to language interpreters or compilers, @xref{Language Bindings}.) |
| Something simple for program input convenience may yet be a possibility, a |
| combination of the @file{expr} demo and the @file{pexpr} tree back-end |
| perhaps. But for now the above evaluators are offered as illustrations. |
| |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @node Efficiency, Debugging, Demonstration Programs, GMP Basics |
| @section Efficiency |
| @cindex Efficiency |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item Small Operands |
| @cindex Small operands |
| On small operands, the time for function call overheads and memory allocation |
| can be significant in comparison to actual calculation. This is unavoidable |
| in a general purpose variable precision library, although GMP attempts to be |
| as efficient as it can on both large and small operands. |
| |
| @item Static Linking |
| @cindex Static linking |
| On some CPUs, in particular the x86s, the static @file{libgmp.a} should be |
| used for maximum speed, since the PIC code in the shared @file{libgmp.so} will |
| have a small overhead on each function call and global data address. For many |
| programs this will be insignificant, but for long calculations there's a gain |
| to be had. |
| |
| @item Initializing and Clearing |
| @cindex Initializing and clearing |
| Avoid excessive initializing and clearing of variables, since this can be |
| quite time consuming, especially in comparison to otherwise fast operations |
| like addition. |
| |
| A language interpreter might want to keep a free list or stack of |
| initialized variables ready for use. It should be possible to integrate |
| something like that with a garbage collector too. |
| |
| @item Reallocations |
| @cindex Reallocations |
| An @code{mpz_t} or @code{mpq_t} variable used to hold successively increasing |
| values will have its memory repeatedly @code{realloc}ed, which could be quite |
| slow or could fragment memory, depending on the C library. If an application |
| can estimate the final size then @code{mpz_init2} or @code{mpz_realloc2} can |
| be called to allocate the necessary space from the beginning |
| (@pxref{Initializing Integers}). |
| |
| It doesn't matter if a size set with @code{mpz_init2} or @code{mpz_realloc2} |
| is too small, since all functions will do a further reallocation if necessary. |
| Badly overestimating memory required will waste space though. |
| |
| @item @code{2exp} Functions |
| @cindex @code{2exp} functions |
| It's up to an application to call functions like @code{mpz_mul_2exp} when |
| appropriate. General purpose functions like @code{mpz_mul} make no attempt to |
| identify powers of two or other special forms, because such inputs will |
| usually be very rare and testing every time would be wasteful. |
| |
| @item @code{ui} and @code{si} Functions |
| @cindex @code{ui} and @code{si} functions |
| The @code{ui} functions and the small number of @code{si} functions exist for |
| convenience and should be used where applicable. But if for example an |
| @code{mpz_t} contains a value that fits in an @code{unsigned long} there's no |
| need extract it and call a @code{ui} function, just use the regular @code{mpz} |
| function. |
| |
| @item In-Place Operations |
| @cindex In-place operations |
| @code{mpz_abs}, @code{mpq_abs}, @code{mpf_abs}, @code{mpz_neg}, @code{mpq_neg} |
| and @code{mpf_neg} are fast when used for in-place operations like |
| @code{mpz_abs(x,x)}, since in the current implementation only a single field |
| of @code{x} needs changing. On suitable compilers (GCC for instance) this is |
| inlined too. |
| |
| @code{mpz_add_ui}, @code{mpz_sub_ui}, @code{mpf_add_ui} and @code{mpf_sub_ui} |
| benefit from an in-place operation like @code{mpz_add_ui(x,x,y)}, since |
| usually only one or two limbs of @code{x} will need to be changed. The same |
| applies to the full precision @code{mpz_add} etc if @code{y} is small. If |
| @code{y} is big then cache locality may be helped, but that's all. |
| |
| @code{mpz_mul} is currently the opposite, a separate destination is slightly |
| better. A call like @code{mpz_mul(x,x,y)} will, unless @code{y} is only one |
| limb, make a temporary copy of @code{x} before forming the result. Normally |
| that copying will only be a tiny fraction of the time for the multiply, so |
| this is not a particularly important consideration. |
| |
| @code{mpz_set}, @code{mpq_set}, @code{mpq_set_num}, @code{mpf_set}, etc, make |
| no attempt to recognise a copy of something to itself, so a call like |
| @code{mpz_set(x,x)} will be wasteful. Naturally that would never be written |
| deliberately, but if it might arise from two pointers to the same object then |
| a test to avoid it might be desirable. |
| |
| @example |
| if (x != y) |
| mpz_set (x, y); |
| @end example |
| |
| Note that it's never worth introducing extra @code{mpz_set} calls just to get |
| in-place operations. If a result should go to a particular variable then just |
| direct it there and let GMP take care of data movement. |
| |
| @item Divisibility Testing (Small Integers) |
| @cindex Divisibility testing |
| @code{mpz_divisible_ui_p} and @code{mpz_congruent_ui_p} are the best functions |
| for testing whether an @code{mpz_t} is divisible by an individual small |
| integer. They use an algorithm which is faster than @code{mpz_tdiv_ui}, but |
| which gives no useful information about the actual remainder, only whether |
| it's zero (or a particular value). |
| |
| However when testing divisibility by several small integers, it's best to take |
| a remainder modulo their product, to save multi-precision operations. For |
| instance to test whether a number is divisible by any of 23, 29 or 31 take a |
| remainder modulo @math{23@times{}29@times{}31 = 20677} and then test that. |
| |
| The division functions like @code{mpz_tdiv_q_ui} which give a quotient as well |
| as a remainder are generally a little slower than the remainder-only functions |
| like @code{mpz_tdiv_ui}. If the quotient is only rarely wanted then it's |
| probably best to just take a remainder and then go back and calculate the |
| quotient if and when it's wanted (@code{mpz_divexact_ui} can be used if the |
| remainder is zero). |
| |
| @item Rational Arithmetic |
| @cindex Rational arithmetic |
| The @code{mpq} functions operate on @code{mpq_t} values with no common factors |
| in the numerator and denominator. Common factors are checked-for and cast out |
| as necessary. In general, cancelling factors every time is the best approach |
| since it minimizes the sizes for subsequent operations. |
| |
| However, applications that know something about the factorization of the |
| values they're working with might be able to avoid some of the GCDs used for |
| canonicalization, or swap them for divisions. For example when multiplying by |
| a prime it's enough to check for factors of it in the denominator instead of |
| doing a full GCD@. Or when forming a big product it might be known that very |
| little cancellation will be possible, and so canonicalization can be left to |
| the end. |
| |
| The @code{mpq_numref} and @code{mpq_denref} macros give access to the |
| numerator and denominator to do things outside the scope of the supplied |
| @code{mpq} functions. @xref{Applying Integer Functions}. |
| |
| The canonical form for rationals allows mixed-type @code{mpq_t} and integer |
| additions or subtractions to be done directly with multiples of the |
| denominator. This will be somewhat faster than @code{mpq_add}. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| /* mpq increment */ |
| mpz_add (mpq_numref(q), mpq_numref(q), mpq_denref(q)); |
| |
| /* mpq += unsigned long */ |
| mpz_addmul_ui (mpq_numref(q), mpq_denref(q), 123UL); |
| |
| /* mpq -= mpz */ |
| mpz_submul (mpq_numref(q), mpq_denref(q), z); |
| @end example |
| |
| @item Number Sequences |
| @cindex Number sequences |
| Functions like @code{mpz_fac_ui}, @code{mpz_fib_ui} and @code{mpz_bin_uiui} |
| are designed for calculating isolated values. If a range of values is wanted |
| it's probably best to call to get a starting point and iterate from there. |
| |
| @item Text Input/Output |
| @cindex Text input/output |
| Hexadecimal or octal are suggested for input or output in text form. |
| Power-of-2 bases like these can be converted much more efficiently than other |
| bases, like decimal. For big numbers there's usually nothing of particular |
| interest to be seen in the digits, so the base doesn't matter much. |
| |
| Maybe we can hope octal will one day become the normal base for everyday use, |
| as proposed by King Charles XII of Sweden and later reformers. |
| @c Reference: Knuth volume 2 section 4.1, page 184 of second edition. :-) |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @node Debugging, Profiling, Efficiency, GMP Basics |
| @section Debugging |
| @cindex Debugging |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item Stack Overflow |
| @cindex Stack overflow |
| @cindex Segmentation violation |
| @cindex Bus error |
| Depending on the system, a segmentation violation or bus error might be the |
| only indication of stack overflow. See @samp{--enable-alloca} choices in |
| @ref{Build Options}, for how to address this. |
| |
| In new enough versions of GCC, @samp{-fstack-check} may be able to ensure an |
| overflow is recognised by the system before too much damage is done, or |
| @samp{-fstack-limit-symbol} or @samp{-fstack-limit-register} may be able to |
| add checking if the system itself doesn't do any (@pxref{Code Gen Options,, |
| Options for Code Generation, gcc, Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). |
| These options must be added to the @samp{CFLAGS} used in the GMP build |
| (@pxref{Build Options}), adding them just to an application will have no |
| effect. Note also they're a slowdown, adding overhead to each function call |
| and each stack allocation. |
| |
| @item Heap Problems |
| @cindex Heap problems |
| @cindex Malloc problems |
| The most likely cause of application problems with GMP is heap corruption. |
| Failing to @code{init} GMP variables will have unpredictable effects, and |
| corruption arising elsewhere in a program may well affect GMP@. Initializing |
| GMP variables more than once or failing to clear them will cause memory leaks. |
| |
| @cindex Malloc debugger |
| In all such cases a @code{malloc} debugger is recommended. On a GNU or BSD |
| system the standard C library @code{malloc} has some diagnostic facilities, |
| see @ref{Allocation Debugging,, Allocation Debugging, libc, The GNU C Library |
| Reference Manual}, or @samp{man 3 malloc}. Other possibilities, in no |
| particular order, include |
| |
| @display |
| @uref{http://cs.ecs.baylor.edu/~donahoo/tools/ccmalloc/} |
| @uref{http://dmalloc.com/} |
| @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Apps/MemProf} |
| @end display |
| |
| The GMP default allocation routines in @file{memory.c} also have a simple |
| sentinel scheme which can be enabled with @code{#define DEBUG} in that file. |
| This is mainly designed for detecting buffer overruns during GMP development, |
| but might find other uses. |
| |
| @item Stack Backtraces |
| @cindex Stack backtrace |
| On some systems the compiler options GMP uses by default can interfere with |
| debugging. In particular on x86 and 68k systems @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} |
| is used and this generally inhibits stack backtracing. Recompiling without |
| such options may help while debugging, though the usual caveats about it |
| potentially moving a memory problem or hiding a compiler bug will apply. |
| |
| @item GDB, the GNU Debugger |
| @cindex GDB |
| @cindex GNU Debugger |
| A sample @file{.gdbinit} is included in the distribution, showing how to call |
| some undocumented dump functions to print GMP variables from within GDB@. Note |
| that these functions shouldn't be used in final application code since they're |
| undocumented and may be subject to incompatible changes in future versions of |
| GMP. |
| |
| @item Source File Paths |
| GMP has multiple source files with the same name, in different directories. |
| For example @file{mpz}, @file{mpq} and @file{mpf} each have an |
| @file{init.c}. If the debugger can't already determine the right one it may |
| help to build with absolute paths on each C file. One way to do that is to |
| use a separate object directory with an absolute path to the source directory. |
| |
| @example |
| cd /my/build/dir |
| /my/source/dir/gmp-@value{VERSION}/configure |
| @end example |
| |
| This works via @code{VPATH}, and might require GNU @command{make}. |
| Alternately it might be possible to change the @code{.c.lo} rules |
| appropriately. |
| |
| @item Assertion Checking |
| @cindex Assertion checking |
| The build option @option{--enable-assert} is available to add some consistency |
| checks to the library (see @ref{Build Options}). These are likely to be of |
| limited value to most applications. Assertion failures are just as likely to |
| indicate memory corruption as a library or compiler bug. |
| |
| Applications using the low-level @code{mpn} functions, however, will benefit |
| from @option{--enable-assert} since it adds checks on the parameters of most |
| such functions, many of which have subtle restrictions on their usage. Note |
| however that only the generic C code has checks, not the assembly code, so |
| @option{--disable-assembly} should be used for maximum checking. |
| |
| @item Temporary Memory Checking |
| The build option @option{--enable-alloca=debug} arranges that each block of |
| temporary memory in GMP is allocated with a separate call to @code{malloc} (or |
| the allocation function set with @code{mp_set_memory_functions}). |
| |
| This can help a malloc debugger detect accesses outside the intended bounds, |
| or detect memory not released. In a normal build, on the other hand, |
| temporary memory is allocated in blocks which GMP divides up for its own use, |
| or may be allocated with a compiler builtin @code{alloca} which will go |
| nowhere near any malloc debugger hooks. |
| |
| @item Maximum Debuggability |
| To summarize the above, a GMP build for maximum debuggability would be |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --disable-shared --enable-assert \ |
| --enable-alloca=debug --disable-assembly CFLAGS=-g |
| @end example |
| |
| For C++, add @samp{--enable-cxx CXXFLAGS=-g}. |
| |
| @item Checker |
| @cindex Checker |
| @cindex GCC Checker |
| The GCC checker (@uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/checker/}) can be |
| used with GMP@. It contains a stub library which means GMP applications |
| compiled with checker can use a normal GMP build. |
| |
| A build of GMP with checking within GMP itself can be made. This will run |
| very very slowly. On GNU/Linux for example, |
| |
| @cindex @command{checkergcc} |
| @example |
| ./configure --disable-assembly CC=checkergcc |
| @end example |
| |
| @option{--disable-assembly} must be used, since the GMP assembly code doesn't |
| support the checking scheme. The GMP C++ features cannot be used, since |
| current versions of checker (0.9.9.1) don't yet support the standard C++ |
| library. |
| |
| @item Valgrind |
| @cindex Valgrind |
| Valgrind (@uref{http://valgrind.org/}) is a memory checker for x86, ARM, MIPS, |
| PowerPC, and S/390. It translates and emulates machine instructions to do |
| strong checks for uninitialized data (at the level of individual bits), memory |
| accesses through bad pointers, and memory leaks. |
| |
| Valgrind does not always support every possible instruction, in particular |
| ones recently added to an ISA. Valgrind might therefore be incompatible with |
| a recent GMP or even a less recent GMP which is compiled using a recent GCC. |
| |
| GMP's assembly code sometimes promotes a read of the limbs to some larger size, |
| for efficiency. GMP will do this even at the start and end of a multilimb |
| operand, using naturally aligned operations on the larger type. This may lead |
| to benign reads outside of allocated areas, triggering complaints from |
| Valgrind. Valgrind's option @samp{--partial-loads-ok=yes} should help. |
| |
| @item Other Problems |
| Any suspected bug in GMP itself should be isolated to make sure it's not an |
| application problem, see @ref{Reporting Bugs}. |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @node Profiling, Autoconf, Debugging, GMP Basics |
| @section Profiling |
| @cindex Profiling |
| @cindex Execution profiling |
| @cindex @code{--enable-profiling} |
| |
| Running a program under a profiler is a good way to find where it's spending |
| most time and where improvements can be best sought. The profiling choices |
| for a GMP build are as follows. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @samp{--disable-profiling} |
| The default is to add nothing special for profiling. |
| |
| It should be possible to just compile the mainline of a program with @code{-p} |
| and use @command{prof} to get a profile consisting of timer-based sampling of |
| the program counter. Most of the GMP assembly code has the necessary symbol |
| information. |
| |
| This approach has the advantage of minimizing interference with normal program |
| operation, but on most systems the resolution of the sampling is quite low (10 |
| milliseconds for instance), requiring long runs to get accurate information. |
| |
| @item @samp{--enable-profiling=prof} |
| @cindex @code{prof} |
| Build with support for the system @command{prof}, which means @samp{-p} added |
| to the @samp{CFLAGS}. |
| |
| This provides call counting in addition to program counter sampling, which |
| allows the most frequently called routines to be identified, and an average |
| time spent in each routine to be determined. |
| |
| The x86 assembly code has support for this option, but on other processors |
| the assembly routines will be as if compiled without @samp{-p} and therefore |
| won't appear in the call counts. |
| |
| On some systems, such as GNU/Linux, @samp{-p} in fact means @samp{-pg} and in |
| this case @samp{--enable-profiling=gprof} described below should be used |
| instead. |
| |
| @item @samp{--enable-profiling=gprof} |
| @cindex @code{gprof} |
| Build with support for @command{gprof}, which means @samp{-pg} added to the |
| @samp{CFLAGS}. |
| |
| This provides call graph construction in addition to call counting and program |
| counter sampling, which makes it possible to count calls coming from different |
| locations. For example the number of calls to @code{mpn_mul} from |
| @code{mpz_mul} versus the number from @code{mpf_mul}. The program counter |
| sampling is still flat though, so only a total time in @code{mpn_mul} would be |
| accumulated, not a separate amount for each call site. |
| |
| The x86 assembly code has support for this option, but on other processors |
| the assembly routines will be as if compiled without @samp{-pg} and therefore |
| not be included in the call counts. |
| |
| On x86 and m68k systems @samp{-pg} and @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} are |
| incompatible, so the latter is omitted from the default flags in that case, |
| which might result in poorer code generation. |
| |
| Incidentally, it should be possible to use the @command{gprof} program with a |
| plain @samp{--enable-profiling=prof} build. But in that case only the |
| @samp{gprof -p} flat profile and call counts can be expected to be valid, not |
| the @samp{gprof -q} call graph. |
| |
| @item @samp{--enable-profiling=instrument} |
| @cindex @code{-finstrument-functions} |
| @cindex @code{instrument-functions} |
| Build with the GCC option @samp{-finstrument-functions} added to the |
| @samp{CFLAGS} (@pxref{Code Gen Options,, Options for Code Generation, gcc, |
| Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). |
| |
| This inserts special instrumenting calls at the start and end of each |
| function, allowing exact timing and full call graph construction. |
| |
| This instrumenting is not normally a standard system feature and will require |
| support from an external library, such as |
| |
| @cindex FunctionCheck |
| @cindex fnccheck |
| @display |
| @uref{https://sourceforge.net/projects/fnccheck/} |
| @end display |
| |
| This should be included in @samp{LIBS} during the GMP configure so that test |
| programs will link. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| ./configure --enable-profiling=instrument LIBS=-lfc |
| @end example |
| |
| On a GNU system the C library provides dummy instrumenting functions, so |
| programs compiled with this option will link. In this case it's only |
| necessary to ensure the correct library is added when linking an application. |
| |
| The x86 assembly code supports this option, but on other processors the |
| assembly routines will be as if compiled without |
| @samp{-finstrument-functions} meaning time spent in them will effectively be |
| attributed to their caller. |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @node Autoconf, Emacs, Profiling, GMP Basics |
| @section Autoconf |
| @cindex Autoconf |
| |
| Autoconf based applications can easily check whether GMP is installed. The |
| only thing to be noted is that GMP library symbols from version 3 onwards have |
| prefixes like @code{__gmpz}. The following therefore would be a simple test, |
| |
| @cindex @code{AC_CHECK_LIB} |
| @example |
| AC_CHECK_LIB(gmp, __gmpz_init) |
| @end example |
| |
| This just uses the default @code{AC_CHECK_LIB} actions for found or not found, |
| but an application that must have GMP would want to generate an error if not |
| found. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| AC_CHECK_LIB(gmp, __gmpz_init, , |
| [AC_MSG_ERROR([GNU MP not found, see https://gmplib.org/])]) |
| @end example |
| |
| If functions added in some particular version of GMP are required, then one of |
| those can be used when checking. For example @code{mpz_mul_si} was added in |
| GMP 3.1, |
| |
| @example |
| AC_CHECK_LIB(gmp, __gmpz_mul_si, , |
| [AC_MSG_ERROR( |
| [GNU MP not found, or not 3.1 or up, see https://gmplib.org/])]) |
| @end example |
| |
| An alternative would be to test the version number in @file{gmp.h} using say |
| @code{AC_EGREP_CPP}. That would make it possible to test the exact version, |
| if some particular sub-minor release is known to be necessary. |
| |
| In general it's recommended that applications should simply demand a new |
| enough GMP rather than trying to provide supplements for features not |
| available in past versions. |
| |
| Occasionally an application will need or want to know the size of a type at |
| configuration or preprocessing time, not just with @code{sizeof} in the code. |
| This can be done in the normal way with @code{mp_limb_t} etc, but GMP 4.0 or |
| up is best for this, since prior versions needed certain @samp{-D} defines on |
| systems using a @code{long long} limb. The following would suit Autoconf 2.50 |
| or up, |
| |
| @example |
| AC_CHECK_SIZEOF(mp_limb_t, , [#include <gmp.h>]) |
| @end example |
| |
| |
| @node Emacs, , Autoconf, GMP Basics |
| @section Emacs |
| @cindex Emacs |
| @cindex @code{info-lookup-symbol} |
| |
| @key{C-h C-i} (@code{info-lookup-symbol}) is a good way to find documentation |
| on C functions while editing (@pxref{Info Lookup, , Info Documentation Lookup, |
| emacs, The Emacs Editor}). |
| |
| The GMP manual can be included in such lookups by putting the following in |
| your @file{.emacs}, |
| |
| @c This isn't pretty, but there doesn't seem to be a better way (in emacs |
| @c 21.2 at least). info-lookup->mode-value could be used for the "assoc"s, |
| @c but that function isn't documented, whereas info-lookup-alist is. |
| @c |
| @example |
| (eval-after-load "info-look" |
| '(let ((mode-value (assoc 'c-mode (assoc 'symbol info-lookup-alist)))) |
| (setcar (nthcdr 3 mode-value) |
| (cons '("(gmp)Function Index" nil "^ -.* " "\\>") |
| (nth 3 mode-value))))) |
| @end example |
| |
| |
| @node Reporting Bugs, Integer Functions, GMP Basics, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Reporting Bugs |
| @cindex Reporting bugs |
| @cindex Bug reporting |
| |
| If you think you have found a bug in the GMP library, please investigate it |
| and report it. We have made this library available to you, and it is not too |
| much to ask you to report the bugs you find. |
| |
| Before you report a bug, check it's not already addressed in @ref{Known Build |
| Problems}, or perhaps @ref{Notes for Particular Systems}. You may also want |
| to check @uref{https://gmplib.org/} for patches for this release. |
| |
| Please include the following in any report, |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| The GMP version number, and if pre-packaged or patched then say so. |
| |
| @item |
| A test program that makes it possible for us to reproduce the bug. Include |
| instructions on how to run the program. |
| |
| @item |
| A description of what is wrong. If the results are incorrect, in what way. |
| If you get a crash, say so. |
| |
| @item |
| If you get a crash, include a stack backtrace from the debugger if it's |
| informative (@samp{where} in @command{gdb}, or @samp{$C} in @command{adb}). |
| |
| @item |
| Please do not send core dumps, executables or @command{strace}s. |
| |
| @item |
| The @samp{configure} options you used when building GMP, if any. |
| |
| @item |
| The output from @samp{configure}, as printed to stdout, with any options used. |
| |
| @item |
| The name of the compiler and its version. For @command{gcc}, get the version |
| with @samp{gcc -v}, otherwise perhaps @samp{what `which cc`}, or similar. |
| |
| @item |
| The output from running @samp{uname -a}. |
| |
| @item |
| The output from running @samp{./config.guess}, and from running |
| @samp{./configfsf.guess} (might be the same). |
| |
| @item |
| If the bug is related to @samp{configure}, then the compressed contents of |
| @file{config.log}. |
| |
| @item |
| If the bug is related to an @file{asm} file not assembling, then the contents |
| of @file{config.m4} and the offending line or lines from the temporary |
| @file{mpn/tmp-<file>.s}. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| Please make an effort to produce a self-contained report, with something |
| definite that can be tested or debugged. Vague queries or piecemeal messages |
| are difficult to act on and don't help the development effort. |
| |
| It is not uncommon that an observed problem is actually due to a bug in the |
| compiler; the GMP code tends to explore interesting corners in compilers. |
| |
| If your bug report is good, we will do our best to help you get a corrected |
| version of the library; if the bug report is poor, we won't do anything about |
| it (except maybe ask you to send a better report). |
| |
| Send your report to: @email{gmp-bugs@@gmplib.org}. |
| |
| If you think something in this manual is unclear, or downright incorrect, or if |
| the language needs to be improved, please send a note to the same address. |
| |
| |
| @node Integer Functions, Rational Number Functions, Reporting Bugs, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Integer Functions |
| @cindex Integer functions |
| |
| This chapter describes the GMP functions for performing integer arithmetic. |
| These functions start with the prefix @code{mpz_}. |
| |
| GMP integers are stored in objects of type @code{mpz_t}. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Initializing Integers:: |
| * Assigning Integers:: |
| * Simultaneous Integer Init & Assign:: |
| * Converting Integers:: |
| * Integer Arithmetic:: |
| * Integer Division:: |
| * Integer Exponentiation:: |
| * Integer Roots:: |
| * Number Theoretic Functions:: |
| * Integer Comparisons:: |
| * Integer Logic and Bit Fiddling:: |
| * I/O of Integers:: |
| * Integer Random Numbers:: |
| * Integer Import and Export:: |
| * Miscellaneous Integer Functions:: |
| * Integer Special Functions:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Initializing Integers, Assigning Integers, Integer Functions, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Initialization Functions |
| @cindex Integer initialization functions |
| @cindex Initialization functions |
| |
| The functions for integer arithmetic assume that all integer objects are |
| initialized. You do that by calling the function @code{mpz_init}. For |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| @{ |
| mpz_t integ; |
| mpz_init (integ); |
| @dots{} |
| mpz_add (integ, @dots{}); |
| @dots{} |
| mpz_sub (integ, @dots{}); |
| |
| /* Unless the program is about to exit, do ... */ |
| mpz_clear (integ); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| As you can see, you can store new values any number of times, once an |
| object is initialized. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_init (mpz_t @var{x}) |
| Initialize @var{x}, and set its value to 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_inits (mpz_t @var{x}, ...) |
| Initialize a NULL-terminated list of @code{mpz_t} variables, and set their |
| values to 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_init2 (mpz_t @var{x}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{n}) |
| Initialize @var{x}, with space for @var{n}-bit numbers, and set its value to 0. |
| Calling this function instead of @code{mpz_init} or @code{mpz_inits} is never |
| necessary; reallocation is handled automatically by GMP when needed. |
| |
| While @var{n} defines the initial space, @var{x} will grow automatically in the |
| normal way, if necessary, for subsequent values stored. @code{mpz_init2} makes |
| it possible to avoid such reallocations if a maximum size is known in advance. |
| |
| In preparation for an operation, GMP often allocates one limb more than |
| ultimately needed. To make sure GMP will not perform reallocation for |
| @var{x}, you need to add the number of bits in @code{mp_limb_t} to @var{n}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_clear (mpz_t @var{x}) |
| Free the space occupied by @var{x}. Call this function for all @code{mpz_t} |
| variables when you are done with them. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_clears (mpz_t @var{x}, ...) |
| Free the space occupied by a NULL-terminated list of @code{mpz_t} variables. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_realloc2 (mpz_t @var{x}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{n}) |
| Change the space allocated for @var{x} to @var{n} bits. The value in @var{x} |
| is preserved if it fits, or is set to 0 if not. |
| |
| Calling this function is never necessary; reallocation is handled automatically |
| by GMP when needed. But this function can be used to increase the space for a |
| variable in order to avoid repeated automatic reallocations, or to decrease it |
| to give memory back to the heap. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Assigning Integers, Simultaneous Integer Init & Assign, Initializing Integers, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Assignment Functions |
| @cindex Integer assignment functions |
| @cindex Assignment functions |
| |
| These functions assign new values to already initialized integers |
| (@pxref{Initializing Integers}). |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_set (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_set_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_set_si (mpz_t @var{rop}, signed long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_set_d (mpz_t @var{rop}, double @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_set_q (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_set_f (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Set the value of @var{rop} from @var{op}. |
| |
| @code{mpz_set_d}, @code{mpz_set_q} and @code{mpz_set_f} truncate @var{op} to |
| make it an integer. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_set_str (mpz_t @var{rop}, const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| Set the value of @var{rop} from @var{str}, a null-terminated C string in base |
| @var{base}. White space is allowed in the string, and is simply ignored. |
| |
| The @var{base} may vary from 2 to 62, or if @var{base} is 0, then the leading |
| characters are used: @code{0x} and @code{0X} for hexadecimal, @code{0b} and |
| @code{0B} for binary, @code{0} for octal, or decimal otherwise. |
| |
| For bases up to 36, case is ignored; upper-case and lower-case letters have |
| the same value. For bases 37 to 62, upper-case letter represent the usual |
| 10..35 while lower-case letter represent 36..61. |
| |
| This function returns 0 if the entire string is a valid number in base |
| @var{base}. Otherwise it returns @minus{}1. |
| @c |
| @c It turns out that it is not entirely true that this function ignores |
| @c white-space. It does ignore it between digits, but not after a minus sign |
| @c or within or after ``0x''. Some thought was given to disallowing all |
| @c whitespace, but that would be an incompatible change, whitespace has been |
| @c documented as ignored ever since GMP 1. |
| @c |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_swap (mpz_t @var{rop1}, mpz_t @var{rop2}) |
| Swap the values @var{rop1} and @var{rop2} efficiently. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Simultaneous Integer Init & Assign, Converting Integers, Assigning Integers, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Combined Initialization and Assignment Functions |
| @cindex Integer assignment functions |
| @cindex Assignment functions |
| @cindex Integer initialization functions |
| @cindex Initialization functions |
| |
| For convenience, GMP provides a parallel series of initialize-and-set functions |
| which initialize the output and then store the value there. These functions' |
| names have the form @code{mpz_init_set@dots{}} |
| |
| Here is an example of using one: |
| |
| @example |
| @{ |
| mpz_t pie; |
| mpz_init_set_str (pie, "3141592653589793238462643383279502884", 10); |
| @dots{} |
| mpz_sub (pie, @dots{}); |
| @dots{} |
| mpz_clear (pie); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| Once the integer has been initialized by any of the @code{mpz_init_set@dots{}} |
| functions, it can be used as the source or destination operand for the ordinary |
| integer functions. Don't use an initialize-and-set function on a variable |
| already initialized! |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_init_set (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_init_set_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_init_set_si (mpz_t @var{rop}, signed long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_init_set_d (mpz_t @var{rop}, double @var{op}) |
| Initialize @var{rop} with limb space and set the initial numeric value from |
| @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_init_set_str (mpz_t @var{rop}, const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| Initialize @var{rop} and set its value like @code{mpz_set_str} (see its |
| documentation above for details). |
| |
| If the string is a correct base @var{base} number, the function returns 0; |
| if an error occurs it returns @minus{}1. @var{rop} is initialized even if |
| an error occurs. (I.e., you have to call @code{mpz_clear} for it.) |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Converting Integers, Integer Arithmetic, Simultaneous Integer Init & Assign, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Conversion Functions |
| @cindex Integer conversion functions |
| @cindex Conversion functions |
| |
| This section describes functions for converting GMP integers to standard C |
| types. Functions for converting @emph{to} GMP integers are described in |
| @ref{Assigning Integers} and @ref{I/O of Integers}. |
| |
| @deftypefun {unsigned long int} mpz_get_ui (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Return the value of @var{op} as an @code{unsigned long}. |
| |
| If @var{op} is too big to fit an @code{unsigned long} then just the least |
| significant bits that do fit are returned. The sign of @var{op} is ignored, |
| only the absolute value is used. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {signed long int} mpz_get_si (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| If @var{op} fits into a @code{signed long int} return the value of @var{op}. |
| Otherwise return the least significant part of @var{op}, with the same sign |
| as @var{op}. |
| |
| If @var{op} is too big to fit in a @code{signed long int}, the returned |
| result is probably not very useful. To find out if the value will fit, use |
| the function @code{mpz_fits_slong_p}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun double mpz_get_d (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a @code{double}, truncating if necessary (i.e.@: rounding |
| towards zero). |
| |
| If the exponent from the conversion is too big, the result is system |
| dependent. An infinity is returned where available. A hardware overflow trap |
| may or may not occur. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun double mpz_get_d_2exp (signed long int *@var{exp}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a @code{double}, truncating if necessary (i.e.@: rounding |
| towards zero), and returning the exponent separately. |
| |
| The return value is in the range @math{0.5@le{}@GMPabs{@var{d}}<1} and the |
| exponent is stored to @code{*@var{exp}}. @m{@var{d} * 2^{exp}, @var{d} * |
| 2^@var{exp}} is the (truncated) @var{op} value. If @var{op} is zero, the |
| return is @math{0.0} and 0 is stored to @code{*@var{exp}}. |
| |
| @cindex @code{frexp} |
| This is similar to the standard C @code{frexp} function (@pxref{Normalization |
| Functions,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {char *} mpz_get_str (char *@var{str}, int @var{base}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a string of digits in base @var{base}. The base argument |
| may vary from 2 to 62 or from @minus{}2 to @minus{}36. |
| |
| For @var{base} in the range 2..36, digits and lower-case letters are used; for |
| @minus{}2..@minus{}36, digits and upper-case letters are used; for 37..62, |
| digits, upper-case letters, and lower-case letters (in that significance order) |
| are used. |
| |
| If @var{str} is @code{NULL}, the result string is allocated using the current |
| allocation function (@pxref{Custom Allocation}). The block will be |
| @code{strlen(str)+1} bytes, that being exactly enough for the string and |
| null-terminator. |
| |
| If @var{str} is not @code{NULL}, it should point to a block of storage large |
| enough for the result, that being @code{mpz_sizeinbase (@var{op}, @var{base}) |
| + 2}. The two extra bytes are for a possible minus sign, and the |
| null-terminator. |
| |
| A pointer to the result string is returned, being either the allocated block, |
| or the given @var{str}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Integer Arithmetic, Integer Division, Converting Integers, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Arithmetic Functions |
| @cindex Integer arithmetic functions |
| @cindex Arithmetic functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_add (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_add_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @math{@var{op1} + @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_sub (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_sub_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_ui_sub (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op1} @minus{} @var{op2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_mul (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_mul_si (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, long int @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_mul_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @math{@var{op1} @GMPtimes{} @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_addmul (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_addmul_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @math{@var{rop} + @var{op1} @GMPtimes{} @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_submul (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_submul_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @math{@var{rop} - @var{op1} @GMPtimes{} @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_mul_2exp (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{op2}) |
| @cindex Bit shift left |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{@var{op1} \times 2^{op2}, @var{op1} times 2 raised to |
| @var{op2}}. This operation can also be defined as a left shift by @var{op2} |
| bits. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_neg (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @minus{}@var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_abs (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to the absolute value of @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Integer Division, Integer Exponentiation, Integer Arithmetic, Integer Functions |
| @section Division Functions |
| @cindex Integer division functions |
| @cindex Division functions |
| |
| Division is undefined if the divisor is zero. Passing a zero divisor to the |
| division or modulo functions (including the modular powering functions |
| @code{mpz_powm} and @code{mpz_powm_ui}), will cause an intentional division by |
| zero. This lets a program handle arithmetic exceptions in these functions the |
| same way as for normal C @code{int} arithmetic. |
| |
| @c Separate deftypefun groups for cdiv, fdiv and tdiv produce a blank line |
| @c between each, and seem to let tex do a better job of page breaks than an |
| @c @sp 1 in the middle of one big set. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_cdiv_q (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_cdiv_r (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_cdiv_qr (mpz_t @var{q}, mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_cdiv_q_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_cdiv_r_ui (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_cdiv_qr_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, mpz_t @var{r}, @w{const mpz_t @var{n}}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_cdiv_ui (const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_cdiv_q_2exp (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_cdiv_r_2exp (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}}) |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_fdiv_q (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_fdiv_r (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_fdiv_qr (mpz_t @var{q}, mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_fdiv_q_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_fdiv_r_ui (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_fdiv_qr_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, mpz_t @var{r}, @w{const mpz_t @var{n}}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_fdiv_ui (const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_fdiv_q_2exp (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_fdiv_r_2exp (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}}) |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_tdiv_q (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_tdiv_r (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_tdiv_qr (mpz_t @var{q}, mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_tdiv_q_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_tdiv_r_ui (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_tdiv_qr_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, mpz_t @var{r}, @w{const mpz_t @var{n}}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_tdiv_ui (const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_tdiv_q_2exp (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_tdiv_r_2exp (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}}) |
| @cindex Bit shift right |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| Divide @var{n} by @var{d}, forming a quotient @var{q} and/or remainder |
| @var{r}. For the @code{2exp} functions, @m{@var{d}=2^b, @var{d}=2^@var{b}}. |
| The rounding is in three styles, each suiting different applications. |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| @code{cdiv} rounds @var{q} up towards @m{+\infty, +infinity}, and @var{r} will |
| have the opposite sign to @var{d}. The @code{c} stands for ``ceil''. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{fdiv} rounds @var{q} down towards @m{-\infty, @minus{}infinity}, and |
| @var{r} will have the same sign as @var{d}. The @code{f} stands for |
| ``floor''. |
| |
| @item |
| @code{tdiv} rounds @var{q} towards zero, and @var{r} will have the same sign |
| as @var{n}. The @code{t} stands for ``truncate''. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| In all cases @var{q} and @var{r} will satisfy |
| @m{@var{n}=@var{q}@var{d}+@var{r}, @var{n}=@var{q}*@var{d}+@var{r}}, and |
| @var{r} will satisfy @math{0@le{}@GMPabs{@var{r}}<@GMPabs{@var{d}}}. |
| |
| The @code{q} functions calculate only the quotient, the @code{r} functions |
| only the remainder, and the @code{qr} functions calculate both. Note that for |
| @code{qr} the same variable cannot be passed for both @var{q} and @var{r}, or |
| results will be unpredictable. |
| |
| For the @code{ui} variants the return value is the remainder, and in fact |
| returning the remainder is all the @code{div_ui} functions do. For |
| @code{tdiv} and @code{cdiv} the remainder can be negative, so for those the |
| return value is the absolute value of the remainder. |
| |
| For the @code{2exp} variants the divisor is @m{2^b,2^@var{b}}. These |
| functions are implemented as right shifts and bit masks, but of course they |
| round the same as the other functions. |
| |
| For positive @var{n} both @code{mpz_fdiv_q_2exp} and @code{mpz_tdiv_q_2exp} |
| are simple bitwise right shifts. For negative @var{n}, @code{mpz_fdiv_q_2exp} |
| is effectively an arithmetic right shift treating @var{n} as twos complement |
| the same as the bitwise logical functions do, whereas @code{mpz_tdiv_q_2exp} |
| effectively treats @var{n} as sign and magnitude. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_mod (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long int} mpz_mod_ui (mpz_t @var{r}, const mpz_t @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{d}}) |
| Set @var{r} to @var{n} @code{mod} @var{d}. The sign of the divisor is |
| ignored; the result is always non-negative. |
| |
| @code{mpz_mod_ui} is identical to @code{mpz_fdiv_r_ui} above, returning the |
| remainder as well as setting @var{r}. See @code{mpz_fdiv_ui} above if only |
| the return value is wanted. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_divexact (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_divexact_ui (mpz_t @var{q}, const mpz_t @var{n}, unsigned long @var{d}) |
| @cindex Exact division functions |
| Set @var{q} to @var{n}/@var{d}. These functions produce correct results only |
| when it is known in advance that @var{d} divides @var{n}. |
| |
| These routines are much faster than the other division functions, and are the |
| best choice when exact division is known to occur, for example reducing a |
| rational to lowest terms. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_divisible_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_divisible_ui_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, unsigned long int @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_divisible_2exp_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}) |
| @cindex Divisibility functions |
| Return non-zero if @var{n} is exactly divisible by @var{d}, or in the case of |
| @code{mpz_divisible_2exp_p} by @m{2^b,2^@var{b}}. |
| |
| @var{n} is divisible by @var{d} if there exists an integer @var{q} satisfying |
| @math{@var{n} = @var{q}@GMPmultiply{}@var{d}}. Unlike the other division |
| functions, @math{@var{d}=0} is accepted and following the rule it can be seen |
| that only 0 is considered divisible by 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_congruent_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{c}, const mpz_t @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_congruent_ui_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, unsigned long int @var{c}, unsigned long int @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_congruent_2exp_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, const mpz_t @var{c}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{b}) |
| @cindex Divisibility functions |
| @cindex Congruence functions |
| Return non-zero if @var{n} is congruent to @var{c} modulo @var{d}, or in the |
| case of @code{mpz_congruent_2exp_p} modulo @m{2^b,2^@var{b}}. |
| |
| @var{n} is congruent to @var{c} mod @var{d} if there exists an integer @var{q} |
| satisfying @math{@var{n} = @var{c} + @var{q}@GMPmultiply{}@var{d}}. Unlike |
| the other division functions, @math{@var{d}=0} is accepted and following the |
| rule it can be seen that @var{n} and @var{c} are considered congruent mod 0 |
| only when exactly equal. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Integer Exponentiation, Integer Roots, Integer Division, Integer Functions |
| @section Exponentiation Functions |
| @cindex Integer exponentiation functions |
| @cindex Exponentiation functions |
| @cindex Powering functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_powm (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{base}, const mpz_t @var{exp}, const mpz_t @var{mod}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_powm_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{base}, unsigned long int @var{exp}, const mpz_t @var{mod}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{base^{exp} \bmod mod, (@var{base} raised to @var{exp}) |
| modulo @var{mod}}. |
| |
| Negative @var{exp} is supported if the inverse @mm{@var{base}@sup{-1} @bmod |
| @var{mod}, @var{base}^(-1) @bmod @var{mod}} exists (see @code{mpz_invert} in |
| @ref{Number Theoretic Functions}). If an inverse doesn't exist then a divide |
| by zero is raised. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_powm_sec (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{base}, const mpz_t @var{exp}, const mpz_t @var{mod}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{base^{exp} \bmod @var{mod}, (@var{base} raised to @var{exp}) |
| modulo @var{mod}}. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{exp} > 0} and that @var{mod} is odd. |
| |
| This function is designed to take the same time and have the same cache access |
| patterns for any two same-size arguments, assuming that function arguments are |
| placed at the same position and that the machine state is identical upon |
| function entry. This function is intended for cryptographic purposes, where |
| resilience to side-channel attacks is desired. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_pow_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{base}, unsigned long int @var{exp}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_ui_pow_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{base}, unsigned long int @var{exp}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{base^{exp}, @var{base} raised to @var{exp}}. The case |
| @math{0^0} yields 1. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Integer Roots, Number Theoretic Functions, Integer Exponentiation, Integer Functions |
| @section Root Extraction Functions |
| @cindex Integer root functions |
| @cindex Root extraction functions |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_root (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{\lfloor\root n \of {op}\rfloor@C{},} the truncated integer |
| part of the @var{n}th root of @var{op}. Return non-zero if the computation |
| was exact, i.e., if @var{op} is @var{rop} to the @var{n}th power. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_rootrem (mpz_t @var{root}, mpz_t @var{rem}, const mpz_t @var{u}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| Set @var{root} to @m{\lfloor\root n \of {u}\rfloor@C{},} the truncated |
| integer part of the @var{n}th root of @var{u}. Set @var{rem} to the |
| remainder, @m{(@var{u} - @var{root}^n), |
| @var{u}@minus{}@var{root}**@var{n}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_sqrt (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{\lfloor\sqrt{@var{op}}\rfloor@C{},} the truncated |
| integer part of the square root of @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_sqrtrem (mpz_t @var{rop1}, mpz_t @var{rop2}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop1} to @m{\lfloor\sqrt{@var{op}}\rfloor, the truncated integer part |
| of the square root of @var{op}}, like @code{mpz_sqrt}. Set @var{rop2} to the |
| remainder @m{(@var{op} - @var{rop1}^2), |
| @var{op}@minus{}@var{rop1}*@var{rop1}}, which will be zero if @var{op} is a |
| perfect square. |
| |
| If @var{rop1} and @var{rop2} are the same variable, the results are |
| undefined. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_perfect_power_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Perfect power functions |
| @cindex Root testing functions |
| Return non-zero if @var{op} is a perfect power, i.e., if there exist integers |
| @m{a,@var{a}} and @m{b,@var{b}}, with @m{b>1, @var{b}>1}, such that |
| @m{@var{op}=a^b, @var{op} equals @var{a} raised to the power @var{b}}. |
| |
| Under this definition both 0 and 1 are considered to be perfect powers. |
| Negative values of @var{op} are accepted, but of course can only be odd |
| perfect powers. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_perfect_square_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Perfect square functions |
| @cindex Root testing functions |
| Return non-zero if @var{op} is a perfect square, i.e., if the square root of |
| @var{op} is an integer. Under this definition both 0 and 1 are considered to |
| be perfect squares. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Number Theoretic Functions, Integer Comparisons, Integer Roots, Integer Functions |
| @section Number Theoretic Functions |
| @cindex Number theoretic functions |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_probab_prime_p (const mpz_t @var{n}, int @var{reps}) |
| @cindex Prime testing functions |
| @cindex Probable prime testing functions |
| Determine whether @var{n} is prime. Return 2 if @var{n} is definitely prime, |
| return 1 if @var{n} is probably prime (without being certain), or return 0 if |
| @var{n} is definitely non-prime. |
| |
| This function performs some trial divisions, a Baillie-PSW probable prime |
| test, then @var{reps-24} Miller-Rabin probabilistic primality tests. A |
| higher @var{reps} value will reduce the chances of a non-prime being |
| identified as ``probably prime''. A composite number will be identified as a |
| prime with an asymptotic probability of less than @m{4^{-reps},4^(-@var{reps})}. |
| Reasonable values of @var{reps} are between 15 and 50. |
| |
| GMP versions up to and including 6.1.2 did not use the Baillie-PSW |
| primality test. In those older versions of GMP, this function performed |
| @var{reps} Miller-Rabin tests. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_nextprime (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Next prime function |
| Set @var{rop} to the next prime greater than @var{op}. |
| |
| This function uses a probabilistic algorithm to identify primes. For |
| practical purposes it's adequate, the chance of a composite passing will be |
| extremely small. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @c mpz_prime_p not implemented as of gmp 3.0. |
| |
| @c @deftypefun int mpz_prime_p (const mpz_t @var{n}) |
| @c Return non-zero if @var{n} is prime and zero if @var{n} is a non-prime. |
| @c This function is far slower than @code{mpz_probab_prime_p}, but then it |
| @c never returns non-zero for composite numbers. |
| |
| @c (For practical purposes, using @code{mpz_probab_prime_p} is adequate. |
| @c The likelihood of a programming error or hardware malfunction is orders |
| @c of magnitudes greater than the likelihood for a composite to pass as a |
| @c prime, if the @var{reps} argument is in the suggested range.) |
| @c @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_gcd (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @cindex Greatest common divisor functions |
| @cindex GCD functions |
| Set @var{rop} to the greatest common divisor of @var{op1} and @var{op2}. The |
| result is always positive even if one or both input operands are negative. |
| Except if both inputs are zero; then this function defines @math{gcd(0,0) = 0}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {unsigned long int} mpz_gcd_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Compute the greatest common divisor of @var{op1} and @var{op2}. If |
| @var{rop} is not @code{NULL}, store the result there. |
| |
| If the result is small enough to fit in an @code{unsigned long int}, it is |
| returned. If the result does not fit, 0 is returned, and the result is equal |
| to the argument @var{op1}. Note that the result will always fit if @var{op2} |
| is non-zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_gcdext (mpz_t @var{g}, mpz_t @var{s}, mpz_t @var{t}, const mpz_t @var{a}, const mpz_t @var{b}) |
| @cindex Extended GCD |
| @cindex GCD extended |
| Set @var{g} to the greatest common divisor of @var{a} and @var{b}, and in |
| addition set @var{s} and @var{t} to coefficients satisfying |
| @math{@var{a}@GMPmultiply{}@var{s} + @var{b}@GMPmultiply{}@var{t} = @var{g}}. |
| The value in @var{g} is always positive, even if one or both of @var{a} and |
| @var{b} are negative (or zero if both inputs are zero). The values in @var{s} |
| and @var{t} are chosen such that normally, @math{@GMPabs{@var{s}} < |
| @GMPabs{@var{b}} / (2 @var{g})} and @math{@GMPabs{@var{t}} < @GMPabs{@var{a}} |
| / (2 @var{g})}, and these relations define @var{s} and @var{t} uniquely. There |
| are a few exceptional cases: |
| |
| If @math{@GMPabs{@var{a}} = @GMPabs{@var{b}}}, then @math{@var{s} = 0}, |
| @math{@var{t} = sgn(@var{b})}. |
| |
| Otherwise, @math{@var{s} = sgn(@var{a})} if @math{@var{b} = 0} or |
| @math{@GMPabs{@var{b}} = 2 @var{g}}, and @math{@var{t} = sgn(@var{b})} if |
| @math{@var{a} = 0} or @math{@GMPabs{@var{a}} = 2 @var{g}}. |
| |
| In all cases, @math{@var{s} = 0} if and only if @math{@var{g} = |
| @GMPabs{@var{b}}}, i.e., if @var{b} divides @var{a} or @math{@var{a} = @var{b} |
| = 0}. |
| |
| If @var{t} or @var{g} is @code{NULL} then that value is not computed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_lcm (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_lcm_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long @var{op2}) |
| @cindex Least common multiple functions |
| @cindex LCM functions |
| Set @var{rop} to the least common multiple of @var{op1} and @var{op2}. |
| @var{rop} is always positive, irrespective of the signs of @var{op1} and |
| @var{op2}. @var{rop} will be zero if either @var{op1} or @var{op2} is zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_invert (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @cindex Modular inverse functions |
| @cindex Inverse modulo functions |
| Compute the inverse of @var{op1} modulo @var{op2} and put the result in |
| @var{rop}. If the inverse exists, the return value is non-zero and @var{rop} |
| will satisfy @math{0 @le{} @var{rop} < @GMPabs{@var{op2}}} (with @math{@var{rop} |
| = 0} possible only when @math{@GMPabs{@var{op2}} = 1}, i.e., in the |
| somewhat degenerate zero ring). If an inverse doesn't |
| exist the return value is zero and @var{rop} is undefined. The behaviour of |
| this function is undefined when @var{op2} is zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_jacobi (const mpz_t @var{a}, const mpz_t @var{b}) |
| @cindex Jacobi symbol functions |
| Calculate the Jacobi symbol @m{\left(a \over b\right), |
| (@var{a}/@var{b})}. This is defined only for @var{b} odd. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_legendre (const mpz_t @var{a}, const mpz_t @var{p}) |
| @cindex Legendre symbol functions |
| Calculate the Legendre symbol @m{\left(a \over p\right), |
| (@var{a}/@var{p})}. This is defined only for @var{p} an odd positive |
| prime, and for such @var{p} it's identical to the Jacobi symbol. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_kronecker (const mpz_t @var{a}, const mpz_t @var{b}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_kronecker_si (const mpz_t @var{a}, long @var{b}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_kronecker_ui (const mpz_t @var{a}, unsigned long @var{b}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_si_kronecker (long @var{a}, const mpz_t @var{b}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_ui_kronecker (unsigned long @var{a}, const mpz_t @var{b}) |
| @cindex Kronecker symbol functions |
| Calculate the Jacobi symbol @m{\left(a \over b\right), |
| (@var{a}/@var{b})} with the Kronecker extension @m{\left(a \over |
| 2\right) = \left(2 \over a\right), (a/2)=(2/a)} when @math{a} odd, or |
| @m{\left(a \over 2\right) = 0, (a/2)=0} when @math{a} even. |
| |
| When @var{b} is odd the Jacobi symbol and Kronecker symbol are |
| identical, so @code{mpz_kronecker_ui} etc can be used for mixed |
| precision Jacobi symbols too. |
| |
| For more information see Henri Cohen section 1.4.2 (@pxref{References}), |
| or any number theory textbook. See also the example program |
| @file{demos/qcn.c} which uses @code{mpz_kronecker_ui}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpz_remove (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}, const mpz_t @var{f}) |
| @cindex Remove factor functions |
| @cindex Factor removal functions |
| Remove all occurrences of the factor @var{f} from @var{op} and store the |
| result in @var{rop}. The return value is how many such occurrences were |
| removed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_fac_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_2fac_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_mfac_uiui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{n}, unsigned long int @var{m}) |
| @cindex Factorial functions |
| Set @var{rop} to the factorial of @var{n}: @code{mpz_fac_ui} computes the plain factorial @var{n}!, |
| @code{mpz_2fac_ui} computes the double-factorial @var{n}!!, and @code{mpz_mfac_uiui} the |
| @var{m}-multi-factorial @m{n!^{(m)}, @var{n}!^(@var{m})}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_primorial_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @cindex Primorial functions |
| Set @var{rop} to the primorial of @var{n}, i.e. the product of all positive |
| prime numbers @math{@le{}@var{n}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_bin_ui (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{n}, unsigned long int @var{k}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_bin_uiui (mpz_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{n}, @w{unsigned long int @var{k}}) |
| @cindex Binomial coefficient functions |
| Compute the binomial coefficient @m{\left({n}\atop{k}\right), @var{n} over |
| @var{k}} and store the result in @var{rop}. Negative values of @var{n} are |
| supported by @code{mpz_bin_ui}, using the identity |
| @m{\left({-n}\atop{k}\right) = (-1)^k \left({n+k-1}\atop{k}\right), |
| bin(-n@C{}k) = (-1)^k * bin(n+k-1@C{}k)}, see Knuth volume 1 section 1.2.6 |
| part G. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_fib_ui (mpz_t @var{fn}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_fib2_ui (mpz_t @var{fn}, mpz_t @var{fnsub1}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @cindex Fibonacci sequence functions |
| @code{mpz_fib_ui} sets @var{fn} to to @m{F_n,F[n]}, the @var{n}'th Fibonacci |
| number. @code{mpz_fib2_ui} sets @var{fn} to @m{F_n,F[n]}, and @var{fnsub1} to |
| @m{F_{n-1},F[n-1]}. |
| |
| These functions are designed for calculating isolated Fibonacci numbers. When |
| a sequence of values is wanted it's best to start with @code{mpz_fib2_ui} and |
| iterate the defining @m{F_{n+1} = F_n + F_{n-1}, F[n+1]=F[n]+F[n-1]} or |
| similar. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_lucnum_ui (mpz_t @var{ln}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_lucnum2_ui (mpz_t @var{ln}, mpz_t @var{lnsub1}, unsigned long int @var{n}) |
| @cindex Lucas number functions |
| @code{mpz_lucnum_ui} sets @var{ln} to to @m{L_n,L[n]}, the @var{n}'th Lucas |
| number. @code{mpz_lucnum2_ui} sets @var{ln} to @m{L_n,L[n]}, and @var{lnsub1} |
| to @m{L_{n-1},L[n-1]}. |
| |
| These functions are designed for calculating isolated Lucas numbers. When a |
| sequence of values is wanted it's best to start with @code{mpz_lucnum2_ui} and |
| iterate the defining @m{L_{n+1} = L_n + L_{n-1}, L[n+1]=L[n]+L[n-1]} or |
| similar. |
| |
| The Fibonacci numbers and Lucas numbers are related sequences, so it's never |
| necessary to call both @code{mpz_fib2_ui} and @code{mpz_lucnum2_ui}. The |
| formulas for going from Fibonacci to Lucas can be found in @ref{Lucas Numbers |
| Algorithm}, the reverse is straightforward too. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Integer Comparisons, Integer Logic and Bit Fiddling, Number Theoretic Functions, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Comparison Functions |
| @cindex Integer comparison functions |
| @cindex Comparison functions |
| |
| @deftypefn Function int mpz_cmp (const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefnx Function int mpz_cmp_d (const mpz_t @var{op1}, double @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefnx Macro int mpz_cmp_si (const mpz_t @var{op1}, signed long int @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefnx Macro int mpz_cmp_ui (const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Compare @var{op1} and @var{op2}. Return a positive value if @math{@var{op1} > |
| @var{op2}}, zero if @math{@var{op1} = @var{op2}}, or a negative value if |
| @math{@var{op1} < @var{op2}}. |
| |
| @code{mpz_cmp_ui} and @code{mpz_cmp_si} are macros and will evaluate their |
| arguments more than once. @code{mpz_cmp_d} can be called with an infinity, |
| but results are undefined for a NaN. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefn Function int mpz_cmpabs (const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefnx Function int mpz_cmpabs_d (const mpz_t @var{op1}, double @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefnx Function int mpz_cmpabs_ui (const mpz_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Compare the absolute values of @var{op1} and @var{op2}. Return a positive |
| value if @math{@GMPabs{@var{op1}} > @GMPabs{@var{op2}}}, zero if |
| @math{@GMPabs{@var{op1}} = @GMPabs{@var{op2}}}, or a negative value if |
| @math{@GMPabs{@var{op1}} < @GMPabs{@var{op2}}}. |
| |
| @code{mpz_cmpabs_d} can be called with an infinity, but results are undefined |
| for a NaN. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro int mpz_sgn (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Sign tests |
| @cindex Integer sign tests |
| Return @math{+1} if @math{@var{op} > 0}, 0 if @math{@var{op} = 0}, and |
| @math{-1} if @math{@var{op} < 0}. |
| |
| This function is actually implemented as a macro. It evaluates its argument |
| multiple times. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| |
| @node Integer Logic and Bit Fiddling, I/O of Integers, Integer Comparisons, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Logical and Bit Manipulation Functions |
| @cindex Logical functions |
| @cindex Bit manipulation functions |
| @cindex Integer logical functions |
| @cindex Integer bit manipulation functions |
| |
| These functions behave as if twos complement arithmetic were used (although |
| sign-magnitude is the actual implementation). The least significant bit is |
| number 0. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_and (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op1} bitwise-and @var{op2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_ior (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op1} bitwise inclusive-or @var{op2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_xor (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op1} bitwise exclusive-or @var{op2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_com (mpz_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to the one's complement of @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpz_popcount (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| If @math{@var{op}@ge{}0}, return the population count of @var{op}, which is the |
| number of 1 bits in the binary representation. If @math{@var{op}<0}, the |
| number of 1s is infinite, and the return value is the largest possible |
| @code{mp_bitcnt_t}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpz_hamdist (const mpz_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| If @var{op1} and @var{op2} are both @math{@ge{}0} or both @math{<0}, return the |
| hamming distance between the two operands, which is the number of bit positions |
| where @var{op1} and @var{op2} have different bit values. If one operand is |
| @math{@ge{}0} and the other @math{<0} then the number of bits different is |
| infinite, and the return value is the largest possible @code{mp_bitcnt_t}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpz_scan0 (const mpz_t @var{op}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{starting_bit}) |
| @deftypefunx {mp_bitcnt_t} mpz_scan1 (const mpz_t @var{op}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{starting_bit}) |
| @cindex Bit scanning functions |
| @cindex Scan bit functions |
| Scan @var{op}, starting from bit @var{starting_bit}, towards more significant |
| bits, until the first 0 or 1 bit (respectively) is found. Return the index of |
| the found bit. |
| |
| If the bit at @var{starting_bit} is already what's sought, then |
| @var{starting_bit} is returned. |
| |
| If there's no bit found, then the largest possible @code{mp_bitcnt_t} is |
| returned. This will happen in @code{mpz_scan0} past the end of a negative |
| number, or @code{mpz_scan1} past the end of a nonnegative number. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_setbit (mpz_t @var{rop}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{bit_index}) |
| Set bit @var{bit_index} in @var{rop}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_clrbit (mpz_t @var{rop}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{bit_index}) |
| Clear bit @var{bit_index} in @var{rop}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_combit (mpz_t @var{rop}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{bit_index}) |
| Complement bit @var{bit_index} in @var{rop}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_tstbit (const mpz_t @var{op}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{bit_index}) |
| Test bit @var{bit_index} in @var{op} and return 0 or 1 accordingly. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @node I/O of Integers, Integer Random Numbers, Integer Logic and Bit Fiddling, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Input and Output Functions |
| @cindex Integer input and output functions |
| @cindex Input functions |
| @cindex Output functions |
| @cindex I/O functions |
| |
| Functions that perform input from a stdio stream, and functions that output to |
| a stdio stream, of @code{mpz} numbers. Passing a @code{NULL} pointer for a |
| @var{stream} argument to any of these functions will make them read from |
| @code{stdin} and write to @code{stdout}, respectively. |
| |
| When using any of these functions, it is a good idea to include @file{stdio.h} |
| before @file{gmp.h}, since that will allow @file{gmp.h} to define prototypes |
| for these functions. |
| |
| See also @ref{Formatted Output} and @ref{Formatted Input}. |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpz_out_str (FILE *@var{stream}, int @var{base}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Output @var{op} on stdio stream @var{stream}, as a string of digits in base |
| @var{base}. The base argument may vary from 2 to 62 or from @minus{}2 to |
| @minus{}36. |
| |
| For @var{base} in the range 2..36, digits and lower-case letters are used; for |
| @minus{}2..@minus{}36, digits and upper-case letters are used; for 37..62, |
| digits, upper-case letters, and lower-case letters (in that significance order) |
| are used. |
| |
| Return the number of bytes written, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpz_inp_str (mpz_t @var{rop}, FILE *@var{stream}, int @var{base}) |
| Input a possibly white-space preceded string in base @var{base} from stdio |
| stream @var{stream}, and put the read integer in @var{rop}. |
| |
| The @var{base} may vary from 2 to 62, or if @var{base} is 0, then the leading |
| characters are used: @code{0x} and @code{0X} for hexadecimal, @code{0b} and |
| @code{0B} for binary, @code{0} for octal, or decimal otherwise. |
| |
| For bases up to 36, case is ignored; upper-case and lower-case letters have |
| the same value. For bases 37 to 62, upper-case letter represent the usual |
| 10..35 while lower-case letter represent 36..61. |
| |
| Return the number of bytes read, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpz_out_raw (FILE *@var{stream}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Output @var{op} on stdio stream @var{stream}, in raw binary format. The |
| integer is written in a portable format, with 4 bytes of size information, and |
| that many bytes of limbs. Both the size and the limbs are written in |
| decreasing significance order (i.e., in big-endian). |
| |
| The output can be read with @code{mpz_inp_raw}. |
| |
| Return the number of bytes written, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| |
| The output of this can not be read by @code{mpz_inp_raw} from GMP 1, because |
| of changes necessary for compatibility between 32-bit and 64-bit machines. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpz_inp_raw (mpz_t @var{rop}, FILE *@var{stream}) |
| Input from stdio stream @var{stream} in the format written by |
| @code{mpz_out_raw}, and put the result in @var{rop}. Return the number of |
| bytes read, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| |
| This routine can read the output from @code{mpz_out_raw} also from GMP 1, in |
| spite of changes necessary for compatibility between 32-bit and 64-bit |
| machines. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Integer Random Numbers, Integer Import and Export, I/O of Integers, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Random Number Functions |
| @cindex Integer random number functions |
| @cindex Random number functions |
| |
| The random number functions of GMP come in two groups; older function |
| that rely on a global state, and newer functions that accept a state |
| parameter that is read and modified. Please see the @ref{Random Number |
| Functions} for more information on how to use and not to use random |
| number functions. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_urandomb (mpz_t @var{rop}, gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{n}) |
| Generate a uniformly distributed random integer in the range 0 to |
| @mm{2@sup{n}-1, 2^@var{n}@minus{}1}, inclusive. |
| |
| The variable @var{state} must be initialized by calling one of the |
| @code{gmp_randinit} functions (@ref{Random State Initialization}) before |
| invoking this function. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_urandomm (mpz_t @var{rop}, gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, const mpz_t @var{n}) |
| Generate a uniform random integer in the range 0 to @math{@var{n}-1}, |
| inclusive. |
| |
| The variable @var{state} must be initialized by calling one of the |
| @code{gmp_randinit} functions (@ref{Random State Initialization}) |
| before invoking this function. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_rrandomb (mpz_t @var{rop}, gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{n}) |
| Generate a random integer with long strings of zeros and ones in the |
| binary representation. Useful for testing functions and algorithms, |
| since this kind of random numbers have proven to be more likely to |
| trigger corner-case bugs. The random number will be in the range |
| @mm{2@sup{n-1}, 2^(@var{n}@minus{}1)} to @mm{2@sup{n}-1, |
| 2^@var{n}@minus{}1}, inclusive. |
| |
| The variable @var{state} must be initialized by calling one of the |
| @code{gmp_randinit} functions (@ref{Random State Initialization}) |
| before invoking this function. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_random (mpz_t @var{rop}, mp_size_t @var{max_size}) |
| Generate a random integer of at most @var{max_size} limbs. The generated |
| random number doesn't satisfy any particular requirements of randomness. |
| Negative random numbers are generated when @var{max_size} is negative. |
| |
| This function is obsolete. Use @code{mpz_urandomb} or |
| @code{mpz_urandomm} instead. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_random2 (mpz_t @var{rop}, mp_size_t @var{max_size}) |
| Generate a random integer of at most @var{max_size} limbs, with long strings |
| of zeros and ones in the binary representation. Useful for testing functions |
| and algorithms, since this kind of random numbers have proven to be more |
| likely to trigger corner-case bugs. Negative random numbers are generated |
| when @var{max_size} is negative. |
| |
| This function is obsolete. Use @code{mpz_rrandomb} instead. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Integer Import and Export, Miscellaneous Integer Functions, Integer Random Numbers, Integer Functions |
| @section Integer Import and Export |
| |
| @code{mpz_t} variables can be converted to and from arbitrary words of binary |
| data with the following functions. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_import (mpz_t @var{rop}, size_t @var{count}, int @var{order}, size_t @var{size}, int @var{endian}, size_t @var{nails}, const void *@var{op}) |
| @cindex Integer import |
| @cindex Import |
| Set @var{rop} from an array of word data at @var{op}. |
| |
| The parameters specify the format of the data. @var{count} many words are |
| read, each @var{size} bytes. @var{order} can be 1 for most significant word |
| first or -1 for least significant first. Within each word @var{endian} can be |
| 1 for most significant byte first, -1 for least significant first, or 0 for |
| the native endianness of the host CPU@. The most significant @var{nails} bits |
| of each word are skipped, this can be 0 to use the full words. |
| |
| There is no sign taken from the data, @var{rop} will simply be a positive |
| integer. An application can handle any sign itself, and apply it for instance |
| with @code{mpz_neg}. |
| |
| There are no data alignment restrictions on @var{op}, any address is allowed. |
| |
| Here's an example converting an array of @code{unsigned long} data, most |
| significant element first, and host byte order within each value. |
| |
| @example |
| unsigned long a[20]; |
| /* Initialize @var{z} and @var{a} */ |
| mpz_import (z, 20, 1, sizeof(a[0]), 0, 0, a); |
| @end example |
| |
| This example assumes the full @code{sizeof} bytes are used for data in the |
| given type, which is usually true, and certainly true for @code{unsigned long} |
| everywhere we know of. However on Cray vector systems it may be noted that |
| @code{short} and @code{int} are always stored in 8 bytes (and with |
| @code{sizeof} indicating that) but use only 32 or 46 bits. The @var{nails} |
| feature can account for this, by passing for instance |
| @code{8*sizeof(int)-INT_BIT}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {void *} mpz_export (void *@var{rop}, size_t *@var{countp}, int @var{order}, size_t @var{size}, int @var{endian}, size_t @var{nails}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Integer export |
| @cindex Export |
| Fill @var{rop} with word data from @var{op}. |
| |
| The parameters specify the format of the data produced. Each word will be |
| @var{size} bytes and @var{order} can be 1 for most significant word first or |
| -1 for least significant first. Within each word @var{endian} can be 1 for |
| most significant byte first, -1 for least significant first, or 0 for the |
| native endianness of the host CPU@. The most significant @var{nails} bits of |
| each word are unused and set to zero, this can be 0 to produce full words. |
| |
| The number of words produced is written to @code{*@var{countp}}, or |
| @var{countp} can be @code{NULL} to discard the count. @var{rop} must have |
| enough space for the data, or if @var{rop} is @code{NULL} then a result array |
| of the necessary size is allocated using the current GMP allocation function |
| (@pxref{Custom Allocation}). In either case the return value is the |
| destination used, either @var{rop} or the allocated block. |
| |
| If @var{op} is non-zero then the most significant word produced will be |
| non-zero. If @var{op} is zero then the count returned will be zero and |
| nothing written to @var{rop}. If @var{rop} is @code{NULL} in this case, no |
| block is allocated, just @code{NULL} is returned. |
| |
| The sign of @var{op} is ignored, just the absolute value is exported. An |
| application can use @code{mpz_sgn} to get the sign and handle it as desired. |
| (@pxref{Integer Comparisons}) |
| |
| There are no data alignment restrictions on @var{rop}, any address is allowed. |
| |
| When an application is allocating space itself the required size can be |
| determined with a calculation like the following. Since @code{mpz_sizeinbase} |
| always returns at least 1, @code{count} here will be at least one, which |
| avoids any portability problems with @code{malloc(0)}, though if @code{z} is |
| zero no space at all is actually needed (or written). |
| |
| @example |
| numb = 8*size - nail; |
| count = (mpz_sizeinbase (z, 2) + numb-1) / numb; |
| p = malloc (count * size); |
| @end example |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Miscellaneous Integer Functions, Integer Special Functions, Integer Import and Export, Integer Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Miscellaneous Functions |
| @cindex Miscellaneous integer functions |
| @cindex Integer miscellaneous functions |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpz_fits_ulong_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_fits_slong_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_fits_uint_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_fits_sint_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_fits_ushort_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_fits_sshort_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Return non-zero iff the value of @var{op} fits in an @code{unsigned long int}, |
| @code{signed long int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{signed int}, @code{unsigned |
| short int}, or @code{signed short int}, respectively. Otherwise, return zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro int mpz_odd_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefnx Macro int mpz_even_p (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Determine whether @var{op} is odd or even, respectively. Return non-zero if |
| yes, zero if no. These macros evaluate their argument more than once. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpz_sizeinbase (const mpz_t @var{op}, int @var{base}) |
| @cindex Size in digits |
| @cindex Digits in an integer |
| Return the size of @var{op} measured in number of digits in the given |
| @var{base}. @var{base} can vary from 2 to 62. The sign of @var{op} is |
| ignored, just the absolute value is used. The result will be either exact or |
| 1 too big. If @var{base} is a power of 2, the result is always exact. If |
| @var{op} is zero the return value is always 1. |
| |
| This function can be used to determine the space required when converting |
| @var{op} to a string. The right amount of allocation is normally two more |
| than the value returned by @code{mpz_sizeinbase}, one extra for a minus sign |
| and one for the null-terminator. |
| |
| @cindex Most significant bit |
| It will be noted that @code{mpz_sizeinbase(@var{op},2)} can be used to locate |
| the most significant 1 bit in @var{op}, counting from 1. (Unlike the bitwise |
| functions which start from 0, @xref{Integer Logic and Bit Fiddling,, Logical |
| and Bit Manipulation Functions}.) |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Integer Special Functions, , Miscellaneous Integer Functions, Integer Functions |
| @section Special Functions |
| @cindex Special integer functions |
| @cindex Integer special functions |
| |
| The functions in this section are for various special purposes. Most |
| applications will not need them. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_array_init (mpz_t @var{integer_array}, mp_size_t @var{array_size}, @w{mp_size_t @var{fixed_num_bits}}) |
| @strong{This is an obsolete function. Do not use it.} |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {void *} _mpz_realloc (mpz_t @var{integer}, mp_size_t @var{new_alloc}) |
| Change the space for @var{integer} to @var{new_alloc} limbs. The value in |
| @var{integer} is preserved if it fits, or is set to 0 if not. The return |
| value is not useful to applications and should be ignored. |
| |
| @code{mpz_realloc2} is the preferred way to accomplish allocation changes like |
| this. @code{mpz_realloc2} and @code{_mpz_realloc} are the same except that |
| @code{_mpz_realloc} takes its size in limbs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpz_getlimbn (const mpz_t @var{op}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Return limb number @var{n} from @var{op}. The sign of @var{op} is ignored, |
| just the absolute value is used. The least significant limb is number 0. |
| |
| @code{mpz_size} can be used to find how many limbs make up @var{op}. |
| @code{mpz_getlimbn} returns zero if @var{n} is outside the range 0 to |
| @code{mpz_size(@var{op})-1}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpz_size (const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Return the size of @var{op} measured in number of limbs. If @var{op} is zero, |
| the returned value will be zero. |
| @c (@xref{Nomenclature}, for an explanation of the concept @dfn{limb}.) |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {const mp_limb_t *} mpz_limbs_read (const mpz_t @var{x}) |
| Return a pointer to the limb array representing the absolute value of @var{x}. |
| The size of the array is @code{mpz_size(@var{x})}. Intended for read access |
| only. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_limb_t *} mpz_limbs_write (mpz_t @var{x}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| @deftypefunx {mp_limb_t *} mpz_limbs_modify (mpz_t @var{x}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Return a pointer to the limb array, intended for write access. The array is |
| reallocated as needed, to make room for @var{n} limbs. Requires @math{@var{n} |
| > 0}. The @code{mpz_limbs_modify} function returns an array that holds the old |
| absolute value of @var{x}, while @code{mpz_limbs_write} may destroy the old |
| value and return an array with unspecified contents. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpz_limbs_finish (mpz_t @var{x}, mp_size_t @var{s}) |
| Updates the internal size field of @var{x}. Used after writing to the limb |
| array pointer returned by @code{mpz_limbs_write} or @code{mpz_limbs_modify} is |
| completed. The array should contain @math{@GMPabs{@var{s}}} valid limbs, |
| representing the new absolute value for @var{x}, and the sign of @var{x} is |
| taken from the sign of @var{s}. This function never reallocates @var{x}, so |
| the limb pointer remains valid. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @c FIXME: Some more useful and less silly example? |
| @example |
| void foo (mpz_t x) |
| @{ |
| mp_size_t n, i; |
| mp_limb_t *xp; |
| |
| n = mpz_size (x); |
| xp = mpz_limbs_modify (x, 2*n); |
| for (i = 0; i < n; i++) |
| xp[n+i] = xp[n-1-i]; |
| mpz_limbs_finish (x, mpz_sgn (x) < 0 ? - 2*n : 2*n); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_srcptr mpz_roinit_n (mpz_t @var{x}, const mp_limb_t *@var{xp}, mp_size_t @var{xs}) |
| Special initialization of @var{x}, using the given limb array and size. |
| @var{x} should be treated as read-only: it can be passed safely as input to |
| any mpz function, but not as an output. The array @var{xp} must point to at |
| least a readable limb, its size is |
| @math{@GMPabs{@var{xs}}}, and the sign of @var{x} is the sign of @var{xs}. For |
| convenience, the function returns @var{x}, but cast to a const pointer type. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @example |
| void foo (mpz_t x) |
| @{ |
| static const mp_limb_t y[3] = @{ 0x1, 0x2, 0x3 @}; |
| mpz_t tmp; |
| mpz_add (x, x, mpz_roinit_n (tmp, y, 3)); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro mpz_t MPZ_ROINIT_N (mp_limb_t *@var{xp}, mp_size_t @var{xs}) |
| This macro expands to an initializer which can be assigned to an mpz_t |
| variable. The limb array @var{xp} must point to at least a readable limb, |
| moreover, unlike the @code{mpz_roinit_n} function, the array must be |
| normalized: if @var{xs} is non-zero, then |
| @code{@var{xp}[@math{@GMPabs{@var{xs}}-1}]} must be non-zero. Intended |
| primarily for constant values. Using it for non-constant values requires a C |
| compiler supporting C99. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @example |
| void foo (mpz_t x) |
| @{ |
| static const mp_limb_t ya[3] = @{ 0x1, 0x2, 0x3 @}; |
| static const mpz_t y = MPZ_ROINIT_N ((mp_limb_t *) ya, 3); |
| |
| mpz_add (x, x, y); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| |
| @node Rational Number Functions, Floating-point Functions, Integer Functions, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Rational Number Functions |
| @cindex Rational number functions |
| |
| This chapter describes the GMP functions for performing arithmetic on rational |
| numbers. These functions start with the prefix @code{mpq_}. |
| |
| Rational numbers are stored in objects of type @code{mpq_t}. |
| |
| All rational arithmetic functions assume operands have a canonical form, and |
| canonicalize their result. The canonical form means that the denominator and |
| the numerator have no common factors, and that the denominator is positive. |
| Zero has the unique representation 0/1. |
| |
| Pure assignment functions do not canonicalize the assigned variable. It is |
| the responsibility of the user to canonicalize the assigned variable before |
| any arithmetic operations are performed on that variable. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_canonicalize (mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Remove any factors that are common to the numerator and denominator of |
| @var{op}, and make the denominator positive. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @menu |
| * Initializing Rationals:: |
| * Rational Conversions:: |
| * Rational Arithmetic:: |
| * Comparing Rationals:: |
| * Applying Integer Functions:: |
| * I/O of Rationals:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Initializing Rationals, Rational Conversions, Rational Number Functions, Rational Number Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Initialization and Assignment Functions |
| @cindex Rational assignment functions |
| @cindex Assignment functions |
| @cindex Rational initialization functions |
| @cindex Initialization functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_init (mpq_t @var{x}) |
| Initialize @var{x} and set it to 0/1. Each variable should normally only be |
| initialized once, or at least cleared out (using the function @code{mpq_clear}) |
| between each initialization. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_inits (mpq_t @var{x}, ...) |
| Initialize a NULL-terminated list of @code{mpq_t} variables, and set their |
| values to 0/1. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_clear (mpq_t @var{x}) |
| Free the space occupied by @var{x}. Make sure to call this function for all |
| @code{mpq_t} variables when you are done with them. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_clears (mpq_t @var{x}, ...) |
| Free the space occupied by a NULL-terminated list of @code{mpq_t} variables. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_set (mpq_t @var{rop}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_set_z (mpq_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Assign @var{rop} from @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_set_ui (mpq_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_set_si (mpq_t @var{rop}, signed long int @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set the value of @var{rop} to @var{op1}/@var{op2}. Note that if @var{op1} and |
| @var{op2} have common factors, @var{rop} has to be passed to |
| @code{mpq_canonicalize} before any operations are performed on @var{rop}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpq_set_str (mpq_t @var{rop}, const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| Set @var{rop} from a null-terminated string @var{str} in the given @var{base}. |
| |
| The string can be an integer like ``41'' or a fraction like ``41/152''. The |
| fraction must be in canonical form (@pxref{Rational Number Functions}), or if |
| not then @code{mpq_canonicalize} must be called. |
| |
| The numerator and optional denominator are parsed the same as in |
| @code{mpz_set_str} (@pxref{Assigning Integers}). White space is allowed in |
| the string, and is simply ignored. The @var{base} can vary from 2 to 62, or |
| if @var{base} is 0 then the leading characters are used: @code{0x} or @code{0X} for hex, |
| @code{0b} or @code{0B} for binary, |
| @code{0} for octal, or decimal otherwise. Note that this is done separately |
| for the numerator and denominator, so for instance @code{0xEF/100} is 239/100, |
| whereas @code{0xEF/0x100} is 239/256. |
| |
| The return value is 0 if the entire string is a valid number, or @minus{}1 if |
| not. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_swap (mpq_t @var{rop1}, mpq_t @var{rop2}) |
| Swap the values @var{rop1} and @var{rop2} efficiently. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Rational Conversions, Rational Arithmetic, Initializing Rationals, Rational Number Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Conversion Functions |
| @cindex Rational conversion functions |
| @cindex Conversion functions |
| |
| @deftypefun double mpq_get_d (const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a @code{double}, truncating if necessary (i.e.@: rounding |
| towards zero). |
| |
| If the exponent from the conversion is too big or too small to fit a |
| @code{double} then the result is system dependent. For too big an infinity is |
| returned when available. For too small @math{0.0} is normally returned. |
| Hardware overflow, underflow and denorm traps may or may not occur. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_set_d (mpq_t @var{rop}, double @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_set_f (mpq_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to the value of @var{op}. There is no rounding, this conversion |
| is exact. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {char *} mpq_get_str (char *@var{str}, int @var{base}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a string of digits in base @var{base}. The base argument |
| may vary from 2 to 62 or from @minus{}2 to @minus{}36. The string will be of |
| the form @samp{num/den}, or if the denominator is 1 then just @samp{num}. |
| |
| For @var{base} in the range 2..36, digits and lower-case letters are used; for |
| @minus{}2..@minus{}36, digits and upper-case letters are used; for 37..62, |
| digits, upper-case letters, and lower-case letters (in that significance order) |
| are used. |
| |
| If @var{str} is @code{NULL}, the result string is allocated using the current |
| allocation function (@pxref{Custom Allocation}). The block will be |
| @code{strlen(str)+1} bytes, that being exactly enough for the string and |
| null-terminator. |
| |
| If @var{str} is not @code{NULL}, it should point to a block of storage large |
| enough for the result, that being |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_sizeinbase (mpq_numref(@var{op}), @var{base}) |
| + mpz_sizeinbase (mpq_denref(@var{op}), @var{base}) + 3 |
| @end example |
| |
| The three extra bytes are for a possible minus sign, possible slash, and the |
| null-terminator. |
| |
| A pointer to the result string is returned, being either the allocated block, |
| or the given @var{str}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Rational Arithmetic, Comparing Rationals, Rational Conversions, Rational Number Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Arithmetic Functions |
| @cindex Rational arithmetic functions |
| @cindex Arithmetic functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_add (mpq_t @var{sum}, const mpq_t @var{addend1}, const mpq_t @var{addend2}) |
| Set @var{sum} to @var{addend1} + @var{addend2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_sub (mpq_t @var{difference}, const mpq_t @var{minuend}, const mpq_t @var{subtrahend}) |
| Set @var{difference} to @var{minuend} @minus{} @var{subtrahend}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_mul (mpq_t @var{product}, const mpq_t @var{multiplier}, const mpq_t @var{multiplicand}) |
| Set @var{product} to @math{@var{multiplier} @GMPtimes{} @var{multiplicand}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_mul_2exp (mpq_t @var{rop}, const mpq_t @var{op1}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{@var{op1} \times 2^{op2}, @var{op1} times 2 raised to |
| @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_div (mpq_t @var{quotient}, const mpq_t @var{dividend}, const mpq_t @var{divisor}) |
| @cindex Division functions |
| Set @var{quotient} to @var{dividend}/@var{divisor}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_div_2exp (mpq_t @var{rop}, const mpq_t @var{op1}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{@var{op1}/2^{op2}, @var{op1} divided by 2 raised to |
| @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_neg (mpq_t @var{negated_operand}, const mpq_t @var{operand}) |
| Set @var{negated_operand} to @minus{}@var{operand}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_abs (mpq_t @var{rop}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to the absolute value of @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_inv (mpq_t @var{inverted_number}, const mpq_t @var{number}) |
| Set @var{inverted_number} to 1/@var{number}. If the new denominator is |
| zero, this routine will divide by zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @node Comparing Rationals, Applying Integer Functions, Rational Arithmetic, Rational Number Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Comparison Functions |
| @cindex Rational comparison functions |
| @cindex Comparison functions |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpq_cmp (const mpq_t @var{op1}, const mpq_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpq_cmp_z (const mpq_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| Compare @var{op1} and @var{op2}. Return a positive value if @math{@var{op1} > |
| @var{op2}}, zero if @math{@var{op1} = @var{op2}}, and a negative value if |
| @math{@var{op1} < @var{op2}}. |
| |
| To determine if two rationals are equal, @code{mpq_equal} is faster than |
| @code{mpq_cmp}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro int mpq_cmp_ui (const mpq_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{num2}, unsigned long int @var{den2}) |
| @deftypefnx Macro int mpq_cmp_si (const mpq_t @var{op1}, long int @var{num2}, unsigned long int @var{den2}) |
| Compare @var{op1} and @var{num2}/@var{den2}. Return a positive value if |
| @math{@var{op1} > @var{num2}/@var{den2}}, zero if @math{@var{op1} = |
| @var{num2}/@var{den2}}, and a negative value if @math{@var{op1} < |
| @var{num2}/@var{den2}}. |
| |
| @var{num2} and @var{den2} are allowed to have common factors. |
| |
| These functions are implemented as a macros and evaluate their arguments |
| multiple times. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro int mpq_sgn (const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Sign tests |
| @cindex Rational sign tests |
| Return @math{+1} if @math{@var{op} > 0}, 0 if @math{@var{op} = 0}, and |
| @math{-1} if @math{@var{op} < 0}. |
| |
| This function is actually implemented as a macro. It evaluates its |
| argument multiple times. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpq_equal (const mpq_t @var{op1}, const mpq_t @var{op2}) |
| Return non-zero if @var{op1} and @var{op2} are equal, zero if they are |
| non-equal. Although @code{mpq_cmp} can be used for the same purpose, this |
| function is much faster. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @node Applying Integer Functions, I/O of Rationals, Comparing Rationals, Rational Number Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Applying Integer Functions to Rationals |
| @cindex Rational numerator and denominator |
| @cindex Numerator and denominator |
| |
| The set of @code{mpq} functions is quite small. In particular, there are few |
| functions for either input or output. The following functions give direct |
| access to the numerator and denominator of an @code{mpq_t}. |
| |
| Note that if an assignment to the numerator and/or denominator could take an |
| @code{mpq_t} out of the canonical form described at the start of this chapter |
| (@pxref{Rational Number Functions}) then @code{mpq_canonicalize} must be |
| called before any other @code{mpq} functions are applied to that @code{mpq_t}. |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro mpz_t mpq_numref (const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefnx Macro mpz_t mpq_denref (const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Return a reference to the numerator and denominator of @var{op}, respectively. |
| The @code{mpz} functions can be used on the result of these macros. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_get_num (mpz_t @var{numerator}, const mpq_t @var{rational}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_get_den (mpz_t @var{denominator}, const mpq_t @var{rational}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_set_num (mpq_t @var{rational}, const mpz_t @var{numerator}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_set_den (mpq_t @var{rational}, const mpz_t @var{denominator}) |
| Get or set the numerator or denominator of a rational. These functions are |
| equivalent to calling @code{mpz_set} with an appropriate @code{mpq_numref} or |
| @code{mpq_denref}. Direct use of @code{mpq_numref} or @code{mpq_denref} is |
| recommended instead of these functions. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node I/O of Rationals, , Applying Integer Functions, Rational Number Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Input and Output Functions |
| @cindex Rational input and output functions |
| @cindex Input functions |
| @cindex Output functions |
| @cindex I/O functions |
| |
| Functions that perform input from a stdio stream, and functions that output to |
| a stdio stream, of @code{mpq} numbers. Passing a @code{NULL} pointer for a |
| @var{stream} argument to any of these functions will make them read from |
| @code{stdin} and write to @code{stdout}, respectively. |
| |
| When using any of these functions, it is a good idea to include @file{stdio.h} |
| before @file{gmp.h}, since that will allow @file{gmp.h} to define prototypes |
| for these functions. |
| |
| See also @ref{Formatted Output} and @ref{Formatted Input}. |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpq_out_str (FILE *@var{stream}, int @var{base}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Output @var{op} on stdio stream @var{stream}, as a string of digits in base |
| @var{base}. The base argument may vary from 2 to 62 or from @minus{}2 to |
| @minus{}36. Output is in the form |
| @samp{num/den} or if the denominator is 1 then just @samp{num}. |
| |
| For @var{base} in the range 2..36, digits and lower-case letters are used; for |
| @minus{}2..@minus{}36, digits and upper-case letters are used; for 37..62, |
| digits, upper-case letters, and lower-case letters (in that significance order) |
| are used. |
| |
| Return the number of bytes written, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpq_inp_str (mpq_t @var{rop}, FILE *@var{stream}, int @var{base}) |
| Read a string of digits from @var{stream} and convert them to a rational in |
| @var{rop}. Any initial white-space characters are read and discarded. Return |
| the number of characters read (including white space), or 0 if a rational |
| could not be read. |
| |
| The input can be a fraction like @samp{17/63} or just an integer like |
| @samp{123}. Reading stops at the first character not in this form, and white |
| space is not permitted within the string. If the input might not be in |
| canonical form, then @code{mpq_canonicalize} must be called (@pxref{Rational |
| Number Functions}). |
| |
| The @var{base} can be between 2 and 62, or can be 0 in which case the leading |
| characters of the string determine the base, @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} for |
| hexadecimal, @code{0b} and @code{0B} for binary, @samp{0} for octal, or |
| decimal otherwise. The leading characters |
| are examined separately for the numerator and denominator of a fraction, so |
| for instance @samp{0x10/11} is @math{16/11}, whereas @samp{0x10/0x11} is |
| @math{16/17}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Floating-point Functions, Low-level Functions, Rational Number Functions, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Floating-point Functions |
| @cindex Floating-point functions |
| @cindex Float functions |
| @cindex User-defined precision |
| @cindex Precision of floats |
| |
| GMP floating point numbers are stored in objects of type @code{mpf_t} and |
| functions operating on them have an @code{mpf_} prefix. |
| |
| The mantissa of each float has a user-selectable precision, in practice only |
| limited by available memory. Each variable has its own precision, and that can |
| be increased or decreased at any time. This selectable precision is a minimum |
| value, GMP rounds it up to a whole limb. |
| |
| The accuracy of a calculation is determined by the priorly set precision of the |
| destination variable and the numeric values of the input variables. Input |
| variables' set precisions do not affect calculations (except indirectly as |
| their values might have been affected when they were assigned). |
| |
| The exponent of each float has fixed precision, one machine word on most |
| systems. In the current implementation the exponent is a count of limbs, so |
| for example on a 32-bit system this means a range of roughly |
| @math{2^@W{-68719476768}} to @math{2^@W{68719476736}}, or on a 64-bit system |
| this will be much greater. Note however that @code{mpf_get_str} can only |
| return an exponent which fits an @code{mp_exp_t} and currently |
| @code{mpf_set_str} doesn't accept exponents bigger than a @code{long}. |
| |
| Each variable keeps track of the mantissa data actually in use. This means |
| that if a float is exactly represented in only a few bits then only those bits |
| will be used in a calculation, even if the variable's selected precision is |
| high. This is a performance optimization; it does not affect the numeric |
| results. |
| |
| Internally, GMP sometimes calculates with higher precision than that of the |
| destination variable in order to limit errors. Final results are always |
| truncated to the destination variable's precision. |
| |
| The mantissa is stored in binary. One consequence of this is that decimal |
| fractions like @math{0.1} cannot be represented exactly. The same is true of |
| plain IEEE @code{double} floats. This makes both highly unsuitable for |
| calculations involving money or other values that should be exact decimal |
| fractions. (Suitably scaled integers, or perhaps rationals, are better |
| choices.) |
| |
| The @code{mpf} functions and variables have no special notion of infinity or |
| not-a-number, and applications must take care not to overflow the exponent or |
| results will be unpredictable. |
| |
| Note that the @code{mpf} functions are @emph{not} intended as a smooth |
| extension to IEEE P754 arithmetic. In particular results obtained on one |
| computer often differ from the results on a computer with a different word |
| size. |
| |
| New projects should consider using the GMP extension library MPFR |
| (@url{http://mpfr.org}) instead. MPFR provides well-defined precision and |
| accurate rounding, and thereby naturally extends IEEE P754. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Initializing Floats:: |
| * Assigning Floats:: |
| * Simultaneous Float Init & Assign:: |
| * Converting Floats:: |
| * Float Arithmetic:: |
| * Float Comparison:: |
| * I/O of Floats:: |
| * Miscellaneous Float Functions:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Initializing Floats, Assigning Floats, Floating-point Functions, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Initialization Functions |
| @cindex Float initialization functions |
| @cindex Initialization functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_set_default_prec (mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Set the default precision to be @strong{at least} @var{prec} bits. All |
| subsequent calls to @code{mpf_init} will use this precision, but previously |
| initialized variables are unaffected. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpf_get_default_prec (void) |
| Return the default precision actually used. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| An @code{mpf_t} object must be initialized before storing the first value in |
| it. The functions @code{mpf_init} and @code{mpf_init2} are used for that |
| purpose. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_init (mpf_t @var{x}) |
| Initialize @var{x} to 0. Normally, a variable should be initialized once only |
| or at least be cleared, using @code{mpf_clear}, between initializations. The |
| precision of @var{x} is undefined unless a default precision has already been |
| established by a call to @code{mpf_set_default_prec}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_init2 (mpf_t @var{x}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Initialize @var{x} to 0 and set its precision to be @strong{at least} |
| @var{prec} bits. Normally, a variable should be initialized once only or at |
| least be cleared, using @code{mpf_clear}, between initializations. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_inits (mpf_t @var{x}, ...) |
| Initialize a NULL-terminated list of @code{mpf_t} variables, and set their |
| values to 0. The precision of the initialized variables is undefined unless a |
| default precision has already been established by a call to |
| @code{mpf_set_default_prec}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_clear (mpf_t @var{x}) |
| Free the space occupied by @var{x}. Make sure to call this function for all |
| @code{mpf_t} variables when you are done with them. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_clears (mpf_t @var{x}, ...) |
| Free the space occupied by a NULL-terminated list of @code{mpf_t} variables. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| Here is an example on how to initialize floating-point variables: |
| @example |
| @{ |
| mpf_t x, y; |
| mpf_init (x); /* use default precision */ |
| mpf_init2 (y, 256); /* precision @emph{at least} 256 bits */ |
| @dots{} |
| /* Unless the program is about to exit, do ... */ |
| mpf_clear (x); |
| mpf_clear (y); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| The following three functions are useful for changing the precision during a |
| calculation. A typical use would be for adjusting the precision gradually in |
| iterative algorithms like Newton-Raphson, making the computation precision |
| closely match the actual accurate part of the numbers. |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpf_get_prec (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Return the current precision of @var{op}, in bits. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_set_prec (mpf_t @var{rop}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Set the precision of @var{rop} to be @strong{at least} @var{prec} bits. The |
| value in @var{rop} will be truncated to the new precision. |
| |
| This function requires a call to @code{realloc}, and so should not be used in |
| a tight loop. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_set_prec_raw (mpf_t @var{rop}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Set the precision of @var{rop} to be @strong{at least} @var{prec} bits, |
| without changing the memory allocated. |
| |
| @var{prec} must be no more than the allocated precision for @var{rop}, that |
| being the precision when @var{rop} was initialized, or in the most recent |
| @code{mpf_set_prec}. |
| |
| The value in @var{rop} is unchanged, and in particular if it had a higher |
| precision than @var{prec} it will retain that higher precision. New values |
| written to @var{rop} will use the new @var{prec}. |
| |
| Before calling @code{mpf_clear} or the full @code{mpf_set_prec}, another |
| @code{mpf_set_prec_raw} call must be made to restore @var{rop} to its original |
| allocated precision. Failing to do so will have unpredictable results. |
| |
| @code{mpf_get_prec} can be used before @code{mpf_set_prec_raw} to get the |
| original allocated precision. After @code{mpf_set_prec_raw} it reflects the |
| @var{prec} value set. |
| |
| @code{mpf_set_prec_raw} is an efficient way to use an @code{mpf_t} variable at |
| different precisions during a calculation, perhaps to gradually increase |
| precision in an iteration, or just to use various different precisions for |
| different purposes during a calculation. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @need 2000 |
| @node Assigning Floats, Simultaneous Float Init & Assign, Initializing Floats, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Assignment Functions |
| @cindex Float assignment functions |
| @cindex Assignment functions |
| |
| These functions assign new values to already initialized floats |
| (@pxref{Initializing Floats}). |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_set (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_set_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_set_si (mpf_t @var{rop}, signed long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_set_d (mpf_t @var{rop}, double @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_set_z (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_set_q (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Set the value of @var{rop} from @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpf_set_str (mpf_t @var{rop}, const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| Set the value of @var{rop} from the string in @var{str}. The string is of the |
| form @samp{M@@N} or, if the base is 10 or less, alternatively @samp{MeN}. |
| @samp{M} is the mantissa and @samp{N} is the exponent. The mantissa is always |
| in the specified base. The exponent is either in the specified base or, if |
| @var{base} is negative, in decimal. The decimal point expected is taken from |
| the current locale, on systems providing @code{localeconv}. |
| |
| The argument @var{base} may be in the ranges 2 to 62, or @minus{}62 to |
| @minus{}2. Negative values are used to specify that the exponent is in |
| decimal. |
| |
| For bases up to 36, case is ignored; upper-case and lower-case letters have |
| the same value; for bases 37 to 62, upper-case letter represent the usual |
| 10..35 while lower-case letter represent 36..61. |
| |
| Unlike the corresponding @code{mpz} function, the base will not be determined |
| from the leading characters of the string if @var{base} is 0. This is so that |
| numbers like @samp{0.23} are not interpreted as octal. |
| |
| White space is allowed in the string, and is simply ignored. [This is not |
| really true; white-space is ignored in the beginning of the string and within |
| the mantissa, but not in other places, such as after a minus sign or in the |
| exponent. We are considering changing the definition of this function, making |
| it fail when there is any white-space in the input, since that makes a lot of |
| sense. Please tell us your opinion about this change. Do you really want it |
| to accept @nicode{"3 14"} as meaning 314 as it does now?] |
| |
| This function returns 0 if the entire string is a valid number in base |
| @var{base}. Otherwise it returns @minus{}1. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_swap (mpf_t @var{rop1}, mpf_t @var{rop2}) |
| Swap @var{rop1} and @var{rop2} efficiently. Both the values and the |
| precisions of the two variables are swapped. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Simultaneous Float Init & Assign, Converting Floats, Assigning Floats, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Combined Initialization and Assignment Functions |
| @cindex Float assignment functions |
| @cindex Assignment functions |
| @cindex Float initialization functions |
| @cindex Initialization functions |
| |
| For convenience, GMP provides a parallel series of initialize-and-set functions |
| which initialize the output and then store the value there. These functions' |
| names have the form @code{mpf_init_set@dots{}} |
| |
| Once the float has been initialized by any of the @code{mpf_init_set@dots{}} |
| functions, it can be used as the source or destination operand for the ordinary |
| float functions. Don't use an initialize-and-set function on a variable |
| already initialized! |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_init_set (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_init_set_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_init_set_si (mpf_t @var{rop}, signed long int @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_init_set_d (mpf_t @var{rop}, double @var{op}) |
| Initialize @var{rop} and set its value from @var{op}. |
| |
| The precision of @var{rop} will be taken from the active default precision, as |
| set by @code{mpf_set_default_prec}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpf_init_set_str (mpf_t @var{rop}, const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| Initialize @var{rop} and set its value from the string in @var{str}. See |
| @code{mpf_set_str} above for details on the assignment operation. |
| |
| Note that @var{rop} is initialized even if an error occurs. (I.e., you have to |
| call @code{mpf_clear} for it.) |
| |
| The precision of @var{rop} will be taken from the active default precision, as |
| set by @code{mpf_set_default_prec}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Converting Floats, Float Arithmetic, Simultaneous Float Init & Assign, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Conversion Functions |
| @cindex Float conversion functions |
| @cindex Conversion functions |
| |
| @deftypefun double mpf_get_d (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a @code{double}, truncating if necessary (i.e.@: rounding |
| towards zero). |
| |
| If the exponent in @var{op} is too big or too small to fit a @code{double} |
| then the result is system dependent. For too big an infinity is returned when |
| available. For too small @math{0.0} is normally returned. Hardware overflow, |
| underflow and denorm traps may or may not occur. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun double mpf_get_d_2exp (signed long int *@var{exp}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a @code{double}, truncating if necessary (i.e.@: rounding |
| towards zero), and with an exponent returned separately. |
| |
| The return value is in the range @math{0.5@le{}@GMPabs{@var{d}}<1} and the |
| exponent is stored to @code{*@var{exp}}. @m{@var{d} \times 2^{exp}, |
| @var{d} * 2^@var{exp}} is the (truncated) @var{op} value. If @var{op} is zero, |
| the return is @math{0.0} and 0 is stored to @code{*@var{exp}}. |
| |
| @cindex @code{frexp} |
| This is similar to the standard C @code{frexp} function (@pxref{Normalization |
| Functions,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun long mpf_get_si (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long} mpf_get_ui (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a @code{long} or @code{unsigned long}, truncating any |
| fraction part. If @var{op} is too big for the return type, the result is |
| undefined. |
| |
| See also @code{mpf_fits_slong_p} and @code{mpf_fits_ulong_p} |
| (@pxref{Miscellaneous Float Functions}). |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {char *} mpf_get_str (char *@var{str}, mp_exp_t *@var{expptr}, int @var{base}, size_t @var{n_digits}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Convert @var{op} to a string of digits in base @var{base}. The base argument |
| may vary from 2 to 62 or from @minus{}2 to @minus{}36. Up to @var{n_digits} |
| digits will be generated. Trailing zeros are not returned. No more digits |
| than can be accurately represented by @var{op} are ever generated. If |
| @var{n_digits} is 0 then that accurate maximum number of digits are generated. |
| |
| For @var{base} in the range 2..36, digits and lower-case letters are used; for |
| @minus{}2..@minus{}36, digits and upper-case letters are used; for 37..62, |
| digits, upper-case letters, and lower-case letters (in that significance order) |
| are used. |
| |
| If @var{str} is @code{NULL}, the result string is allocated using the current |
| allocation function (@pxref{Custom Allocation}). The block will be |
| @code{strlen(str)+1} bytes, that being exactly enough for the string and |
| null-terminator. |
| |
| If @var{str} is not @code{NULL}, it should point to a block of |
| @math{@var{n_digits} + 2} bytes, that being enough for the mantissa, a |
| possible minus sign, and a null-terminator. When @var{n_digits} is 0 to get |
| all significant digits, an application won't be able to know the space |
| required, and @var{str} should be @code{NULL} in that case. |
| |
| The generated string is a fraction, with an implicit radix point immediately |
| to the left of the first digit. The applicable exponent is written through |
| the @var{expptr} pointer. For example, the number 3.1416 would be returned as |
| string @nicode{"31416"} and exponent 1. |
| |
| When @var{op} is zero, an empty string is produced and the exponent returned |
| is 0. |
| |
| A pointer to the result string is returned, being either the allocated block |
| or the given @var{str}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Float Arithmetic, Float Comparison, Converting Floats, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Arithmetic Functions |
| @cindex Float arithmetic functions |
| @cindex Arithmetic functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_add (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_add_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @math{@var{op1} + @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_sub (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_ui_sub (mpf_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_sub_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op1} @minus{} @var{op2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_mul (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_mul_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @math{@var{op1} @GMPtimes{} @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| Division is undefined if the divisor is zero, and passing a zero divisor to the |
| divide functions will make these functions intentionally divide by zero. This |
| lets the user handle arithmetic exceptions in these functions in the same |
| manner as other arithmetic exceptions. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_div (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_ui_div (mpf_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_div_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| @cindex Division functions |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op1}/@var{op2}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_sqrt (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_sqrt_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, unsigned long int @var{op}) |
| @cindex Root extraction functions |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{\sqrt{@var{op}}, the square root of @var{op}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_pow_ui (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| @cindex Exponentiation functions |
| @cindex Powering functions |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{@var{op1}^{op2}, @var{op1} raised to the power @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_neg (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @minus{}@var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_abs (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Set @var{rop} to the absolute value of @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_mul_2exp (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{@var{op1} \times 2^{op2}, @var{op1} times 2 raised to |
| @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_div_2exp (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{op2}) |
| Set @var{rop} to @m{@var{op1}/2^{op2}, @var{op1} divided by 2 raised to |
| @var{op2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @node Float Comparison, I/O of Floats, Float Arithmetic, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Comparison Functions |
| @cindex Float comparison functions |
| @cindex Comparison functions |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpf_cmp (const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_cmp_z (const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpz_t @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_cmp_d (const mpf_t @var{op1}, double @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_cmp_ui (const mpf_t @var{op1}, unsigned long int @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_cmp_si (const mpf_t @var{op1}, signed long int @var{op2}) |
| Compare @var{op1} and @var{op2}. Return a positive value if @math{@var{op1} > |
| @var{op2}}, zero if @math{@var{op1} = @var{op2}}, and a negative value if |
| @math{@var{op1} < @var{op2}}. |
| |
| @code{mpf_cmp_d} can be called with an infinity, but results are undefined for |
| a NaN. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpf_eq (const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}, mp_bitcnt_t op3) |
| @strong{This function is mathematically ill-defined and should not be used.} |
| |
| Return non-zero if the first @var{op3} bits of @var{op1} and @var{op2} are |
| equal, zero otherwise. Note that numbers like e.g., 256 (binary 100000000) and |
| 255 (binary 11111111) will never be equal by this function's measure, and |
| furthermore that 0 will only be equal to itself. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_reldiff (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op1}, const mpf_t @var{op2}) |
| Compute the relative difference between @var{op1} and @var{op2} and store the |
| result in @var{rop}. This is @math{@GMPabs{@var{op1}-@var{op2}}/@var{op1}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro int mpf_sgn (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Sign tests |
| @cindex Float sign tests |
| Return @math{+1} if @math{@var{op} > 0}, 0 if @math{@var{op} = 0}, and |
| @math{-1} if @math{@var{op} < 0}. |
| |
| This function is actually implemented as a macro. It evaluates its argument |
| multiple times. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @node I/O of Floats, Miscellaneous Float Functions, Float Comparison, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Input and Output Functions |
| @cindex Float input and output functions |
| @cindex Input functions |
| @cindex Output functions |
| @cindex I/O functions |
| |
| Functions that perform input from a stdio stream, and functions that output to |
| a stdio stream, of @code{mpf} numbers. Passing a @code{NULL} pointer for a |
| @var{stream} argument to any of these functions will make them read from |
| @code{stdin} and write to @code{stdout}, respectively. |
| |
| When using any of these functions, it is a good idea to include @file{stdio.h} |
| before @file{gmp.h}, since that will allow @file{gmp.h} to define prototypes |
| for these functions. |
| |
| See also @ref{Formatted Output} and @ref{Formatted Input}. |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpf_out_str (FILE *@var{stream}, int @var{base}, size_t @var{n_digits}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Print @var{op} to @var{stream}, as a string of digits. Return the number of |
| bytes written, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| |
| The mantissa is prefixed with an @samp{0.} and is in the given @var{base}, |
| which may vary from 2 to 62 or from @minus{}2 to @minus{}36. An exponent is |
| then printed, separated by an @samp{e}, or if the base is greater than 10 then |
| by an @samp{@@}. The exponent is always in decimal. The decimal point follows |
| the current locale, on systems providing @code{localeconv}. |
| |
| For @var{base} in the range 2..36, digits and lower-case letters are used; for |
| @minus{}2..@minus{}36, digits and upper-case letters are used; for 37..62, |
| digits, upper-case letters, and lower-case letters (in that significance order) |
| are used. |
| |
| Up to @var{n_digits} will be printed from the mantissa, except that no more |
| digits than are accurately representable by @var{op} will be printed. |
| @var{n_digits} can be 0 to select that accurate maximum. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpf_inp_str (mpf_t @var{rop}, FILE *@var{stream}, int @var{base}) |
| Read a string in base @var{base} from @var{stream}, and put the read float in |
| @var{rop}. The string is of the form @samp{M@@N} or, if the base is 10 or |
| less, alternatively @samp{MeN}. @samp{M} is the mantissa and @samp{N} is the |
| exponent. The mantissa is always in the specified base. The exponent is |
| either in the specified base or, if @var{base} is negative, in decimal. The |
| decimal point expected is taken from the current locale, on systems providing |
| @code{localeconv}. |
| |
| The argument @var{base} may be in the ranges 2 to 36, or @minus{}36 to |
| @minus{}2. Negative values are used to specify that the exponent is in |
| decimal. |
| |
| Unlike the corresponding @code{mpz} function, the base will not be determined |
| from the leading characters of the string if @var{base} is 0. This is so that |
| numbers like @samp{0.23} are not interpreted as octal. |
| |
| Return the number of bytes read, or if an error occurred, return 0. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @c @deftypefun void mpf_out_raw (FILE *@var{stream}, const mpf_t @var{float}) |
| @c Output @var{float} on stdio stream @var{stream}, in raw binary |
| @c format. The float is written in a portable format, with 4 bytes of |
| @c size information, and that many bytes of limbs. Both the size and the |
| @c limbs are written in decreasing significance order. |
| @c @end deftypefun |
| |
| @c @deftypefun void mpf_inp_raw (mpf_t @var{float}, FILE *@var{stream}) |
| @c Input from stdio stream @var{stream} in the format written by |
| @c @code{mpf_out_raw}, and put the result in @var{float}. |
| @c @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Miscellaneous Float Functions, , I/O of Floats, Floating-point Functions |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @section Miscellaneous Functions |
| @cindex Miscellaneous float functions |
| @cindex Float miscellaneous functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_ceil (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_floor (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_trunc (mpf_t @var{rop}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @cindex Rounding functions |
| @cindex Float rounding functions |
| Set @var{rop} to @var{op} rounded to an integer. @code{mpf_ceil} rounds to the |
| next higher integer, @code{mpf_floor} to the next lower, and @code{mpf_trunc} |
| to the integer towards zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpf_integer_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Return non-zero if @var{op} is an integer. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpf_fits_ulong_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_fits_slong_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_fits_uint_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_fits_sint_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_fits_ushort_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_fits_sshort_p (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Return non-zero if @var{op} would fit in the respective C data type, when |
| truncated to an integer. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_urandomb (mpf_t @var{rop}, gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{nbits}) |
| @cindex Random number functions |
| @cindex Float random number functions |
| Generate a uniformly distributed random float in @var{rop}, such that @math{0 |
| @le{} @var{rop} < 1}, with @var{nbits} significant bits in the mantissa or |
| less if the precision of @var{rop} is smaller. |
| |
| The variable @var{state} must be initialized by calling one of the |
| @code{gmp_randinit} functions (@ref{Random State Initialization}) before |
| invoking this function. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpf_random2 (mpf_t @var{rop}, mp_size_t @var{max_size}, mp_exp_t @var{exp}) |
| Generate a random float of at most @var{max_size} limbs, with long strings of |
| zeros and ones in the binary representation. The exponent of the number is in |
| the interval @minus{}@var{exp} to @var{exp} (in limbs). This function is |
| useful for testing functions and algorithms, since these kind of random |
| numbers have proven to be more likely to trigger corner-case bugs. Negative |
| random numbers are generated when @var{max_size} is negative. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @c @deftypefun size_t mpf_size (const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| @c Return the size of @var{op} measured in number of limbs. If @var{op} is |
| @c zero, the returned value will be zero. (@xref{Nomenclature}, for an |
| @c explanation of the concept @dfn{limb}.) |
| @c |
| @c @strong{This function is obsolete. It will disappear from future GMP |
| @c releases.} |
| @c @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Low-level Functions, Random Number Functions, Floating-point Functions, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Low-level Functions |
| @cindex Low-level functions |
| |
| This chapter describes low-level GMP functions, used to implement the |
| high-level GMP functions, but also intended for time-critical user code. |
| |
| These functions start with the prefix @code{mpn_}. |
| |
| @c 1. Some of these function clobber input operands. |
| @c |
| |
| The @code{mpn} functions are designed to be as fast as possible, @strong{not} |
| to provide a coherent calling interface. The different functions have somewhat |
| similar interfaces, but there are variations that make them hard to use. These |
| functions do as little as possible apart from the real multiple precision |
| computation, so that no time is spent on things that not all callers need. |
| |
| A source operand is specified by a pointer to the least significant limb and a |
| limb count. A destination operand is specified by just a pointer. It is the |
| responsibility of the caller to ensure that the destination has enough space |
| for storing the result. |
| |
| With this way of specifying operands, it is possible to perform computations on |
| subranges of an argument, and store the result into a subrange of a |
| destination. |
| |
| A common requirement for all functions is that each source area needs at least |
| one limb. No size argument may be zero. Unless otherwise stated, in-place |
| operations are allowed where source and destination are the same, but not where |
| they only partly overlap. |
| |
| The @code{mpn} functions are the base for the implementation of the |
| @code{mpz_}, @code{mpf_}, and @code{mpq_} functions. |
| |
| This example adds the number beginning at @var{s1p} and the number beginning at |
| @var{s2p} and writes the sum at @var{destp}. All areas have @var{n} limbs. |
| |
| @example |
| cy = mpn_add_n (destp, s1p, s2p, n) |
| @end example |
| |
| It should be noted that the @code{mpn} functions make no attempt to identify |
| high or low zero limbs on their operands, or other special forms. On random |
| data such cases will be unlikely and it'd be wasteful for every function to |
| check every time. An application knowing something about its data can take |
| steps to trim or perhaps split its calculations. |
| @c |
| @c For reference, within gmp mpz_t operands never have high zero limbs, and |
| @c we rate low zero limbs as unlikely too (or something an application should |
| @c handle). This is a prime motivation for not stripping zero limbs in say |
| @c mpn_mul_n etc. |
| @c |
| @c Other applications doing variable-length calculations will quite likely do |
| @c something similar to mpz. And even if not then it's highly likely zero |
| @c limb stripping can be done at just a few judicious points, which will be |
| @c more efficient than having lots of mpn functions checking every time. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @noindent |
| In the notation used below, a source operand is identified by the pointer to |
| the least significant limb, and the limb count in braces. For example, |
| @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@}. |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_add_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Add @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the @var{n} |
| least significant limbs of the result to @var{rp}. Return carry, either 0 or |
| 1. |
| |
| This is the lowest-level function for addition. It is the preferred function |
| for addition, since it is written in assembly for most CPUs. For addition of |
| a variable to itself (i.e., @var{s1p} equals @var{s2p}) use @code{mpn_lshift} |
| with a count of 1 for optimal speed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_add_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{s2limb}) |
| Add @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @var{s2limb}, and write the @var{n} least |
| significant limbs of the result to @var{rp}. Return carry, either 0 or 1. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_add (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{s1n}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{s2n}) |
| Add @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, @var{s2n}@}, and write the |
| @var{s1n} least significant limbs of the result to @var{rp}. Return carry, |
| either 0 or 1. |
| |
| This function requires that @var{s1n} is greater than or equal to @var{s2n}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_sub_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Subtract @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@} from @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@}, and write the |
| @var{n} least significant limbs of the result to @var{rp}. Return borrow, |
| either 0 or 1. |
| |
| This is the lowest-level function for subtraction. It is the preferred |
| function for subtraction, since it is written in assembly for most CPUs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_sub_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{s2limb}) |
| Subtract @var{s2limb} from @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@}, and write the @var{n} least |
| significant limbs of the result to @var{rp}. Return borrow, either 0 or 1. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_sub (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{s1n}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{s2n}) |
| Subtract @{@var{s2p}, @var{s2n}@} from @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@}, and write the |
| @var{s1n} least significant limbs of the result to @var{rp}. Return borrow, |
| either 0 or 1. |
| |
| This function requires that @var{s1n} is greater than or equal to |
| @var{s2n}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_neg (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the negation of @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@}, and write the result to |
| @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. This is equivalent to calling @code{mpn_sub_n} with a |
| @var{n}-limb zero minuend and passing @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} as subtrahend. |
| Return borrow, either 0 or 1. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_mul_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Multiply @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the |
| 2*@var{n}-limb result to @var{rp}. |
| |
| The destination has to have space for 2*@var{n} limbs, even if the product's |
| most significant limb is zero. No overlap is permitted between the |
| destination and either source. |
| |
| If the two input operands are the same, use @code{mpn_sqr}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_mul (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{s1n}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{s2n}) |
| Multiply @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, @var{s2n}@}, and write the |
| (@var{s1n}+@var{s2n})-limb result to @var{rp}. Return the most significant |
| limb of the result. |
| |
| The destination has to have space for @var{s1n} + @var{s2n} limbs, even if the |
| product's most significant limb is zero. No overlap is permitted between the |
| destination and either source. |
| |
| This function requires that @var{s1n} is greater than or equal to @var{s2n}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_sqr (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Compute the square of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and write the 2*@var{n}-limb |
| result to @var{rp}. |
| |
| The destination has to have space for 2@var{n} limbs, even if the result's |
| most significant limb is zero. No overlap is permitted between the |
| destination and the source. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_mul_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{s2limb}) |
| Multiply @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} by @var{s2limb}, and write the @var{n} least |
| significant limbs of the product to @var{rp}. Return the most significant |
| limb of the product. @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} are |
| allowed to overlap provided @math{@var{rp} @le{} @var{s1p}}. |
| |
| This is a low-level function that is a building block for general |
| multiplication as well as other operations in GMP@. It is written in assembly |
| for most CPUs. |
| |
| Don't call this function if @var{s2limb} is a power of 2; use @code{mpn_lshift} |
| with a count equal to the logarithm of @var{s2limb} instead, for optimal speed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_addmul_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{s2limb}) |
| Multiply @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @var{s2limb}, and add the @var{n} least |
| significant limbs of the product to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} and write the result |
| to @var{rp}. Return the most significant limb of the product, plus carry-out |
| from the addition. @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} are |
| allowed to overlap provided @math{@var{rp} @le{} @var{s1p}}. |
| |
| This is a low-level function that is a building block for general |
| multiplication as well as other operations in GMP@. It is written in assembly |
| for most CPUs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_submul_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{s2limb}) |
| Multiply @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @var{s2limb}, and subtract the @var{n} |
| least significant limbs of the product from @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} and write the |
| result to @var{rp}. Return the most significant limb of the product, plus |
| borrow-out from the subtraction. @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{rp}, |
| @var{n}@} are allowed to overlap provided @math{@var{rp} @le{} @var{s1p}}. |
| |
| This is a low-level function that is a building block for general |
| multiplication and division as well as other operations in GMP@. It is written |
| in assembly for most CPUs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_tdiv_qr (mp_limb_t *@var{qp}, mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, mp_size_t @var{qxn}, const mp_limb_t *@var{np}, mp_size_t @var{nn}, const mp_limb_t *@var{dp}, mp_size_t @var{dn}) |
| Divide @{@var{np}, @var{nn}@} by @{@var{dp}, @var{dn}@} and put the quotient |
| at @{@var{qp}, @var{nn}@minus{}@var{dn}+1@} and the remainder at @{@var{rp}, |
| @var{dn}@}. The quotient is rounded towards 0. |
| |
| No overlap is permitted between arguments, except that @var{np} might equal |
| @var{rp}. The dividend size @var{nn} must be greater than or equal to divisor |
| size @var{dn}. The most significant limb of the divisor must be non-zero. The |
| @var{qxn} operand must be zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_divrem (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_size_t @var{qxn}, mp_limb_t *@var{rs2p}, mp_size_t @var{rs2n}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s3p}, mp_size_t @var{s3n}) |
| [This function is obsolete. Please call @code{mpn_tdiv_qr} instead for best |
| performance.] |
| |
| Divide @{@var{rs2p}, @var{rs2n}@} by @{@var{s3p}, @var{s3n}@}, and write the |
| quotient at @var{r1p}, with the exception of the most significant limb, which |
| is returned. The remainder replaces the dividend at @var{rs2p}; it will be |
| @var{s3n} limbs long (i.e., as many limbs as the divisor). |
| |
| In addition to an integer quotient, @var{qxn} fraction limbs are developed, and |
| stored after the integral limbs. For most usages, @var{qxn} will be zero. |
| |
| It is required that @var{rs2n} is greater than or equal to @var{s3n}. It is |
| required that the most significant bit of the divisor is set. |
| |
| If the quotient is not needed, pass @var{rs2p} + @var{s3n} as @var{r1p}. Aside |
| from that special case, no overlap between arguments is permitted. |
| |
| Return the most significant limb of the quotient, either 0 or 1. |
| |
| The area at @var{r1p} needs to be @var{rs2n} @minus{} @var{s3n} + @var{qxn} |
| limbs large. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefn Function mp_limb_t mpn_divrem_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_size_t @var{qxn}, @w{mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}}, mp_size_t @var{s2n}, mp_limb_t @var{s3limb}) |
| @deftypefnx Macro mp_limb_t mpn_divmod_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, @w{mp_size_t @var{s2n}}, @w{mp_limb_t @var{s3limb}}) |
| Divide @{@var{s2p}, @var{s2n}@} by @var{s3limb}, and write the quotient at |
| @var{r1p}. Return the remainder. |
| |
| The integer quotient is written to @{@var{r1p}+@var{qxn}, @var{s2n}@} and in |
| addition @var{qxn} fraction limbs are developed and written to @{@var{r1p}, |
| @var{qxn}@}. Either or both @var{s2n} and @var{qxn} can be zero. For most |
| usages, @var{qxn} will be zero. |
| |
| @code{mpn_divmod_1} exists for upward source compatibility and is simply a |
| macro calling @code{mpn_divrem_1} with a @var{qxn} of 0. |
| |
| The areas at @var{r1p} and @var{s2p} have to be identical or completely |
| separate, not partially overlapping. |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_divmod (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_limb_t *@var{rs2p}, mp_size_t @var{rs2n}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s3p}, mp_size_t @var{s3n}) |
| [This function is obsolete. Please call @code{mpn_tdiv_qr} instead for best |
| performance.] |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_divexact_1 (mp_limb_t * @var{rp}, const mp_limb_t * @var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{d}) |
| Divide @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} by @var{d}, expecting it to divide exactly, and |
| writing the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. If @var{d} doesn't divide |
| exactly, the value written to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} is undefined. The areas at |
| @var{rp} and @var{sp} have to be identical or completely separate, not |
| partially overlapping. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefn Macro mp_limb_t mpn_divexact_by3 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, @w{mp_size_t @var{n}}) |
| @deftypefnx Function mp_limb_t mpn_divexact_by3c (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, @w{mp_size_t @var{n}}, mp_limb_t @var{carry}) |
| Divide @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} by 3, expecting it to divide exactly, and writing |
| the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. If 3 divides exactly, the return value is |
| zero and the result is the quotient. If not, the return value is non-zero and |
| the result won't be anything useful. |
| |
| @code{mpn_divexact_by3c} takes an initial carry parameter, which can be the |
| return value from a previous call, so a large calculation can be done piece by |
| piece from low to high. @code{mpn_divexact_by3} is simply a macro calling |
| @code{mpn_divexact_by3c} with a 0 carry parameter. |
| |
| These routines use a multiply-by-inverse and will be faster than |
| @code{mpn_divrem_1} on CPUs with fast multiplication but slow division. |
| |
| The source @math{a}, result @math{q}, size @math{n}, initial carry @math{i}, |
| and return value @math{c} satisfy @m{cb^n+a-i=3q, c*b^n + a-i = 3*q}, where |
| @m{b=2\GMPraise{@code{GMP\_NUMB\_BITS}}, b=2^GMP_NUMB_BITS}. The |
| return @math{c} is always 0, 1 or 2, and the initial carry @math{i} must also |
| be 0, 1 or 2 (these are both borrows really). When @math{c=0} clearly |
| @math{q=(a-i)/3}. When @m{c \neq 0, c!=0}, the remainder @math{(a-i) @bmod{} |
| 3} is given by @math{3-c}, because @math{b @equiv{} 1 @bmod{} 3} (when |
| @code{mp_bits_per_limb} is even, which is always so currently). |
| @end deftypefn |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_mod_1 (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{s1n}, mp_limb_t @var{s2limb}) |
| Divide @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@} by @var{s2limb}, and return the remainder. |
| @var{s1n} can be zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_lshift (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}, unsigned int @var{count}) |
| Shift @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} left by @var{count} bits, and write the result to |
| @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. The bits shifted out at the left are returned in the |
| least significant @var{count} bits of the return value (the rest of the return |
| value is zero). |
| |
| @var{count} must be in the range 1 to @nicode{mp_bits_per_limb}@minus{}1. The |
| regions @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} may overlap, provided |
| @math{@var{rp} @ge{} @var{sp}}. |
| |
| This function is written in assembly for most CPUs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_rshift (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}, unsigned int @var{count}) |
| Shift @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} right by @var{count} bits, and write the result to |
| @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. The bits shifted out at the right are returned in the |
| most significant @var{count} bits of the return value (the rest of the return |
| value is zero). |
| |
| @var{count} must be in the range 1 to @nicode{mp_bits_per_limb}@minus{}1. The |
| regions @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@} may overlap, provided |
| @math{@var{rp} @le{} @var{sp}}. |
| |
| This function is written in assembly for most CPUs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpn_cmp (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Compare @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@} and return a |
| positive value if @math{@var{s1} > @var{s2}}, 0 if they are equal, or a |
| negative value if @math{@var{s1} < @var{s2}}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpn_zero_p (const mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Test @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} and return 1 if the operand is zero, 0 otherwise. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_size_t mpn_gcd (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, mp_limb_t *@var{xp}, mp_size_t @var{xn}, mp_limb_t *@var{yp}, mp_size_t @var{yn}) |
| Set @{@var{rp}, @var{retval}@} to the greatest common divisor of @{@var{xp}, |
| @var{xn}@} and @{@var{yp}, @var{yn}@}. The result can be up to @var{yn} limbs, |
| the return value is the actual number produced. Both source operands are |
| destroyed. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{xn} @ge @var{yn} > 0}, the most significant |
| limb of @{@var{yp}, @var{yn}@} must be non-zero, and at least one of |
| the two operands must be odd. No overlap is permitted |
| between @{@var{xp}, @var{xn}@} and @{@var{yp}, @var{yn}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_gcd_1 (const mp_limb_t *@var{xp}, mp_size_t @var{xn}, mp_limb_t @var{ylimb}) |
| Return the greatest common divisor of @{@var{xp}, @var{xn}@} and @var{ylimb}. |
| Both operands must be non-zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_size_t mpn_gcdext (mp_limb_t *@var{gp}, mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t *@var{sn}, mp_limb_t *@var{up}, mp_size_t @var{un}, mp_limb_t *@var{vp}, mp_size_t @var{vn}) |
| Let @m{U,@var{U}} be defined by @{@var{up}, @var{un}@} and let @m{V,@var{V}} be |
| defined by @{@var{vp}, @var{vn}@}. |
| |
| Compute the greatest common divisor @math{G} of @math{U} and @math{V}. Compute |
| a cofactor @math{S} such that @math{G = US + VT}. The second cofactor @var{T} |
| is not computed but can easily be obtained from @m{(G - US) / V, (@var{G} - |
| @var{U}*@var{S}) / @var{V}} (the division will be exact). It is required that |
| @math{@var{un} @ge @var{vn} > 0}, and the most significant |
| limb of @{@var{vp}, @var{vn}@} must be non-zero. |
| |
| @math{S} satisfies @math{S = 1} or @math{@GMPabs{S} < V / (2 G)}. @math{S = |
| 0} if and only if @math{V} divides @math{U} (i.e., @math{G = V}). |
| |
| Store @math{G} at @var{gp} and let the return value define its limb count. |
| Store @math{S} at @var{sp} and let |*@var{sn}| define its limb count. @math{S} |
| can be negative; when this happens *@var{sn} will be negative. The area at |
| @var{gp} should have room for @var{vn} limbs and the area at @var{sp} should |
| have room for @math{@var{vn}+1} limbs. |
| |
| Both source operands are destroyed. |
| |
| Compatibility notes: GMP 4.3.0 and 4.3.1 defined @math{S} less strictly. |
| Earlier as well as later GMP releases define @math{S} as described here. |
| GMP releases before GMP 4.3.0 required additional space for both input and output |
| areas. More precisely, the areas @{@var{up}, @math{@var{un}+1}@} and |
| @{@var{vp}, @math{@var{vn}+1}@} were destroyed (i.e.@: the operands plus an |
| extra limb past the end of each), and the areas pointed to by @var{gp} and |
| @var{sp} should each have room for @math{@var{un}+1} limbs. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_size_t mpn_sqrtrem (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_limb_t *@var{r2p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Compute the square root of @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} and put the result at |
| @{@var{r1p}, @math{@GMPceil{@var{n}/2}}@} and the remainder at @{@var{r2p}, |
| @var{retval}@}. @var{r2p} needs space for @var{n} limbs, but the return value |
| indicates how many are produced. |
| |
| The most significant limb of @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} must be non-zero. The |
| areas @{@var{r1p}, @math{@GMPceil{@var{n}/2}}@} and @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@} must |
| be completely separate. The areas @{@var{r2p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{sp}, |
| @var{n}@} must be either identical or completely separate. |
| |
| If the remainder is not wanted then @var{r2p} can be @code{NULL}, and in this |
| case the return value is zero or non-zero according to whether the remainder |
| would have been zero or non-zero. |
| |
| A return value of zero indicates a perfect square. See also |
| @code{mpn_perfect_square_p}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun size_t mpn_sizeinbase (const mp_limb_t *@var{xp}, mp_size_t @var{n}, int @var{base}) |
| Return the size of @{@var{xp},@var{n}@} measured in number of digits in the |
| given @var{base}. @var{base} can vary from 2 to 62. Requires @math{@var{n} > 0} |
| and @math{@var{xp}[@var{n}-1] > 0}. The result will be either exact or |
| 1 too big. If @var{base} is a power of 2, the result is always exact. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_size_t mpn_get_str (unsigned char *@var{str}, int @var{base}, mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{s1n}) |
| Convert @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@} to a raw unsigned char array at @var{str} in |
| base @var{base}, and return the number of characters produced. There may be |
| leading zeros in the string. The string is not in ASCII; to convert it to |
| printable format, add the ASCII codes for @samp{0} or @samp{A}, depending on |
| the base and range. @var{base} can vary from 2 to 256. |
| |
| The most significant limb of the input @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@} must be |
| non-zero. The input @{@var{s1p}, @var{s1n}@} is clobbered, except when |
| @var{base} is a power of 2, in which case it's unchanged. |
| |
| The area at @var{str} has to have space for the largest possible number |
| represented by a @var{s1n} long limb array, plus one extra character. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_size_t mpn_set_str (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const unsigned char *@var{str}, size_t @var{strsize}, int @var{base}) |
| Convert bytes @{@var{str},@var{strsize}@} in the given @var{base} to limbs at |
| @var{rp}. |
| |
| @math{@var{str}[0]} is the most significant input byte and |
| @math{@var{str}[@var{strsize}-1]} is the least significant input byte. Each |
| byte should be a value in the range 0 to @math{@var{base}-1}, not an ASCII |
| character. @var{base} can vary from 2 to 256. |
| |
| The converted value is @{@var{rp},@var{rn}@} where @var{rn} is the return |
| value. If the most significant input byte @math{@var{str}[0]} is non-zero, |
| then @math{@var{rp}[@var{rn}-1]} will be non-zero, else |
| @math{@var{rp}[@var{rn}-1]} and some number of subsequent limbs may be zero. |
| |
| The area at @var{rp} has to have space for the largest possible number with |
| @var{strsize} digits in the chosen base, plus one extra limb. |
| |
| The input must have at least one byte, and no overlap is permitted between |
| @{@var{str},@var{strsize}@} and the result at @var{rp}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpn_scan0 (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{bit}) |
| Scan @var{s1p} from bit position @var{bit} for the next clear bit. |
| |
| It is required that there be a clear bit within the area at @var{s1p} at or |
| beyond bit position @var{bit}, so that the function has something to return. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpn_scan1 (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{bit}) |
| Scan @var{s1p} from bit position @var{bit} for the next set bit. |
| |
| It is required that there be a set bit within the area at @var{s1p} at or |
| beyond bit position @var{bit}, so that the function has something to return. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_random (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_size_t @var{r1n}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpn_random2 (mp_limb_t *@var{r1p}, mp_size_t @var{r1n}) |
| Generate a random number of length @var{r1n} and store it at @var{r1p}. The |
| most significant limb is always non-zero. @code{mpn_random} generates |
| uniformly distributed limb data, @code{mpn_random2} generates long strings of |
| zeros and ones in the binary representation. |
| |
| @code{mpn_random2} is intended for testing the correctness of the @code{mpn} |
| routines. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpn_popcount (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Count the number of set bits in @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpn_hamdist (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Compute the hamming distance between @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, |
| @var{n}@}, which is the number of bit positions where the two operands have |
| different bit values. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpn_perfect_square_p (const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Return non-zero iff @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} is a perfect square. |
| The most significant limb of the input @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} must be |
| non-zero. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_and_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical and of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, |
| @var{n}@}, and write the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_ior_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical inclusive or of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and |
| @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_xor_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical exclusive or of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and |
| @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_andn_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical and of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and the bitwise |
| complement of @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_iorn_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical inclusive or of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and the bitwise |
| complement of @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_nand_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical and of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and @{@var{s2p}, |
| @var{n}@}, and write the bitwise complement of the result to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_nior_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical inclusive or of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and |
| @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the bitwise complement of the result to |
| @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_xnor_n (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise logical exclusive or of @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} and |
| @{@var{s2p}, @var{n}@}, and write the bitwise complement of the result to |
| @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_com (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{sp}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Perform the bitwise complement of @{@var{sp}, @var{n}@}, and write the result |
| to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_copyi (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Copy from @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}, increasingly. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_copyd (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Copy from @{@var{s1p}, @var{n}@} to @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}, decreasingly. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_zero (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Zero @{@var{rp}, @var{n}@}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @section Low-level functions for cryptography |
| @cindex Low-level functions for cryptography |
| @cindex Cryptography functions, low-level |
| |
| The functions prefixed with @code{mpn_sec_} and @code{mpn_cnd_} are designed to |
| perform the exact same low-level operations and have the same cache access |
| patterns for any two same-size arguments, assuming that function arguments are |
| placed at the same position and that the machine state is identical upon |
| function entry. These functions are intended for cryptographic purposes, where |
| resilience to side-channel attacks is desired. |
| |
| These functions are less efficient than their ``leaky'' counterparts; their |
| performance for operands of the sizes typically used for cryptographic |
| applications is between 15% and 100% worse. For larger operands, these |
| functions might be inadequate, since they rely on asymptotically elementary |
| algorithms. |
| |
| These functions do not make any explicit allocations. Those of these functions |
| that need scratch space accept a scratch space operand. This convention allows |
| callers to keep sensitive data in designated memory areas. Note however that |
| compilers may choose to spill scalar values used within these functions to |
| their stack frame and that such scalars may contain sensitive data. |
| |
| In addition to these specially crafted functions, the following @code{mpn} |
| functions are naturally side-channel resistant: @code{mpn_add_n}, |
| @code{mpn_sub_n}, @code{mpn_lshift}, @code{mpn_rshift}, @code{mpn_zero}, |
| @code{mpn_copyi}, @code{mpn_copyd}, @code{mpn_com}, and the logical function |
| (@code{mpn_and_n}, etc). |
| |
| There are some exceptions from the side-channel resilience: (1) Some assembly |
| implementations of @code{mpn_lshift} identify shift-by-one as a special case. |
| This is a problem iff the shift count is a function of sensitive data. (2) |
| Alpha ev6 and Pentium4 using 64-bit limbs have leaky @code{mpn_add_n} and |
| @code{mpn_sub_n}. (3) Alpha ev6 has a leaky @code{mpn_mul_1} which also makes |
| @code{mpn_sec_mul} on those systems unsafe. |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_cnd_add_n (mp_limb_t @var{cnd}, mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_limb_t mpn_cnd_sub_n (mp_limb_t @var{cnd}, mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s1p}, const mp_limb_t *@var{s2p}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| These functions do conditional addition and subtraction. If @var{cnd} is |
| non-zero, they produce the same result as a regular @code{mpn_add_n} or |
| @code{mpn_sub_n}, and if @var{cnd} is zero, they copy @{@var{s1p},@var{n}@} to |
| the result area and return zero. The functions are designed to have timing and |
| memory access patterns depending only on size and location of the data areas, |
| but independent of the condition @var{cnd}. Like for @code{mpn_add_n} and |
| @code{mpn_sub_n}, on most machines, the timing will also be independent of the |
| actual limb values. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_sec_add_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{ap}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{b}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_limb_t mpn_sec_sub_1 (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{ap}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t @var{b}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| Set @var{R} to @var{A} + @var{b} or @var{A} - @var{b}, respectively, where |
| @var{R} = @{@var{rp},@var{n}@}, @var{A} = @{@var{ap},@var{n}@}, and @var{b} is |
| a single limb. Returns carry. |
| |
| These functions take @math{O(N)} time, unlike the leaky functions |
| @code{mpn_add_1} which are @math{O(1)} on average. They require scratch space |
| of @code{mpn_sec_add_1_itch(@var{n})} and @code{mpn_sec_sub_1_itch(@var{n})} |
| limbs, respectively, to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. The scratch space |
| requirements are guaranteed to be at most @var{n} limbs, and increase |
| monotonously in the operand size. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_cnd_swap (mp_limb_t @var{cnd}, volatile mp_limb_t *@var{ap}, volatile mp_limb_t *@var{bp}, mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| If @var{cnd} is non-zero, swaps the contents of the areas @{@var{ap},@var{n}@} |
| and @{@var{bp},@var{n}@}. Otherwise, the areas are left unmodified. |
| Implemented using logical operations on the limbs, with the same memory |
| accesses independent of the value of @var{cnd}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_sec_mul (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{ap}, mp_size_t @var{an}, const mp_limb_t *@var{bp}, mp_size_t @var{bn}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_size_t mpn_sec_mul_itch (mp_size_t @var{an}, mp_size_t @var{bn}) |
| Set @var{R} to @math{A @times{} B}, where @var{A} = @{@var{ap},@var{an}@}, |
| @var{B} = @{@var{bp},@var{bn}@}, and @var{R} = |
| @{@var{rp},@math{@var{an}+@var{bn}}@}. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{an} @ge @var{bn} > 0}. |
| |
| No overlapping between @var{R} and the input operands is allowed. For |
| @math{@var{A} = @var{B}}, use @code{mpn_sec_sqr} for optimal performance. |
| |
| This function requires scratch space of @code{mpn_sec_mul_itch(@var{an}, |
| @var{bn})} limbs to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. The scratch space |
| requirements are guaranteed to increase monotonously in the operand sizes. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_sec_sqr (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{ap}, mp_size_t @var{an}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_size_t mpn_sec_sqr_itch (mp_size_t @var{an}) |
| Set @var{R} to @math{A^2}, where @var{A} = @{@var{ap},@var{an}@}, and @var{R} = |
| @{@var{rp},@math{2@var{an}}@}. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{an} > 0}. |
| |
| No overlapping between @var{R} and the input operands is allowed. |
| |
| This function requires scratch space of @code{mpn_sec_sqr_itch(@var{an})} limbs |
| to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. The scratch space requirements are |
| guaranteed to increase monotonously in the operand size. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_sec_powm (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{bp}, mp_size_t @var{bn}, const mp_limb_t *@var{ep}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{enb}, const mp_limb_t *@var{mp}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_size_t mpn_sec_powm_itch (mp_size_t @var{bn}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{enb}, size_t @var{n}) |
| Set @var{R} to @m{B^E \bmod @var{M}, (@var{B} raised to @var{E}) modulo |
| @var{M}}, where @var{R} = @{@var{rp},@var{n}@}, @var{M} = @{@var{mp},@var{n}@}, |
| and @var{E} = @{@var{ep},@math{@GMPceil{@var{enb} / |
| @code{GMP\_NUMB\_BITS}}}@}. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{B} > 0}, that @math{@var{M} > 0} is odd, and |
| that @m{@var{E} < 2@GMPraise{@var{enb}}, @var{E} < 2^@var{enb}}, with @math{@var{enb} > 0}. |
| |
| No overlapping between @var{R} and the input operands is allowed. |
| |
| This function requires scratch space of @code{mpn_sec_powm_itch(@var{bn}, |
| @var{enb}, @var{n})} limbs to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. The scratch |
| space requirements are guaranteed to increase monotonously in the operand |
| sizes. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_sec_tabselect (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, const mp_limb_t *@var{tab}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_size_t @var{nents}, mp_size_t @var{which}) |
| Select entry @var{which} from table @var{tab}, which has @var{nents} entries, each @var{n} |
| limbs. Store the selected entry at @var{rp}. |
| |
| This function reads the entire table to avoid side-channel information leaks. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mp_limb_t mpn_sec_div_qr (mp_limb_t *@var{qp}, mp_limb_t *@var{np}, mp_size_t @var{nn}, const mp_limb_t *@var{dp}, mp_size_t @var{dn}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_size_t mpn_sec_div_qr_itch (mp_size_t @var{nn}, mp_size_t @var{dn}) |
| |
| Set @var{Q} to @m{\lfloor @var{N} / @var{D}\rfloor, the truncated quotient |
| @var{N} / @var{D}} and @var{R} to @m{@var{N} \bmod @var{D}, @var{N} modulo |
| @var{D}}, where @var{N} = @{@var{np},@var{nn}@}, @var{D} = |
| @{@var{dp},@var{dn}@}, @var{Q}'s most significant limb is the function return |
| value and the remaining limbs are @{@var{qp},@var{nn-dn}@}, and @var{R} = |
| @{@var{np},@var{dn}@}. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{nn} @ge @var{dn} @ge 1}, and that |
| @m{@var{dp}[@var{dn}-1] @neq 0, @var{dp}[@var{dn}-1] != 0}. This does not |
| imply that @math{@var{N} @ge @var{D}} since @var{N} might be zero-padded. |
| |
| Note the overlapping between @var{N} and @var{R}. No other operand overlapping |
| is allowed. The entire space occupied by @var{N} is overwritten. |
| |
| This function requires scratch space of @code{mpn_sec_div_qr_itch(@var{nn}, |
| @var{dn})} limbs to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpn_sec_div_r (mp_limb_t *@var{np}, mp_size_t @var{nn}, const mp_limb_t *@var{dp}, mp_size_t @var{dn}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_size_t mpn_sec_div_r_itch (mp_size_t @var{nn}, mp_size_t @var{dn}) |
| |
| Set @var{R} to @m{@var{N} \bmod @var{D}, @var{N} modulo @var{D}}, where @var{N} |
| = @{@var{np},@var{nn}@}, @var{D} = @{@var{dp},@var{dn}@}, and @var{R} = |
| @{@var{np},@var{dn}@}. |
| |
| It is required that @math{@var{nn} @ge @var{dn} @ge 1}, and that |
| @m{@var{dp}[@var{dn}-1] @neq 0, @var{dp}[@var{dn}-1] != 0}. This does not |
| imply that @math{@var{N} @ge @var{D}} since @var{N} might be zero-padded. |
| |
| Note the overlapping between @var{N} and @var{R}. No other operand overlapping |
| is allowed. The entire space occupied by @var{N} is overwritten. |
| |
| This function requires scratch space of @code{mpn_sec_div_r_itch(@var{nn}, |
| @var{dn})} limbs to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int mpn_sec_invert (mp_limb_t *@var{rp}, mp_limb_t *@var{ap}, const mp_limb_t *@var{mp}, mp_size_t @var{n}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{nbcnt}, mp_limb_t *@var{tp}) |
| @deftypefunx mp_size_t mpn_sec_invert_itch (mp_size_t @var{n}) |
| Set @var{R} to @m{@var{A}^{-1} \bmod @var{M}, the inverse of @var{A} modulo |
| @var{M}}, where @var{R} = @{@var{rp},@var{n}@}, @var{A} = @{@var{ap},@var{n}@}, |
| and @var{M} = @{@var{mp},@var{n}@}. @strong{This function's interface is |
| preliminary.} |
| |
| If an inverse exists, return 1, otherwise return 0 and leave @var{R} |
| undefined. In either case, the input @var{A} is destroyed. |
| |
| It is required that @var{M} is odd, and that @math{@var{nbcnt} @ge |
| @GMPceil{\log(@var{A}+1)} + @GMPceil{\log(@var{M}+1)}}. A safe choice is |
| @m{@var{nbcnt} = 2@var{n} @times{} @code{GMP\_NUMB\_BITS}, @var{nbcnt} = 2 |
| @times{} @var{n} @times{} GMP_NUMB_BITS}, but a smaller value might improve |
| performance if @var{M} or @var{A} are known to have leading zero bits. |
| |
| This function requires scratch space of @code{mpn_sec_invert_itch(@var{n})} |
| limbs to be passed in the @var{tp} parameter. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @section Nails |
| @cindex Nails |
| |
| @strong{Everything in this section is highly experimental and may disappear or |
| be subject to incompatible changes in a future version of GMP.} |
| |
| Nails are an experimental feature whereby a few bits are left unused at the |
| top of each @code{mp_limb_t}. This can significantly improve carry handling |
| on some processors. |
| |
| All the @code{mpn} functions accepting limb data will expect the nail bits to |
| be zero on entry, and will return data with the nails similarly all zero. |
| This applies both to limb vectors and to single limb arguments. |
| |
| Nails can be enabled by configuring with @samp{--enable-nails}. By default |
| the number of bits will be chosen according to what suits the host processor, |
| but a particular number can be selected with @samp{--enable-nails=N}. |
| |
| At the mpn level, a nail build is neither source nor binary compatible with a |
| non-nail build, strictly speaking. But programs acting on limbs only through |
| the mpn functions are likely to work equally well with either build, and |
| judicious use of the definitions below should make any program compatible with |
| either build, at the source level. |
| |
| For the higher level routines, meaning @code{mpz} etc, a nail build should be |
| fully source and binary compatible with a non-nail build. |
| |
| @defmac GMP_NAIL_BITS |
| @defmacx GMP_NUMB_BITS |
| @defmacx GMP_LIMB_BITS |
| @code{GMP_NAIL_BITS} is the number of nail bits, or 0 when nails are not in |
| use. @code{GMP_NUMB_BITS} is the number of data bits in a limb. |
| @code{GMP_LIMB_BITS} is the total number of bits in an @code{mp_limb_t}. In |
| all cases |
| |
| @example |
| GMP_LIMB_BITS == GMP_NAIL_BITS + GMP_NUMB_BITS |
| @end example |
| @end defmac |
| |
| @defmac GMP_NAIL_MASK |
| @defmacx GMP_NUMB_MASK |
| Bit masks for the nail and number parts of a limb. @code{GMP_NAIL_MASK} is 0 |
| when nails are not in use. |
| |
| @code{GMP_NAIL_MASK} is not often needed, since the nail part can be obtained |
| with @code{x >> GMP_NUMB_BITS}, and that means one less large constant, which |
| can help various RISC chips. |
| @end defmac |
| |
| @defmac GMP_NUMB_MAX |
| The maximum value that can be stored in the number part of a limb. This is |
| the same as @code{GMP_NUMB_MASK}, but can be used for clarity when doing |
| comparisons rather than bit-wise operations. |
| @end defmac |
| |
| The term ``nails'' comes from finger or toe nails, which are at the ends of a |
| limb (arm or leg). ``numb'' is short for number, but is also how the |
| developers felt after trying for a long time to come up with sensible names |
| for these things. |
| |
| In the future (the distant future most likely) a non-zero nail might be |
| permitted, giving non-unique representations for numbers in a limb vector. |
| This would help vector processors since carries would only ever need to |
| propagate one or two limbs. |
| |
| |
| @node Random Number Functions, Formatted Output, Low-level Functions, Top |
| @chapter Random Number Functions |
| @cindex Random number functions |
| |
| Sequences of pseudo-random numbers in GMP are generated using a variable of |
| type @code{gmp_randstate_t}, which holds an algorithm selection and a current |
| state. Such a variable must be initialized by a call to one of the |
| @code{gmp_randinit} functions, and can be seeded with one of the |
| @code{gmp_randseed} functions. |
| |
| The functions actually generating random numbers are described in @ref{Integer |
| Random Numbers}, and @ref{Miscellaneous Float Functions}. |
| |
| The older style random number functions don't accept a @code{gmp_randstate_t} |
| parameter but instead share a global variable of that type. They use a |
| default algorithm and are currently not seeded (though perhaps that will |
| change in the future). The new functions accepting a @code{gmp_randstate_t} |
| are recommended for applications that care about randomness. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Random State Initialization:: |
| * Random State Seeding:: |
| * Random State Miscellaneous:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Random State Initialization, Random State Seeding, Random Number Functions, Random Number Functions |
| @section Random State Initialization |
| @cindex Random number state |
| @cindex Initialization functions |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randinit_default (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}) |
| Initialize @var{state} with a default algorithm. This will be a compromise |
| between speed and randomness, and is recommended for applications with no |
| special requirements. Currently this is @code{gmp_randinit_mt}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randinit_mt (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}) |
| @cindex Mersenne twister random numbers |
| Initialize @var{state} for a Mersenne Twister algorithm. This algorithm is |
| fast and has good randomness properties. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randinit_lc_2exp (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, const mpz_t @var{a}, @w{unsigned long @var{c}}, @w{mp_bitcnt_t @var{m2exp}}) |
| @cindex Linear congruential random numbers |
| Initialize @var{state} with a linear congruential algorithm @m{X = (@var{a}X + |
| @var{c}) @bmod 2^{m2exp}, X = (@var{a}*X + @var{c}) mod 2^@var{m2exp}}. |
| |
| The low bits of @math{X} in this algorithm are not very random. The least |
| significant bit will have a period no more than 2, and the second bit no more |
| than 4, etc. For this reason only the high half of each @math{X} is actually |
| used. |
| |
| When a random number of more than @math{@var{m2exp}/2} bits is to be |
| generated, multiple iterations of the recurrence are used and the results |
| concatenated. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_randinit_lc_2exp_size (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{size}) |
| @cindex Linear congruential random numbers |
| Initialize @var{state} for a linear congruential algorithm as per |
| @code{gmp_randinit_lc_2exp}. @var{a}, @var{c} and @var{m2exp} are selected |
| from a table, chosen so that @var{size} bits (or more) of each @math{X} will |
| be used, i.e.@: @math{@var{m2exp}/2 @ge{} @var{size}}. |
| |
| If successful the return value is non-zero. If @var{size} is bigger than the |
| table data provides then the return value is zero. The maximum @var{size} |
| currently supported is 128. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randinit_set (gmp_randstate_t @var{rop}, gmp_randstate_t @var{op}) |
| Initialize @var{rop} with a copy of the algorithm and state from @var{op}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @c Although gmp_randinit, gmp_errno and related constants are obsolete, we |
| @c still put @findex entries for them, since they're still documented and |
| @c someone might be looking them up when perusing old application code. |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randinit (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, @w{gmp_randalg_t @var{alg}}, @dots{}) |
| @strong{This function is obsolete.} |
| |
| @findex GMP_RAND_ALG_LC |
| @findex GMP_RAND_ALG_DEFAULT |
| Initialize @var{state} with an algorithm selected by @var{alg}. The only |
| choice is @code{GMP_RAND_ALG_LC}, which is @code{gmp_randinit_lc_2exp_size} |
| described above. A third parameter of type @code{unsigned long} is required, |
| this is the @var{size} for that function. @code{GMP_RAND_ALG_DEFAULT} or 0 |
| are the same as @code{GMP_RAND_ALG_LC}. |
| |
| @c For reference, this is the only place gmp_errno has been documented, and |
| @c due to being non thread safe we won't be adding to it's uses. |
| @findex gmp_errno |
| @findex GMP_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED_ARGUMENT |
| @findex GMP_ERROR_INVALID_ARGUMENT |
| @code{gmp_randinit} sets bits in the global variable @code{gmp_errno} to |
| indicate an error. @code{GMP_ERROR_UNSUPPORTED_ARGUMENT} if @var{alg} is |
| unsupported, or @code{GMP_ERROR_INVALID_ARGUMENT} if the @var{size} parameter |
| is too big. It may be noted this error reporting is not thread safe (a good |
| reason to use @code{gmp_randinit_lc_2exp_size} instead). |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randclear (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}) |
| Free all memory occupied by @var{state}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Random State Seeding, Random State Miscellaneous, Random State Initialization, Random Number Functions |
| @section Random State Seeding |
| @cindex Random number seeding |
| @cindex Seeding random numbers |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randseed (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, const mpz_t @var{seed}) |
| @deftypefunx void gmp_randseed_ui (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, @w{unsigned long int @var{seed}}) |
| Set an initial seed value into @var{state}. |
| |
| The size of a seed determines how many different sequences of random numbers |
| that it's possible to generate. The ``quality'' of the seed is the randomness |
| of a given seed compared to the previous seed used, and this affects the |
| randomness of separate number sequences. The method for choosing a seed is |
| critical if the generated numbers are to be used for important applications, |
| such as generating cryptographic keys. |
| |
| Traditionally the system time has been used to seed, but care needs to be |
| taken with this. If an application seeds often and the resolution of the |
| system clock is low, then the same sequence of numbers might be repeated. |
| Also, the system time is quite easy to guess, so if unpredictability is |
| required then it should definitely not be the only source for the seed value. |
| On some systems there's a special device @file{/dev/random} which provides |
| random data better suited for use as a seed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Random State Miscellaneous, , Random State Seeding, Random Number Functions |
| @section Random State Miscellaneous |
| |
| @deftypefun {unsigned long} gmp_urandomb_ui (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, unsigned long @var{n}) |
| Return a uniformly distributed random number of @var{n} bits, i.e.@: in the |
| range 0 to @m{2^n-1,2^@var{n}-1} inclusive. @var{n} must be less than or |
| equal to the number of bits in an @code{unsigned long}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {unsigned long} gmp_urandomm_ui (gmp_randstate_t @var{state}, unsigned long @var{n}) |
| Return a uniformly distributed random number in the range 0 to |
| @math{@var{n}-1}, inclusive. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node Formatted Output, Formatted Input, Random Number Functions, Top |
| @chapter Formatted Output |
| @cindex Formatted output |
| @cindex @code{printf} formatted output |
| |
| @menu |
| * Formatted Output Strings:: |
| * Formatted Output Functions:: |
| * C++ Formatted Output:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Formatted Output Strings, Formatted Output Functions, Formatted Output, Formatted Output |
| @section Format Strings |
| |
| @code{gmp_printf} and friends accept format strings similar to the standard C |
| @code{printf} (@pxref{Formatted Output,, Formatted Output, libc, The GNU C |
| Library Reference Manual}). A format specification is of the form |
| |
| @example |
| % [flags] [width] [.[precision]] [type] conv |
| @end example |
| |
| GMP adds types @samp{Z}, @samp{Q} and @samp{F} for @code{mpz_t}, @code{mpq_t} |
| and @code{mpf_t} respectively, @samp{M} for @code{mp_limb_t}, and @samp{N} for |
| an @code{mp_limb_t} array. @samp{Z}, @samp{Q}, @samp{M} and @samp{N} behave |
| like integers. @samp{Q} will print a @samp{/} and a denominator, if needed. |
| @samp{F} behaves like a float. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_t z; |
| gmp_printf ("%s is an mpz %Zd\n", "here", z); |
| |
| mpq_t q; |
| gmp_printf ("a hex rational: %#40Qx\n", q); |
| |
| mpf_t f; |
| int n; |
| gmp_printf ("fixed point mpf %.*Ff with %d digits\n", n, f, n); |
| |
| mp_limb_t l; |
| gmp_printf ("limb %Mu\n", l); |
| |
| const mp_limb_t *ptr; |
| mp_size_t size; |
| gmp_printf ("limb array %Nx\n", ptr, size); |
| @end example |
| |
| For @samp{N} the limbs are expected least significant first, as per the |
| @code{mpn} functions (@pxref{Low-level Functions}). A negative size can be |
| given to print the value as a negative. |
| |
| All the standard C @code{printf} types behave the same as the C library |
| @code{printf}, and can be freely intermixed with the GMP extensions. In the |
| current implementation the standard parts of the format string are simply |
| handed to @code{printf} and only the GMP extensions handled directly. |
| |
| The flags accepted are as follows. GLIBC style @nisamp{'} is only for the |
| standard C types (not the GMP types), and only if the C library supports it. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{0} @tab pad with zeros (rather than spaces) |
| @item @nicode{#} @tab show the base with @samp{0x}, @samp{0X} or @samp{0} |
| @item @nicode{+} @tab always show a sign |
| @item (space) @tab show a space or a @samp{-} sign |
| @item @nicode{'} @tab group digits, GLIBC style (not GMP types) |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| The optional width and precision can be given as a number within the format |
| string, or as a @samp{*} to take an extra parameter of type @code{int}, the |
| same as the standard @code{printf}. |
| |
| The standard types accepted are as follows. @samp{h} and @samp{l} are |
| portable, the rest will depend on the compiler (or include files) for the type |
| and the C library for the output. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{h} @tab @nicode{short} |
| @item @nicode{hh} @tab @nicode{char} |
| @item @nicode{j} @tab @nicode{intmax_t} or @nicode{uintmax_t} |
| @item @nicode{l} @tab @nicode{long} or @nicode{wchar_t} |
| @item @nicode{ll} @tab @nicode{long long} |
| @item @nicode{L} @tab @nicode{long double} |
| @item @nicode{q} @tab @nicode{quad_t} or @nicode{u_quad_t} |
| @item @nicode{t} @tab @nicode{ptrdiff_t} |
| @item @nicode{z} @tab @nicode{size_t} |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| @noindent |
| The GMP types are |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{F} @tab @nicode{mpf_t}, float conversions |
| @item @nicode{Q} @tab @nicode{mpq_t}, integer conversions |
| @item @nicode{M} @tab @nicode{mp_limb_t}, integer conversions |
| @item @nicode{N} @tab @nicode{mp_limb_t} array, integer conversions |
| @item @nicode{Z} @tab @nicode{mpz_t}, integer conversions |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| The conversions accepted are as follows. @samp{a} and @samp{A} are always |
| supported for @code{mpf_t} but depend on the C library for standard C float |
| types. @samp{m} and @samp{p} depend on the C library. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{a} @nicode{A} @tab hex floats, C99 style |
| @item @nicode{c} @tab character |
| @item @nicode{d} @tab decimal integer |
| @item @nicode{e} @nicode{E} @tab scientific format float |
| @item @nicode{f} @tab fixed point float |
| @item @nicode{i} @tab same as @nicode{d} |
| @item @nicode{g} @nicode{G} @tab fixed or scientific float |
| @item @nicode{m} @tab @code{strerror} string, GLIBC style |
| @item @nicode{n} @tab store characters written so far |
| @item @nicode{o} @tab octal integer |
| @item @nicode{p} @tab pointer |
| @item @nicode{s} @tab string |
| @item @nicode{u} @tab unsigned integer |
| @item @nicode{x} @nicode{X} @tab hex integer |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| @samp{o}, @samp{x} and @samp{X} are unsigned for the standard C types, but for |
| types @samp{Z}, @samp{Q} and @samp{N} they are signed. @samp{u} is not |
| meaningful for @samp{Z}, @samp{Q} and @samp{N}. |
| |
| @samp{M} is a proxy for the C library @samp{l} or @samp{L}, according to the |
| size of @code{mp_limb_t}. Unsigned conversions will be usual, but a signed |
| conversion can be used and will interpret the value as a twos complement |
| negative. |
| |
| @samp{n} can be used with any type, even the GMP types. |
| |
| Other types or conversions that might be accepted by the C library |
| @code{printf} cannot be used through @code{gmp_printf}, this includes for |
| instance extensions registered with GLIBC @code{register_printf_function}. |
| Also currently there's no support for POSIX @samp{$} style numbered arguments |
| (perhaps this will be added in the future). |
| |
| The precision field has its usual meaning for integer @samp{Z} and float |
| @samp{F} types, but is currently undefined for @samp{Q} and should not be used |
| with that. |
| |
| @code{mpf_t} conversions only ever generate as many digits as can be |
| accurately represented by the operand, the same as @code{mpf_get_str} does. |
| Zeros will be used if necessary to pad to the requested precision. This |
| happens even for an @samp{f} conversion of an @code{mpf_t} which is an |
| integer, for instance @math{2^@W{1024}} in an @code{mpf_t} of 128 bits |
| precision will only produce about 40 digits, then pad with zeros to the |
| decimal point. An empty precision field like @samp{%.Fe} or @samp{%.Ff} can |
| be used to specifically request just the significant digits. Without any dot |
| and thus no precision field, a precision value of 6 will be used. Note that |
| these rules mean that @samp{%Ff}, @samp{%.Ff}, and @samp{%.0Ff} will all be |
| different. |
| |
| The decimal point character (or string) is taken from the current locale |
| settings on systems which provide @code{localeconv} (@pxref{Locales,, Locales |
| and Internationalization, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). The C |
| library will normally do the same for standard float output. |
| |
| The format string is only interpreted as plain @code{char}s, multibyte |
| characters are not recognised. Perhaps this will change in the future. |
| |
| |
| @node Formatted Output Functions, C++ Formatted Output, Formatted Output Strings, Formatted Output |
| @section Functions |
| @cindex Output functions |
| |
| Each of the following functions is similar to the corresponding C library |
| function. The basic @code{printf} forms take a variable argument list. The |
| @code{vprintf} forms take an argument pointer, see @ref{Variadic Functions,, |
| Variadic Functions, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, or @samp{man 3 |
| va_start}. |
| |
| It should be emphasised that if a format string is invalid, or the arguments |
| don't match what the format specifies, then the behaviour of any of these |
| functions will be unpredictable. GCC format string checking is not available, |
| since it doesn't recognise the GMP extensions. |
| |
| The file based functions @code{gmp_printf} and @code{gmp_fprintf} will return |
| @math{-1} to indicate a write error. Output is not ``atomic'', so partial |
| output may be produced if a write error occurs. All the functions can return |
| @math{-1} if the C library @code{printf} variant in use returns @math{-1}, but |
| this shouldn't normally occur. |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_printf (const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vprintf (const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Print to the standard output @code{stdout}. Return the number of characters |
| written, or @math{-1} if an error occurred. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_fprintf (FILE *@var{fp}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vfprintf (FILE *@var{fp}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Print to the stream @var{fp}. Return the number of characters written, or |
| @math{-1} if an error occurred. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_sprintf (char *@var{buf}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vsprintf (char *@var{buf}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Form a null-terminated string in @var{buf}. Return the number of characters |
| written, excluding the terminating null. |
| |
| No overlap is permitted between the space at @var{buf} and the string |
| @var{fmt}. |
| |
| These functions are not recommended, since there's no protection against |
| exceeding the space available at @var{buf}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_snprintf (char *@var{buf}, size_t @var{size}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vsnprintf (char *@var{buf}, size_t @var{size}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Form a null-terminated string in @var{buf}. No more than @var{size} bytes |
| will be written. To get the full output, @var{size} must be enough for the |
| string and null-terminator. |
| |
| The return value is the total number of characters which ought to have been |
| produced, excluding the terminating null. If @math{@var{retval} @ge{} |
| @var{size}} then the actual output has been truncated to the first |
| @math{@var{size}-1} characters, and a null appended. |
| |
| No overlap is permitted between the region @{@var{buf},@var{size}@} and the |
| @var{fmt} string. |
| |
| Notice the return value is in ISO C99 @code{snprintf} style. This is so even |
| if the C library @code{vsnprintf} is the older GLIBC 2.0.x style. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_asprintf (char **@var{pp}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vasprintf (char **@var{pp}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Form a null-terminated string in a block of memory obtained from the current |
| memory allocation function (@pxref{Custom Allocation}). The block will be the |
| size of the string and null-terminator. The address of the block in stored to |
| *@var{pp}. The return value is the number of characters produced, excluding |
| the null-terminator. |
| |
| Unlike the C library @code{asprintf}, @code{gmp_asprintf} doesn't return |
| @math{-1} if there's no more memory available, it lets the current allocation |
| function handle that. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_obstack_printf (struct obstack *@var{ob}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_obstack_vprintf (struct obstack *@var{ob}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| @cindex @code{obstack} output |
| Append to the current object in @var{ob}. The return value is the number of |
| characters written. A null-terminator is not written. |
| |
| @var{fmt} cannot be within the current object in @var{ob}, since that object |
| might move as it grows. |
| |
| These functions are available only when the C library provides the obstack |
| feature, which probably means only on GNU systems, see @ref{Obstacks,, |
| Obstacks, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Formatted Output, , Formatted Output Functions, Formatted Output |
| @section C++ Formatted Output |
| @cindex C++ @code{ostream} output |
| @cindex @code{ostream} output |
| |
| The following functions are provided in @file{libgmpxx} (@pxref{Headers and |
| Libraries}), which is built if C++ support is enabled (@pxref{Build Options}). |
| Prototypes are available from @code{<gmp.h>}. |
| |
| @deftypefun ostream& operator<< (ostream& @var{stream}, const mpz_t @var{op}) |
| Print @var{op} to @var{stream}, using its @code{ios} formatting settings. |
| @code{ios::width} is reset to 0 after output, the same as the standard |
| @code{ostream operator<<} routines do. |
| |
| In hex or octal, @var{op} is printed as a signed number, the same as for |
| decimal. This is unlike the standard @code{operator<<} routines on @code{int} |
| etc, which instead give twos complement. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun ostream& operator<< (ostream& @var{stream}, const mpq_t @var{op}) |
| Print @var{op} to @var{stream}, using its @code{ios} formatting settings. |
| @code{ios::width} is reset to 0 after output, the same as the standard |
| @code{ostream operator<<} routines do. |
| |
| Output will be a fraction like @samp{5/9}, or if the denominator is 1 then |
| just a plain integer like @samp{123}. |
| |
| In hex or octal, @var{op} is printed as a signed value, the same as for |
| decimal. If @code{ios::showbase} is set then a base indicator is shown on |
| both the numerator and denominator (if the denominator is required). |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun ostream& operator<< (ostream& @var{stream}, const mpf_t @var{op}) |
| Print @var{op} to @var{stream}, using its @code{ios} formatting settings. |
| @code{ios::width} is reset to 0 after output, the same as the standard |
| @code{ostream operator<<} routines do. |
| |
| The decimal point follows the standard library float @code{operator<<}, which |
| on recent systems means the @code{std::locale} imbued on @var{stream}. |
| |
| Hex and octal are supported, unlike the standard @code{operator<<} on |
| @code{double}. The mantissa will be in hex or octal, the exponent will be in |
| decimal. For hex the exponent delimiter is an @samp{@@}. This is as per |
| @code{mpf_out_str}. |
| |
| @code{ios::showbase} is supported, and will put a base on the mantissa, for |
| example hex @samp{0x1.8} or @samp{0x0.8}, or octal @samp{01.4} or @samp{00.4}. |
| This last form is slightly strange, but at least differentiates itself from |
| decimal. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| These operators mean that GMP types can be printed in the usual C++ way, for |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_t z; |
| int n; |
| ... |
| cout << "iteration " << n << " value " << z << "\n"; |
| @end example |
| |
| But note that @code{ostream} output (and @code{istream} input, @pxref{C++ |
| Formatted Input}) is the only overloading available for the GMP types and that |
| for instance using @code{+} with an @code{mpz_t} will have unpredictable |
| results. For classes with overloading, see @ref{C++ Class Interface}. |
| |
| |
| @node Formatted Input, C++ Class Interface, Formatted Output, Top |
| @chapter Formatted Input |
| @cindex Formatted input |
| @cindex @code{scanf} formatted input |
| |
| @menu |
| * Formatted Input Strings:: |
| * Formatted Input Functions:: |
| * C++ Formatted Input:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Formatted Input Strings, Formatted Input Functions, Formatted Input, Formatted Input |
| @section Formatted Input Strings |
| |
| @code{gmp_scanf} and friends accept format strings similar to the standard C |
| @code{scanf} (@pxref{Formatted Input,, Formatted Input, libc, The GNU C |
| Library Reference Manual}). A format specification is of the form |
| |
| @example |
| % [flags] [width] [type] conv |
| @end example |
| |
| GMP adds types @samp{Z}, @samp{Q} and @samp{F} for @code{mpz_t}, @code{mpq_t} |
| and @code{mpf_t} respectively. @samp{Z} and @samp{Q} behave like integers. |
| @samp{Q} will read a @samp{/} and a denominator, if present. @samp{F} behaves |
| like a float. |
| |
| GMP variables don't require an @code{&} when passed to @code{gmp_scanf}, since |
| they're already ``call-by-reference''. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| /* to read say "a(5) = 1234" */ |
| int n; |
| mpz_t z; |
| gmp_scanf ("a(%d) = %Zd\n", &n, z); |
| |
| mpq_t q1, q2; |
| gmp_sscanf ("0377 + 0x10/0x11", "%Qi + %Qi", q1, q2); |
| |
| /* to read say "topleft (1.55,-2.66)" */ |
| mpf_t x, y; |
| char buf[32]; |
| gmp_scanf ("%31s (%Ff,%Ff)", buf, x, y); |
| @end example |
| |
| All the standard C @code{scanf} types behave the same as in the C library |
| @code{scanf}, and can be freely intermixed with the GMP extensions. In the |
| current implementation the standard parts of the format string are simply |
| handed to @code{scanf} and only the GMP extensions handled directly. |
| |
| The flags accepted are as follows. @samp{a} and @samp{'} will depend on |
| support from the C library, and @samp{'} cannot be used with GMP types. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{*} @tab read but don't store |
| @item @nicode{a} @tab allocate a buffer (string conversions) |
| @item @nicode{'} @tab grouped digits, GLIBC style (not GMP types) |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| The standard types accepted are as follows. @samp{h} and @samp{l} are |
| portable, the rest will depend on the compiler (or include files) for the type |
| and the C library for the input. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{h} @tab @nicode{short} |
| @item @nicode{hh} @tab @nicode{char} |
| @item @nicode{j} @tab @nicode{intmax_t} or @nicode{uintmax_t} |
| @item @nicode{l} @tab @nicode{long int}, @nicode{double} or @nicode{wchar_t} |
| @item @nicode{ll} @tab @nicode{long long} |
| @item @nicode{L} @tab @nicode{long double} |
| @item @nicode{q} @tab @nicode{quad_t} or @nicode{u_quad_t} |
| @item @nicode{t} @tab @nicode{ptrdiff_t} |
| @item @nicode{z} @tab @nicode{size_t} |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| @noindent |
| The GMP types are |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{F} @tab @nicode{mpf_t}, float conversions |
| @item @nicode{Q} @tab @nicode{mpq_t}, integer conversions |
| @item @nicode{Z} @tab @nicode{mpz_t}, integer conversions |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| The conversions accepted are as follows. @samp{p} and @samp{[} will depend on |
| support from the C library, the rest are standard. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {(space)} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item @nicode{c} @tab character or characters |
| @item @nicode{d} @tab decimal integer |
| @item @nicode{e} @nicode{E} @nicode{f} @nicode{g} @nicode{G} |
| @tab float |
| @item @nicode{i} @tab integer with base indicator |
| @item @nicode{n} @tab characters read so far |
| @item @nicode{o} @tab octal integer |
| @item @nicode{p} @tab pointer |
| @item @nicode{s} @tab string of non-whitespace characters |
| @item @nicode{u} @tab decimal integer |
| @item @nicode{x} @nicode{X} @tab hex integer |
| @item @nicode{[} @tab string of characters in a set |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| @samp{e}, @samp{E}, @samp{f}, @samp{g} and @samp{G} are identical, they all |
| read either fixed point or scientific format, and either upper or lower case |
| @samp{e} for the exponent in scientific format. |
| |
| C99 style hex float format (@code{printf %a}, @pxref{Formatted Output |
| Strings}) is always accepted for @code{mpf_t}, but for the standard float |
| types it will depend on the C library. |
| |
| @samp{x} and @samp{X} are identical, both accept both upper and lower case |
| hexadecimal. |
| |
| @samp{o}, @samp{u}, @samp{x} and @samp{X} all read positive or negative |
| values. For the standard C types these are described as ``unsigned'' |
| conversions, but that merely affects certain overflow handling, negatives are |
| still allowed (per @code{strtoul}, @pxref{Parsing of Integers,, Parsing of |
| Integers, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). For GMP types there are |
| no overflows, so @samp{d} and @samp{u} are identical. |
| |
| @samp{Q} type reads the numerator and (optional) denominator as given. If the |
| value might not be in canonical form then @code{mpq_canonicalize} must be |
| called before using it in any calculations (@pxref{Rational Number |
| Functions}). |
| |
| @samp{Qi} will read a base specification separately for the numerator and |
| denominator. For example @samp{0x10/11} would be 16/11, whereas |
| @samp{0x10/0x11} would be 16/17. |
| |
| @samp{n} can be used with any of the types above, even the GMP types. |
| @samp{*} to suppress assignment is allowed, though in that case it would do |
| nothing at all. |
| |
| Other conversions or types that might be accepted by the C library |
| @code{scanf} cannot be used through @code{gmp_scanf}. |
| |
| Whitespace is read and discarded before a field, except for @samp{c} and |
| @samp{[} conversions. |
| |
| For float conversions, the decimal point character (or string) expected is |
| taken from the current locale settings on systems which provide |
| @code{localeconv} (@pxref{Locales,, Locales and Internationalization, libc, |
| The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). The C library will normally do the same |
| for standard float input. |
| |
| The format string is only interpreted as plain @code{char}s, multibyte |
| characters are not recognised. Perhaps this will change in the future. |
| |
| |
| @node Formatted Input Functions, C++ Formatted Input, Formatted Input Strings, Formatted Input |
| @section Formatted Input Functions |
| @cindex Input functions |
| |
| Each of the following functions is similar to the corresponding C library |
| function. The plain @code{scanf} forms take a variable argument list. The |
| @code{vscanf} forms take an argument pointer, see @ref{Variadic Functions,, |
| Variadic Functions, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, or @samp{man 3 |
| va_start}. |
| |
| It should be emphasised that if a format string is invalid, or the arguments |
| don't match what the format specifies, then the behaviour of any of these |
| functions will be unpredictable. GCC format string checking is not available, |
| since it doesn't recognise the GMP extensions. |
| |
| No overlap is permitted between the @var{fmt} string and any of the results |
| produced. |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_scanf (const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vscanf (const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Read from the standard input @code{stdin}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_fscanf (FILE *@var{fp}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vfscanf (FILE *@var{fp}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Read from the stream @var{fp}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun int gmp_sscanf (const char *@var{s}, const char *@var{fmt}, @dots{}) |
| @deftypefunx int gmp_vsscanf (const char *@var{s}, const char *@var{fmt}, va_list @var{ap}) |
| Read from a null-terminated string @var{s}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| The return value from each of these functions is the same as the standard C99 |
| @code{scanf}, namely the number of fields successfully parsed and stored. |
| @samp{%n} fields and fields read but suppressed by @samp{*} don't count |
| towards the return value. |
| |
| If end of input (or a file error) is reached before a character for a field or |
| a literal, and if no previous non-suppressed fields have matched, then the |
| return value is @code{EOF} instead of 0. A whitespace character in the format |
| string is only an optional match and doesn't induce an @code{EOF} in this |
| fashion. Leading whitespace read and discarded for a field don't count as |
| characters for that field. |
| |
| For the GMP types, input parsing follows C99 rules, namely one character of |
| lookahead is used and characters are read while they continue to meet the |
| format requirements. If this doesn't provide a complete number then the |
| function terminates, with that field not stored nor counted towards the return |
| value. For instance with @code{mpf_t} an input @samp{1.23e-XYZ} would be read |
| up to the @samp{X} and that character pushed back since it's not a digit. The |
| string @samp{1.23e-} would then be considered invalid since an @samp{e} must |
| be followed by at least one digit. |
| |
| For the standard C types, in the current implementation GMP calls the C |
| library @code{scanf} functions, which might have looser rules about what |
| constitutes a valid input. |
| |
| Note that @code{gmp_sscanf} is the same as @code{gmp_fscanf} and only does one |
| character of lookahead when parsing. Although clearly it could look at its |
| entire input, it is deliberately made identical to @code{gmp_fscanf}, the same |
| way C99 @code{sscanf} is the same as @code{fscanf}. |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Formatted Input, , Formatted Input Functions, Formatted Input |
| @section C++ Formatted Input |
| @cindex C++ @code{istream} input |
| @cindex @code{istream} input |
| |
| The following functions are provided in @file{libgmpxx} (@pxref{Headers and |
| Libraries}), which is built only if C++ support is enabled (@pxref{Build |
| Options}). Prototypes are available from @code{<gmp.h>}. |
| |
| @deftypefun istream& operator>> (istream& @var{stream}, mpz_t @var{rop}) |
| Read @var{rop} from @var{stream}, using its @code{ios} formatting settings. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun istream& operator>> (istream& @var{stream}, mpq_t @var{rop}) |
| An integer like @samp{123} will be read, or a fraction like @samp{5/9}. No |
| whitespace is allowed around the @samp{/}. If the fraction is not in |
| canonical form then @code{mpq_canonicalize} must be called (@pxref{Rational |
| Number Functions}) before operating on it. |
| |
| As per integer input, an @samp{0} or @samp{0x} base indicator is read when |
| none of @code{ios::dec}, @code{ios::oct} or @code{ios::hex} are set. This is |
| done separately for numerator and denominator, so that for instance |
| @samp{0x10/11} is @math{16/11} and @samp{0x10/0x11} is @math{16/17}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun istream& operator>> (istream& @var{stream}, mpf_t @var{rop}) |
| Read @var{rop} from @var{stream}, using its @code{ios} formatting settings. |
| |
| Hex or octal floats are not supported, but might be in the future, or perhaps |
| it's best to accept only what the standard float @code{operator>>} does. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| Note that digit grouping specified by the @code{istream} locale is currently |
| not accepted. Perhaps this will change in the future. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| These operators mean that GMP types can be read in the usual C++ way, for |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_t z; |
| ... |
| cin >> z; |
| @end example |
| |
| But note that @code{istream} input (and @code{ostream} output, @pxref{C++ |
| Formatted Output}) is the only overloading available for the GMP types and |
| that for instance using @code{+} with an @code{mpz_t} will have unpredictable |
| results. For classes with overloading, see @ref{C++ Class Interface}. |
| |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Class Interface, Custom Allocation, Formatted Input, Top |
| @chapter C++ Class Interface |
| @cindex C++ interface |
| |
| This chapter describes the C++ class based interface to GMP. |
| |
| All GMP C language types and functions can be used in C++ programs, since |
| @file{gmp.h} has @code{extern "C"} qualifiers, but the class interface offers |
| overloaded functions and operators which may be more convenient. |
| |
| Due to the implementation of this interface, a reasonably recent C++ compiler |
| is required, one supporting namespaces, partial specialization of templates |
| and member templates. |
| |
| @strong{Everything described in this chapter is to be considered preliminary |
| and might be subject to incompatible changes if some unforeseen difficulty |
| reveals itself.} |
| |
| @menu |
| * C++ Interface General:: |
| * C++ Interface Integers:: |
| * C++ Interface Rationals:: |
| * C++ Interface Floats:: |
| * C++ Interface Random Numbers:: |
| * C++ Interface Limitations:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface General, C++ Interface Integers, C++ Class Interface, C++ Class Interface |
| @section C++ Interface General |
| |
| @noindent |
| All the C++ classes and functions are available with |
| |
| @cindex @code{gmpxx.h} |
| @example |
| #include <gmpxx.h> |
| @end example |
| |
| Programs should be linked with the @file{libgmpxx} and @file{libgmp} |
| libraries. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| g++ mycxxprog.cc -lgmpxx -lgmp |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| The classes defined are |
| |
| @deftp Class mpz_class |
| @deftpx Class mpq_class |
| @deftpx Class mpf_class |
| @end deftp |
| |
| The standard operators and various standard functions are overloaded to allow |
| arithmetic with these classes. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| int |
| main (void) |
| @{ |
| mpz_class a, b, c; |
| |
| a = 1234; |
| b = "-5678"; |
| c = a+b; |
| cout << "sum is " << c << "\n"; |
| cout << "absolute value is " << abs(c) << "\n"; |
| |
| return 0; |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| An important feature of the implementation is that an expression like |
| @code{a=b+c} results in a single call to the corresponding @code{mpz_add}, |
| without using a temporary for the @code{b+c} part. Expressions which by their |
| nature imply intermediate values, like @code{a=b*c+d*e}, still use temporaries |
| though. |
| |
| The classes can be freely intermixed in expressions, as can the classes and |
| the standard types @code{long}, @code{unsigned long} and @code{double}. |
| Smaller types like @code{int} or @code{float} can also be intermixed, since |
| C++ will promote them. |
| |
| Note that @code{bool} is not accepted directly, but must be explicitly cast to |
| an @code{int} first. This is because C++ will automatically convert any |
| pointer to a @code{bool}, so if GMP accepted @code{bool} it would make all |
| sorts of invalid class and pointer combinations compile but almost certainly |
| not do anything sensible. |
| |
| Conversions back from the classes to standard C++ types aren't done |
| automatically, instead member functions like @code{get_si} are provided (see |
| the following sections for details). |
| |
| Also there are no automatic conversions from the classes to the corresponding |
| GMP C types, instead a reference to the underlying C object can be obtained |
| with the following functions, |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_t mpz_class::get_mpz_t () |
| @deftypefunx mpq_t mpq_class::get_mpq_t () |
| @deftypefunx mpf_t mpf_class::get_mpf_t () |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| These can be used to call a C function which doesn't have a C++ class |
| interface. For example to set @code{a} to the GCD of @code{b} and @code{c}, |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class a, b, c; |
| ... |
| mpz_gcd (a.get_mpz_t(), b.get_mpz_t(), c.get_mpz_t()); |
| @end example |
| |
| In the other direction, a class can be initialized from the corresponding GMP |
| C type, or assigned to if an explicit constructor is used. In both cases this |
| makes a copy of the value, it doesn't create any sort of association. For |
| example, |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_t z; |
| // ... init and calculate z ... |
| mpz_class x(z); |
| mpz_class y; |
| y = mpz_class (z); |
| @end example |
| |
| There are no namespace setups in @file{gmpxx.h}, all types and functions are |
| simply put into the global namespace. This is what @file{gmp.h} has done in |
| the past, and continues to do for compatibility. The extras provided by |
| @file{gmpxx.h} follow GMP naming conventions and are unlikely to clash with |
| anything. |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface Integers, C++ Interface Rationals, C++ Interface General, C++ Class Interface |
| @section C++ Interface Integers |
| |
| @deftypefun {} mpz_class::mpz_class (type @var{n}) |
| Construct an @code{mpz_class}. All the standard C++ types may be used, except |
| @code{long long} and @code{long double}, and all the GMP C++ classes can be |
| used, although conversions from @code{mpq_class} and @code{mpf_class} are |
| @code{explicit}. Any necessary conversion follows the corresponding C |
| function, for example @code{double} follows @code{mpz_set_d} |
| (@pxref{Assigning Integers}). |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun explicit mpz_class::mpz_class (const mpz_t @var{z}) |
| Construct an @code{mpz_class} from an @code{mpz_t}. The value in @var{z} is |
| copied into the new @code{mpz_class}, there won't be any permanent association |
| between it and @var{z}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun explicit mpz_class::mpz_class (const char *@var{s}, int @var{base} = 0) |
| @deftypefunx explicit mpz_class::mpz_class (const string& @var{s}, int @var{base} = 0) |
| Construct an @code{mpz_class} converted from a string using @code{mpz_set_str} |
| (@pxref{Assigning Integers}). |
| |
| If the string is not a valid integer, an @code{std::invalid_argument} |
| exception is thrown. The same applies to @code{operator=}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_class operator"" _mpz (const char *@var{str}) |
| With C++11 compilers, integers can be constructed with the syntax |
| @code{123_mpz} which is equivalent to @code{mpz_class("123")}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_class operator/ (mpz_class @var{a}, mpz_class @var{d}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class operator% (mpz_class @var{a}, mpz_class @var{d}) |
| Divisions involving @code{mpz_class} round towards zero, as per the |
| @code{mpz_tdiv_q} and @code{mpz_tdiv_r} functions (@pxref{Integer Division}). |
| This is the same as the C99 @code{/} and @code{%} operators. |
| |
| The @code{mpz_fdiv@dots{}} or @code{mpz_cdiv@dots{}} functions can always be called |
| directly if desired. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class q, a, d; |
| ... |
| mpz_fdiv_q (q.get_mpz_t(), a.get_mpz_t(), d.get_mpz_t()); |
| @end example |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_class abs (mpz_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int cmp (mpz_class @var{op1}, type @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int cmp (type @var{op1}, mpz_class @var{op2}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx bool mpz_class::fits_sint_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpz_class::fits_slong_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpz_class::fits_sshort_p (void) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx bool mpz_class::fits_uint_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpz_class::fits_ulong_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpz_class::fits_ushort_p (void) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx double mpz_class::get_d (void) |
| @deftypefunx long mpz_class::get_si (void) |
| @deftypefunx string mpz_class::get_str (int @var{base} = 10) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long} mpz_class::get_ui (void) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_class::set_str (const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpz_class::set_str (const string& @var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| @deftypefunx int sgn (mpz_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class sqrt (mpz_class @var{op}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class gcd (mpz_class @var{op1}, mpz_class @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class lcm (mpz_class @var{op1}, mpz_class @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class mpz_class::factorial (type @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class factorial (mpz_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class mpz_class::primorial (type @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class primorial (mpz_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class mpz_class::fibonacci (type @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class fibonacci (mpz_class @var{op}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx void mpz_class::swap (mpz_class& @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void swap (mpz_class& @var{op1}, mpz_class& @var{op2}) |
| These functions provide a C++ class interface to the corresponding GMP C |
| routines. Calling @code{factorial} or @code{primorial} on a negative number |
| is undefined. |
| |
| @code{cmp} can be used with any of the classes or the standard C++ types, |
| except @code{long long} and @code{long double}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| Overloaded operators for combinations of @code{mpz_class} and @code{double} |
| are provided for completeness, but it should be noted that if the given |
| @code{double} is not an integer then the way any rounding is done is currently |
| unspecified. The rounding might take place at the start, in the middle, or at |
| the end of the operation, and it might change in the future. |
| |
| Conversions between @code{mpz_class} and @code{double}, however, are defined |
| to follow the corresponding C functions @code{mpz_get_d} and @code{mpz_set_d}. |
| And comparisons are always made exactly, as per @code{mpz_cmp_d}. |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface Rationals, C++ Interface Floats, C++ Interface Integers, C++ Class Interface |
| @section C++ Interface Rationals |
| |
| In all the following constructors, if a fraction is given then it should be in |
| canonical form, or if not then @code{mpq_class::canonicalize} called. |
| |
| @deftypefun {} mpq_class::mpq_class (type @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx {} mpq_class::mpq_class (integer @var{num}, integer @var{den}) |
| Construct an @code{mpq_class}. The initial value can be a single value of any |
| type (conversion from @code{mpf_class} is @code{explicit}), or a pair of |
| integers (@code{mpz_class} or standard C++ integer types) representing a |
| fraction, except that @code{long long} and @code{long double} are not |
| supported. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| mpq_class q (99); |
| mpq_class q (1.75); |
| mpq_class q (1, 3); |
| @end example |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun explicit mpq_class::mpq_class (const mpq_t @var{q}) |
| Construct an @code{mpq_class} from an @code{mpq_t}. The value in @var{q} is |
| copied into the new @code{mpq_class}, there won't be any permanent association |
| between it and @var{q}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun explicit mpq_class::mpq_class (const char *@var{s}, int @var{base} = 0) |
| @deftypefunx explicit mpq_class::mpq_class (const string& @var{s}, int @var{base} = 0) |
| Construct an @code{mpq_class} converted from a string using @code{mpq_set_str} |
| (@pxref{Initializing Rationals}). |
| |
| If the string is not a valid rational, an @code{std::invalid_argument} |
| exception is thrown. The same applies to @code{operator=}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpq_class operator"" _mpq (const char *@var{str}) |
| With C++11 compilers, integral rationals can be constructed with the syntax |
| @code{123_mpq} which is equivalent to @code{mpq_class(123_mpz)}. Other |
| rationals can be built as @code{-1_mpq/2} or @code{0xb_mpq/123456_mpz}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void mpq_class::canonicalize () |
| Put an @code{mpq_class} into canonical form, as per @ref{Rational Number |
| Functions}. All arithmetic operators require their operands in canonical |
| form, and will return results in canonical form. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpq_class abs (mpq_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int cmp (mpq_class @var{op1}, type @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int cmp (type @var{op1}, mpq_class @var{op2}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx double mpq_class::get_d (void) |
| @deftypefunx string mpq_class::get_str (int @var{base} = 10) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx int mpq_class::set_str (const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpq_class::set_str (const string& @var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| @deftypefunx int sgn (mpq_class @var{op}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx void mpq_class::swap (mpq_class& @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void swap (mpq_class& @var{op1}, mpq_class& @var{op2}) |
| These functions provide a C++ class interface to the corresponding GMP C |
| routines. |
| |
| @code{cmp} can be used with any of the classes or the standard C++ types, |
| except @code{long long} and @code{long double}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mpz_class&} mpq_class::get_num () |
| @deftypefunx {mpz_class&} mpq_class::get_den () |
| Get a reference to an @code{mpz_class} which is the numerator or denominator |
| of an @code{mpq_class}. This can be used both for read and write access. If |
| the object returned is modified, it modifies the original @code{mpq_class}. |
| |
| If direct manipulation might produce a non-canonical value, then |
| @code{mpq_class::canonicalize} must be called before further operations. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_t mpq_class::get_num_mpz_t () |
| @deftypefunx mpz_t mpq_class::get_den_mpz_t () |
| Get a reference to the underlying @code{mpz_t} numerator or denominator of an |
| @code{mpq_class}. This can be passed to C functions expecting an |
| @code{mpz_t}. Any modifications made to the @code{mpz_t} will modify the |
| original @code{mpq_class}. |
| |
| If direct manipulation might produce a non-canonical value, then |
| @code{mpq_class::canonicalize} must be called before further operations. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun istream& operator>> (istream& @var{stream}, mpq_class& @var{rop}); |
| Read @var{rop} from @var{stream}, using its @code{ios} formatting settings, |
| the same as @code{mpq_t operator>>} (@pxref{C++ Formatted Input}). |
| |
| If the @var{rop} read might not be in canonical form then |
| @code{mpq_class::canonicalize} must be called. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface Floats, C++ Interface Random Numbers, C++ Interface Rationals, C++ Class Interface |
| @section C++ Interface Floats |
| |
| When an expression requires the use of temporary intermediate @code{mpf_class} |
| values, like @code{f=g*h+x*y}, those temporaries will have the same precision |
| as the destination @code{f}. Explicit constructors can be used if this |
| doesn't suit. |
| |
| @deftypefun {} mpf_class::mpf_class (type @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx {} mpf_class::mpf_class (type @var{op}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Construct an @code{mpf_class}. Any standard C++ type can be used, except |
| @code{long long} and @code{long double}, and any of the GMP C++ classes can be |
| used. |
| |
| If @var{prec} is given, the initial precision is that value, in bits. If |
| @var{prec} is not given, then the initial precision is determined by the type |
| of @var{op} given. An @code{mpz_class}, @code{mpq_class}, or C++ |
| builtin type will give the default @code{mpf} precision (@pxref{Initializing |
| Floats}). An @code{mpf_class} or expression will give the precision of that |
| value. The precision of a binary expression is the higher of the two |
| operands. |
| |
| @example |
| mpf_class f(1.5); // default precision |
| mpf_class f(1.5, 500); // 500 bits (at least) |
| mpf_class f(x); // precision of x |
| mpf_class f(abs(x)); // precision of x |
| mpf_class f(-g, 1000); // 1000 bits (at least) |
| mpf_class f(x+y); // greater of precisions of x and y |
| @end example |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun explicit mpf_class::mpf_class (const mpf_t @var{f}) |
| @deftypefunx {} mpf_class::mpf_class (const mpf_t @var{f}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Construct an @code{mpf_class} from an @code{mpf_t}. The value in @var{f} is |
| copied into the new @code{mpf_class}, there won't be any permanent association |
| between it and @var{f}. |
| |
| If @var{prec} is given, the initial precision is that value, in bits. If |
| @var{prec} is not given, then the initial precision is that of @var{f}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun explicit mpf_class::mpf_class (const char *@var{s}) |
| @deftypefunx {} mpf_class::mpf_class (const char *@var{s}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}, int @var{base} = 0) |
| @deftypefunx explicit mpf_class::mpf_class (const string& @var{s}) |
| @deftypefunx {} mpf_class::mpf_class (const string& @var{s}, mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}, int @var{base} = 0) |
| Construct an @code{mpf_class} converted from a string using @code{mpf_set_str} |
| (@pxref{Assigning Floats}). If @var{prec} is given, the initial precision is |
| that value, in bits. If not, the default @code{mpf} precision |
| (@pxref{Initializing Floats}) is used. |
| |
| If the string is not a valid float, an @code{std::invalid_argument} exception |
| is thrown. The same applies to @code{operator=}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpf_class operator"" _mpf (const char *@var{str}) |
| With C++11 compilers, floats can be constructed with the syntax |
| @code{1.23e-1_mpf} which is equivalent to @code{mpf_class("1.23e-1")}. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mpf_class&} mpf_class::operator= (type @var{op}) |
| Convert and store the given @var{op} value to an @code{mpf_class} object. The |
| same types are accepted as for the constructors above. |
| |
| Note that @code{operator=} only stores a new value, it doesn't copy or change |
| the precision of the destination, instead the value is truncated if necessary. |
| This is the same as @code{mpf_set} etc. Note in particular this means for |
| @code{mpf_class} a copy constructor is not the same as a default constructor |
| plus assignment. |
| |
| @example |
| mpf_class x (y); // x created with precision of y |
| |
| mpf_class x; // x created with default precision |
| x = y; // value truncated to that precision |
| @end example |
| |
| Applications using templated code may need to be careful about the assumptions |
| the code makes in this area, when working with @code{mpf_class} values of |
| various different or non-default precisions. For instance implementations of |
| the standard @code{complex} template have been seen in both styles above, |
| though of course @code{complex} is normally only actually specified for use |
| with the builtin float types. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpf_class abs (mpf_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpf_class ceil (mpf_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx int cmp (mpf_class @var{op1}, type @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx int cmp (type @var{op1}, mpf_class @var{op2}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx bool mpf_class::fits_sint_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpf_class::fits_slong_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpf_class::fits_sshort_p (void) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx bool mpf_class::fits_uint_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpf_class::fits_ulong_p (void) |
| @deftypefunx bool mpf_class::fits_ushort_p (void) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx mpf_class floor (mpf_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpf_class hypot (mpf_class @var{op1}, mpf_class @var{op2}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx double mpf_class::get_d (void) |
| @deftypefunx long mpf_class::get_si (void) |
| @deftypefunx string mpf_class::get_str (mp_exp_t& @var{exp}, int @var{base} = 10, size_t @var{digits} = 0) |
| @deftypefunx {unsigned long} mpf_class::get_ui (void) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_class::set_str (const char *@var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| @deftypefunx int mpf_class::set_str (const string& @var{str}, int @var{base}) |
| @deftypefunx int sgn (mpf_class @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx mpf_class sqrt (mpf_class @var{op}) |
| @maybepagebreak |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_class::swap (mpf_class& @var{op}) |
| @deftypefunx void swap (mpf_class& @var{op1}, mpf_class& @var{op2}) |
| @deftypefunx mpf_class trunc (mpf_class @var{op}) |
| These functions provide a C++ class interface to the corresponding GMP C |
| routines. |
| |
| @code{cmp} can be used with any of the classes or the standard C++ types, |
| except @code{long long} and @code{long double}. |
| |
| The accuracy provided by @code{hypot} is not currently guaranteed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {mp_bitcnt_t} mpf_class::get_prec () |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_class::set_prec (mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| @deftypefunx void mpf_class::set_prec_raw (mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Get or set the current precision of an @code{mpf_class}. |
| |
| The restrictions described for @code{mpf_set_prec_raw} (@pxref{Initializing |
| Floats}) apply to @code{mpf_class::set_prec_raw}. Note in particular that the |
| @code{mpf_class} must be restored to it's allocated precision before being |
| destroyed. This must be done by application code, there's no automatic |
| mechanism for it. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface Random Numbers, C++ Interface Limitations, C++ Interface Floats, C++ Class Interface |
| @section C++ Interface Random Numbers |
| |
| @deftp Class gmp_randclass |
| The C++ class interface to the GMP random number functions uses |
| @code{gmp_randclass} to hold an algorithm selection and current state, as per |
| @code{gmp_randstate_t}. |
| @end deftp |
| |
| @deftypefun {} gmp_randclass::gmp_randclass (void (*@var{randinit}) (gmp_randstate_t, @dots{}), @dots{}) |
| Construct a @code{gmp_randclass}, using a call to the given @var{randinit} |
| function (@pxref{Random State Initialization}). The arguments expected are |
| the same as @var{randinit}, but with @code{mpz_class} instead of @code{mpz_t}. |
| For example, |
| |
| @example |
| gmp_randclass r1 (gmp_randinit_default); |
| gmp_randclass r2 (gmp_randinit_lc_2exp_size, 32); |
| gmp_randclass r3 (gmp_randinit_lc_2exp, a, c, m2exp); |
| gmp_randclass r4 (gmp_randinit_mt); |
| @end example |
| |
| @code{gmp_randinit_lc_2exp_size} will fail if the size requested is too big, |
| an @code{std::length_error} exception is thrown in that case. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun {} gmp_randclass::gmp_randclass (gmp_randalg_t @var{alg}, @dots{}) |
| Construct a @code{gmp_randclass} using the same parameters as |
| @code{gmp_randinit} (@pxref{Random State Initialization}). This function is |
| obsolete and the above @var{randinit} style should be preferred. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun void gmp_randclass::seed (unsigned long int @var{s}) |
| @deftypefunx void gmp_randclass::seed (mpz_class @var{s}) |
| Seed a random number generator. See @pxref{Random Number Functions}, for how |
| to choose a good seed. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_class gmp_randclass::get_z_bits (mp_bitcnt_t @var{bits}) |
| @deftypefunx mpz_class gmp_randclass::get_z_bits (mpz_class @var{bits}) |
| Generate a random integer with a specified number of bits. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpz_class gmp_randclass::get_z_range (mpz_class @var{n}) |
| Generate a random integer in the range 0 to @math{@var{n}-1} inclusive. |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @deftypefun mpf_class gmp_randclass::get_f () |
| @deftypefunx mpf_class gmp_randclass::get_f (mp_bitcnt_t @var{prec}) |
| Generate a random float @var{f} in the range @math{0 <= @var{f} < 1}. @var{f} |
| will be to @var{prec} bits precision, or if @var{prec} is not given then to |
| the precision of the destination. For example, |
| |
| @example |
| gmp_randclass r; |
| ... |
| mpf_class f (0, 512); // 512 bits precision |
| f = r.get_f(); // random number, 512 bits |
| @end example |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface Limitations, , C++ Interface Random Numbers, C++ Class Interface |
| @section C++ Interface Limitations |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @code{mpq_class} and Templated Reading |
| A generic piece of template code probably won't know that @code{mpq_class} |
| requires a @code{canonicalize} call if inputs read with @code{operator>>} |
| might be non-canonical. This can lead to incorrect results. |
| |
| @code{operator>>} behaves as it does for reasons of efficiency. A |
| canonicalize can be quite time consuming on large operands, and is best |
| avoided if it's not necessary. |
| |
| But this potential difficulty reduces the usefulness of @code{mpq_class}. |
| Perhaps a mechanism to tell @code{operator>>} what to do will be adopted in |
| the future, maybe a preprocessor define, a global flag, or an @code{ios} flag |
| pressed into service. Or maybe, at the risk of inconsistency, the |
| @code{mpq_class} @code{operator>>} could canonicalize and leave @code{mpq_t} |
| @code{operator>>} not doing so, for use on those occasions when that's |
| acceptable. Send feedback or alternate ideas to @email{gmp-bugs@@gmplib.org}. |
| |
| @item Subclassing |
| Subclassing the GMP C++ classes works, but is not currently recommended. |
| |
| Expressions involving subclasses resolve correctly (or seem to), but in normal |
| C++ fashion the subclass doesn't inherit constructors and assignments. |
| There's many of those in the GMP classes, and a good way to reestablish them |
| in a subclass is not yet provided. |
| |
| @item Templated Expressions |
| A subtle difficulty exists when using expressions together with |
| application-defined template functions. Consider the following, with @code{T} |
| intended to be some numeric type, |
| |
| @example |
| template <class T> |
| T fun (const T &, const T &); |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| When used with, say, plain @code{mpz_class} variables, it works fine: @code{T} |
| is resolved as @code{mpz_class}. |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class f(1), g(2); |
| fun (f, g); // Good |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| But when one of the arguments is an expression, it doesn't work. |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class f(1), g(2), h(3); |
| fun (f, g+h); // Bad |
| @end example |
| |
| This is because @code{g+h} ends up being a certain expression template type |
| internal to @code{gmpxx.h}, which the C++ template resolution rules are unable |
| to automatically convert to @code{mpz_class}. The workaround is simply to add |
| an explicit cast. |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class f(1), g(2), h(3); |
| fun (f, mpz_class(g+h)); // Good |
| @end example |
| |
| Similarly, within @code{fun} it may be necessary to cast an expression to type |
| @code{T} when calling a templated @code{fun2}. |
| |
| @example |
| template <class T> |
| void fun (T f, T g) |
| @{ |
| fun2 (f, f+g); // Bad |
| @} |
| |
| template <class T> |
| void fun (T f, T g) |
| @{ |
| fun2 (f, T(f+g)); // Good |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| @item C++11 |
| C++11 provides several new ways in which types can be inferred: @code{auto}, |
| @code{decltype}, etc. While they can be very convenient, they don't mix well |
| with expression templates. In this example, the addition is performed twice, |
| as if we had defined @code{sum} as a macro. |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class z = 33; |
| auto sum = z + z; |
| mpz_class prod = sum * sum; |
| @end example |
| |
| This other example may crash, though some compilers might make it look like |
| it is working, because the expression @code{z+z} goes out of scope before it |
| is evaluated. |
| |
| @example |
| mpz_class z = 33; |
| auto sum = z + z + z; |
| mpz_class prod = sum * 2; |
| @end example |
| |
| It is thus strongly recommended to avoid @code{auto} anywhere a GMP C++ |
| expression may appear. |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @node Custom Allocation, Language Bindings, C++ Class Interface, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @chapter Custom Allocation |
| @cindex Custom allocation |
| @cindex Memory allocation |
| @cindex Allocation of memory |
| |
| By default GMP uses @code{malloc}, @code{realloc} and @code{free} for memory |
| allocation, and if they fail GMP prints a message to the standard error output |
| and terminates the program. |
| |
| Alternate functions can be specified, to allocate memory in a different way or |
| to have a different error action on running out of memory. |
| |
| @deftypefun void mp_set_memory_functions (@* void *(*@var{alloc_func_ptr}) (size_t), @* void *(*@var{realloc_func_ptr}) (void *, size_t, size_t), @* void (*@var{free_func_ptr}) (void *, size_t)) |
| Replace the current allocation functions from the arguments. If an argument |
| is @code{NULL}, the corresponding default function is used. |
| |
| These functions will be used for all memory allocation done by GMP, apart from |
| temporary space from @code{alloca} if that function is available and GMP is |
| configured to use it (@pxref{Build Options}). |
| |
| @strong{Be sure to call @code{mp_set_memory_functions} only when there are no |
| active GMP objects allocated using the previous memory functions! Usually |
| that means calling it before any other GMP function.} |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| The functions supplied should fit the following declarations: |
| |
| @deftypevr Function {void *} allocate_function (size_t @var{alloc_size}) |
| Return a pointer to newly allocated space with at least @var{alloc_size} |
| bytes. |
| @end deftypevr |
| |
| @deftypevr Function {void *} reallocate_function (void *@var{ptr}, size_t @var{old_size}, size_t @var{new_size}) |
| Resize a previously allocated block @var{ptr} of @var{old_size} bytes to be |
| @var{new_size} bytes. |
| |
| The block may be moved if necessary or if desired, and in that case the |
| smaller of @var{old_size} and @var{new_size} bytes must be copied to the new |
| location. The return value is a pointer to the resized block, that being the |
| new location if moved or just @var{ptr} if not. |
| |
| @var{ptr} is never @code{NULL}, it's always a previously allocated block. |
| @var{new_size} may be bigger or smaller than @var{old_size}. |
| @end deftypevr |
| |
| @deftypevr Function void free_function (void *@var{ptr}, size_t @var{size}) |
| De-allocate the space pointed to by @var{ptr}. |
| |
| @var{ptr} is never @code{NULL}, it's always a previously allocated block of |
| @var{size} bytes. |
| @end deftypevr |
| |
| A @dfn{byte} here means the unit used by the @code{sizeof} operator. |
| |
| The @var{reallocate_function} parameter @var{old_size} and the |
| @var{free_function} parameter @var{size} are passed for convenience, but of |
| course they can be ignored if not needed by an implementation. The default |
| functions using @code{malloc} and friends for instance don't use them. |
| |
| No error return is allowed from any of these functions, if they return then |
| they must have performed the specified operation. In particular note that |
| @var{allocate_function} or @var{reallocate_function} mustn't return |
| @code{NULL}. |
| |
| Getting a different fatal error action is a good use for custom allocation |
| functions, for example giving a graphical dialog rather than the default print |
| to @code{stderr}. How much is possible when genuinely out of memory is |
| another question though. |
| |
| There's currently no defined way for the allocation functions to recover from |
| an error such as out of memory, they must terminate program execution. A |
| @code{longjmp} or throwing a C++ exception will have undefined results. This |
| may change in the future. |
| |
| GMP may use allocated blocks to hold pointers to other allocated blocks. This |
| will limit the assumptions a conservative garbage collection scheme can make. |
| |
| Since the default GMP allocation uses @code{malloc} and friends, those |
| functions will be linked in even if the first thing a program does is an |
| @code{mp_set_memory_functions}. It's necessary to change the GMP sources if |
| this is a problem. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @deftypefun void mp_get_memory_functions (@* void *(**@var{alloc_func_ptr}) (size_t), @* void *(**@var{realloc_func_ptr}) (void *, size_t, size_t), @* void (**@var{free_func_ptr}) (void *, size_t)) |
| Get the current allocation functions, storing function pointers to the |
| locations given by the arguments. If an argument is @code{NULL}, that |
| function pointer is not stored. |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| For example, to get just the current free function, |
| |
| @example |
| void (*freefunc) (void *, size_t); |
| |
| mp_get_memory_functions (NULL, NULL, &freefunc); |
| @end example |
| @end deftypefun |
| |
| @node Language Bindings, Algorithms, Custom Allocation, Top |
| @chapter Language Bindings |
| @cindex Language bindings |
| @cindex Other languages |
| |
| The following packages and projects offer access to GMP from languages other |
| than C, though perhaps with varying levels of functionality and efficiency. |
| |
| @c @spaceuref{U} is the same as @uref{U}, but with a couple of extra spaces |
| @c in tex, just to separate the URL from the preceding text a bit. |
| @iftex |
| @macro spaceuref {U} |
| @ @ @uref{\U\} |
| @end macro |
| @end iftex |
| @ifnottex |
| @macro spaceuref {U} |
| @uref{\U\} |
| @end macro |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @table @asis |
| @item C++ |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GMP C++ class interface, @pxref{C++ Class Interface} @* Straightforward |
| interface, expression templates to eliminate temporaries. |
| @item |
| ALP @spaceuref{https://www-sop.inria.fr/saga/logiciels/ALP/} @* Linear algebra and |
| polynomials using templates. |
| @item |
| CLN @spaceuref{https://www.ginac.de/CLN/} @* High level classes for arithmetic. |
| @item |
| Linbox @spaceuref{http://www.linalg.org/} @* Sparse vectors and matrices. |
| @item |
| NTL @spaceuref{http://www.shoup.net/ntl/} @* A C++ number theory library. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @c @item D |
| @c @itemize @bullet |
| @c @item |
| @c gmp-d @spaceuref{http://home.comcast.net/~benhinkle/gmp-d/} |
| @c @end itemize |
| |
| @item Eiffel |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Eiffelroom @spaceuref{http://www.eiffelroom.org/node/442} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @c @item Fortran |
| @c @itemize @bullet |
| @c @item |
| @c Omni F77 @spaceuref{http://phase.hpcc.jp/Omni/home.html} @* Arbitrary |
| @c precision floats. |
| @c @end itemize |
| |
| @item Haskell |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Glasgow Haskell Compiler @spaceuref{https://www.haskell.org/ghc/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Java |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Kaffe @spaceuref{https://github.com/kaffe/kaffe} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Lisp |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GNU Common Lisp @spaceuref{https://www.gnu.org/software/gcl/gcl.html} |
| @item |
| Librep @spaceuref{http://librep.sourceforge.net/} |
| @item |
| @c FIXME: When there's a stable release with gmp support, just refer to it |
| @c rather than bothering to talk about betas. |
| XEmacs (21.5.18 beta and up) @spaceuref{https://www.xemacs.org} @* Optional |
| big integers, rationals and floats using GMP. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item ML |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| MLton compiler @spaceuref{http://mlton.org/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Objective Caml |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| MLGMP @spaceuref{https://opam.ocaml.org/packages/mlgmp/} |
| @item |
| Numerix @spaceuref{http://pauillac.inria.fr/~quercia/} @* Optionally using |
| GMP. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Oz |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Mozart @spaceuref{https://mozart.github.io/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Pascal |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GNU Pascal Compiler @spaceuref{http://www.gnu-pascal.de/} @* GMP unit. |
| @item |
| Numerix @spaceuref{http://pauillac.inria.fr/~quercia/} @* For Free Pascal, |
| optionally using GMP. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Perl |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GMP module, see @file{demos/perl} in the GMP sources (@pxref{Demonstration |
| Programs}). |
| @item |
| Math::GMP @spaceuref{https://www.cpan.org/} @* Compatible with Math::BigInt, but |
| not as many functions as the GMP module above. |
| @item |
| Math::BigInt::GMP @spaceuref{https://www.cpan.org/} @* Plug Math::GMP into |
| normal Math::BigInt operations. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @item Pike |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| pikempz module in the standard distribution, @uref{https://pike.lysator.liu.se/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @need 500 |
| @item Prolog |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| SWI Prolog @spaceuref{http://www.swi-prolog.org/} @* |
| Arbitrary precision floats. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Python |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GMPY @uref{https://code.google.com/p/gmpy/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Ruby |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| @uref{https://rubygems.org/gems/gmp} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Scheme |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GNU Guile @spaceuref{https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/guile.html} |
| @item |
| RScheme @spaceuref{https://www.rscheme.org/} |
| @item |
| STklos @spaceuref{http://www.stklos.net/} |
| @c |
| @c For reference, MzScheme uses some of gmp, but (as of version 205) it only |
| @c has copies of some of the generic C code, and we don't consider that a |
| @c language binding to gmp. |
| @c |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Smalltalk |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| GNU Smalltalk @spaceuref{http://smalltalk.gnu.org/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @item Other |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Axiom @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/axiom} @* Computer algebra |
| using GCL. |
| @item |
| DrGenius @spaceuref{http://drgenius.seul.org/} @* Geometry system and |
| mathematical programming language. |
| @item |
| GiNaC @spaceuref{httsp://www.ginac.de/} @* C++ computer algebra using CLN. |
| @item |
| GOO @spaceuref{https://www.eecs.berkeley.edu/~jrb/goo/} @* Dynamic object oriented |
| language. |
| @item |
| Maxima @uref{https://www.ma.utexas.edu/users/wfs/maxima.html} @* Macsyma |
| computer algebra using GCL. |
| @c @item |
| @c Q @spaceuref{http://q-lang.sourceforge.net/} @* Equational programming system. |
| @item |
| Regina @spaceuref{http://regina.sourceforge.net/} @* Topological calculator. |
| @item |
| Yacas @spaceuref{http://yacas.sourceforge.net} @* Yet another computer algebra system. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @node Algorithms, Internals, Language Bindings, Top |
| @chapter Algorithms |
| @cindex Algorithms |
| |
| This chapter is an introduction to some of the algorithms used for various GMP |
| operations. The code is likely to be hard to understand without knowing |
| something about the algorithms. |
| |
| Some GMP internals are mentioned, but applications that expect to be |
| compatible with future GMP releases should take care to use only the |
| documented functions. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Multiplication Algorithms:: |
| * Division Algorithms:: |
| * Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms:: |
| * Powering Algorithms:: |
| * Root Extraction Algorithms:: |
| * Radix Conversion Algorithms:: |
| * Other Algorithms:: |
| * Assembly Coding:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Multiplication Algorithms, Division Algorithms, Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Multiplication |
| @cindex Multiplication algorithms |
| |
| N@cross{}N limb multiplications and squares are done using one of seven |
| algorithms, as the size N increases. |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {KaratsubaMMM} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item Algorithm @tab Threshold |
| @item Basecase @tab (none) |
| @item Karatsuba @tab @code{MUL_TOOM22_THRESHOLD} |
| @item Toom-3 @tab @code{MUL_TOOM33_THRESHOLD} |
| @item Toom-4 @tab @code{MUL_TOOM44_THRESHOLD} |
| @item Toom-6.5 @tab @code{MUL_TOOM6H_THRESHOLD} |
| @item Toom-8.5 @tab @code{MUL_TOOM8H_THRESHOLD} |
| @item FFT @tab @code{MUL_FFT_THRESHOLD} |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| Similarly for squaring, with the @code{SQR} thresholds. |
| |
| N@cross{}M multiplications of operands with different sizes above |
| @code{MUL_TOOM22_THRESHOLD} are currently done by special Toom-inspired |
| algorithms or directly with FFT, depending on operand size (@pxref{Unbalanced |
| Multiplication}). |
| |
| @menu |
| * Basecase Multiplication:: |
| * Karatsuba Multiplication:: |
| * Toom 3-Way Multiplication:: |
| * Toom 4-Way Multiplication:: |
| * Higher degree Toom'n'half:: |
| * FFT Multiplication:: |
| * Other Multiplication:: |
| * Unbalanced Multiplication:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Basecase Multiplication, Karatsuba Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Basecase Multiplication |
| |
| Basecase N@cross{}M multiplication is a straightforward rectangular set of |
| cross-products, the same as long multiplication done by hand and for that |
| reason sometimes known as the schoolbook or grammar school method. This is an |
| @m{O(NM),O(N*M)} algorithm. See Knuth section 4.3.1 algorithm M |
| (@pxref{References}), and the @file{mpn/generic/mul_basecase.c} code. |
| |
| Assembly implementations of @code{mpn_mul_basecase} are essentially the same |
| as the generic C code, but have all the usual assembly tricks and |
| obscurities introduced for speed. |
| |
| A square can be done in roughly half the time of a multiply, by using the fact |
| that the cross products above and below the diagonal are the same. A triangle |
| of products below the diagonal is formed, doubled (left shift by one bit), and |
| then the products on the diagonal added. This can be seen in |
| @file{mpn/generic/sqr_basecase.c}. Again the assembly implementations take |
| essentially the same approach. |
| |
| @tex |
| \def\GMPline#1#2#3#4#5#6{% |
| \hbox {% |
| \vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex |
| \hbox to 2em {\hfil{#2}\hfil}% |
| \vrule \hbox to 2em {\hfil{#3}\hfil}% |
| \vrule \hbox to 2em {\hfil{#4}\hfil}% |
| \vrule \hbox to 2em {\hfil{#5}\hfil}% |
| \vrule \hbox to 2em {\hfil{#6}\hfil}% |
| \vrule}} |
| \GMPdisplay{ |
| \hbox{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 1.5em {\vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex width 0pt}% |
| \hbox {\vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex width 0pt u0\hfil}% |
| \hbox {\vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex width 0pt u1\hfil}% |
| \hbox {\vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex width 0pt u2\hfil}% |
| \hbox {\vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex width 0pt u3\hfil}% |
| \hbox {\vrule height 2.5ex depth 1ex width 0pt u4\hfil}% |
| \vfill}% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox{% |
| \hbox to 2em {\hfil u0\hfil}% |
| \hbox to 2em {\hfil u1\hfil}% |
| \hbox to 2em {\hfil u2\hfil}% |
| \hbox to 2em {\hfil u3\hfil}% |
| \hbox to 2em {\hfil u4\hfil}}% |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \hrule |
| \GMPline{u0}{d}{}{}{}{}% |
| \hrule |
| \GMPline{u1}{}{d}{}{}{}% |
| \hrule |
| \GMPline{u2}{}{}{d}{}{}% |
| \hrule |
| \GMPline{u3}{}{}{}{d}{}% |
| \hrule |
| \GMPline{u4}{}{}{}{}{d}% |
| \hrule}}} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| u0 u1 u2 u3 u4 |
| +---+---+---+---+---+ |
| u0 | d | | | | | |
| +---+---+---+---+---+ |
| u1 | | d | | | | |
| +---+---+---+---+---+ |
| u2 | | | d | | | |
| +---+---+---+---+---+ |
| u3 | | | | d | | |
| +---+---+---+---+---+ |
| u4 | | | | | d | |
| +---+---+---+---+---+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| In practice squaring isn't a full 2@cross{} faster than multiplying, it's |
| usually around 1.5@cross{}. Less than 1.5@cross{} probably indicates |
| @code{mpn_sqr_basecase} wants improving on that CPU. |
| |
| On some CPUs @code{mpn_mul_basecase} can be faster than the generic C |
| @code{mpn_sqr_basecase} on some small sizes. @code{SQR_BASECASE_THRESHOLD} is |
| the size at which to use @code{mpn_sqr_basecase}, this will be zero if that |
| routine should be used always. |
| |
| |
| @node Karatsuba Multiplication, Toom 3-Way Multiplication, Basecase Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Karatsuba Multiplication |
| @cindex Karatsuba multiplication |
| |
| The Karatsuba multiplication algorithm is described in Knuth section 4.3.3 |
| part A, and various other textbooks. A brief description is given here. |
| |
| The inputs @math{x} and @math{y} are treated as each split into two parts of |
| equal length (or the most significant part one limb shorter if N is odd). |
| |
| @tex |
| % GMPboxwidth used for all the multiplication pictures |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxwidth \global\GMPboxwidth=5em |
| % GMPboxdepth and GMPboxheight are also used for the float pictures |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxdepth \global\GMPboxdepth=1ex |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxheight \global\GMPboxheight=2ex |
| \gdef\GMPvrule{\vrule height \GMPboxheight depth \GMPboxdepth} |
| \def\GMPbox#1#2{% |
| \vbox {% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth{% |
| \GMPvrule \hfil $#1$\hfil \vrule \hfil $#2$\hfil \vrule}% |
| \hrule}} |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth {high \hfil low} |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \GMPbox{x_1}{x_0} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{y_1}{y_0} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| high low |
| +----------+----------+ |
| | x1 | x0 | |
| +----------+----------+ |
| |
| +----------+----------+ |
| | y1 | y0 | |
| +----------+----------+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| Let @math{b} be the power of 2 where the split occurs, i.e.@: if @ms{x,0} is |
| @math{k} limbs (@ms{y,0} the same) then |
| @m{b=2\GMPraise{$k*$@code{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}}, b=2^(k*mp_bits_per_limb)}. |
| With that @m{x=x_1b+x_0,x=x1*b+x0} and @m{y=y_1b+y_0,y=y1*b+y0}, and the |
| following holds, |
| |
| @display |
| @m{xy = (b^2+b)x_1y_1 - b(x_1-x_0)(y_1-y_0) + (b+1)x_0y_0, |
| x*y = (b^2+b)*x1*y1 - b*(x1-x0)*(y1-y0) + (b+1)*x0*y0} |
| @end display |
| |
| This formula means doing only three multiplies of (N/2)@cross{}(N/2) limbs, |
| whereas a basecase multiply of N@cross{}N limbs is equivalent to four |
| multiplies of (N/2)@cross{}(N/2). The factors @math{(b^2+b)} etc represent |
| the positions where the three products must be added. |
| |
| @tex |
| \def\GMPboxA#1#2{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox{% |
| \GMPvrule |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth {\hfil\hbox{$#1$}\hfil}% |
| \vrule |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth {\hfil\hbox{$#2$}\hfil}% |
| \vrule} |
| \hrule}} |
| \def\GMPboxB#1#2{% |
| \hbox{% |
| \raise \GMPboxdepth \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {\hfil #1\hskip 0.5em}% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox{% |
| \GMPvrule |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth {\hfil\hbox{$#2$}\hfil}% |
| \vrule}% |
| \hrule}}} |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 4\GMPboxwidth {high \hfil low} |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \GMPboxA{x_1y_1}{x_0y_0} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPboxB{$+$}{x_1y_1} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPboxB{$+$}{x_0y_0} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPboxB{$-$}{(x_1-x_0)(y_1-y_0)} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| high low |
| +--------+--------+ +--------+--------+ |
| | x1*y1 | | x0*y0 | |
| +--------+--------+ +--------+--------+ |
| +--------+--------+ |
| add | x1*y1 | |
| +--------+--------+ |
| +--------+--------+ |
| add | x0*y0 | |
| +--------+--------+ |
| +--------+--------+ |
| sub | (x1-x0)*(y1-y0) | |
| +--------+--------+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| The term @m{(x_1-x_0)(y_1-y_0),(x1-x0)*(y1-y0)} is best calculated as an |
| absolute value, and the sign used to choose to add or subtract. Notice the |
| sum @m{\mathop{\rm high}(x_0y_0)+\mathop{\rm low}(x_1y_1), |
| high(x0*y0)+low(x1*y1)} occurs twice, so it's possible to do @m{5k,5*k} limb |
| additions, rather than @m{6k,6*k}, but in GMP extra function call overheads |
| outweigh the saving. |
| |
| Squaring is similar to multiplying, but with @math{x=y} the formula reduces to |
| an equivalent with three squares, |
| |
| @display |
| @m{x^2 = (b^2+b)x_1^2 - b(x_1-x_0)^2 + (b+1)x_0^2, |
| x^2 = (b^2+b)*x1^2 - b*(x1-x0)^2 + (b+1)*x0^2} |
| @end display |
| |
| The final result is accumulated from those three squares the same way as for |
| the three multiplies above. The middle term @m{(x_1-x_0)^2,(x1-x0)^2} is now |
| always positive. |
| |
| A similar formula for both multiplying and squaring can be constructed with a |
| middle term @m{(x_1+x_0)(y_1+y_0),(x1+x0)*(y1+y0)}. But those sums can exceed |
| @math{k} limbs, leading to more carry handling and additions than the form |
| above. |
| |
| Karatsuba multiplication is asymptotically an @math{O(N^@W{1.585})} algorithm, |
| the exponent being @m{\log3/\log2,log(3)/log(2)}, representing 3 multiplies |
| each @math{1/2} the size of the inputs. This is a big improvement over the |
| basecase multiply at @math{O(N^2)} and the advantage soon overcomes the extra |
| additions Karatsuba performs. @code{MUL_TOOM22_THRESHOLD} can be as little |
| as 10 limbs. The @code{SQR} threshold is usually about twice the @code{MUL}. |
| |
| The basecase algorithm will take a time of the form @m{M(N) = aN^2 + bN + c, |
| M(N) = a*N^2 + b*N + c} and the Karatsuba algorithm @m{K(N) = 3M(N/2) + dN + |
| e, K(N) = 3*M(N/2) + d*N + e}, which expands to @m{K(N) = {3\over4} aN^2 + |
| {3\over2} bN + 3c + dN + e, K(N) = 3/4*a*N^2 + 3/2*b*N + 3*c + d*N + e}. The |
| factor @m{3\over4, 3/4} for @math{a} means per-crossproduct speedups in the |
| basecase code will increase the threshold since they benefit @math{M(N)} more |
| than @math{K(N)}. And conversely the @m{3\over2, 3/2} for @math{b} means |
| linear style speedups of @math{b} will increase the threshold since they |
| benefit @math{K(N)} more than @math{M(N)}. The latter can be seen for |
| instance when adding an optimized @code{mpn_sqr_diagonal} to |
| @code{mpn_sqr_basecase}. Of course all speedups reduce total time, and in |
| that sense the algorithm thresholds are merely of academic interest. |
| |
| |
| @node Toom 3-Way Multiplication, Toom 4-Way Multiplication, Karatsuba Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Toom 3-Way Multiplication |
| @cindex Toom multiplication |
| |
| The Karatsuba formula is the simplest case of a general approach to splitting |
| inputs that leads to both Toom and FFT algorithms. A description of |
| Toom can be found in Knuth section 4.3.3, with an example 3-way |
| calculation after Theorem A@. The 3-way form used in GMP is described here. |
| |
| The operands are each considered split into 3 pieces of equal length (or the |
| most significant part 1 or 2 limbs shorter than the other two). |
| |
| @tex |
| \def\GMPbox#1#2#3{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule \vfil |
| \hbox to 3\GMPboxwidth {% |
| \GMPvrule |
| \hfil$#1$\hfil |
| \vrule |
| \hfil$#2$\hfil |
| \vrule |
| \hfil$#3$\hfil |
| \vrule}% |
| \vfil \hrule |
| }} |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 3\GMPboxwidth {high \hfil low} |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \GMPbox{x_2}{x_1}{x_0} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{y_2}{y_1}{y_0} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| high low |
| +----------+----------+----------+ |
| | x2 | x1 | x0 | |
| +----------+----------+----------+ |
| |
| +----------+----------+----------+ |
| | y2 | y1 | y0 | |
| +----------+----------+----------+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @noindent |
| These parts are treated as the coefficients of two polynomials |
| |
| @display |
| @group |
| @m{X(t) = x_2t^2 + x_1t + x_0, |
| X(t) = x2*t^2 + x1*t + x0} |
| @m{Y(t) = y_2t^2 + y_1t + y_0, |
| Y(t) = y2*t^2 + y1*t + y0} |
| @end group |
| @end display |
| |
| Let @math{b} equal the power of 2 which is the size of the @ms{x,0}, @ms{x,1}, |
| @ms{y,0} and @ms{y,1} pieces, i.e.@: if they're @math{k} limbs each then |
| @m{b=2\GMPraise{$k*$@code{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}}, b=2^(k*mp_bits_per_limb)}. |
| With this @math{x=X(b)} and @math{y=Y(b)}. |
| |
| Let a polynomial @m{W(t)=X(t)Y(t),W(t)=X(t)*Y(t)} and suppose its coefficients |
| are |
| |
| @display |
| @m{W(t) = w_4t^4 + w_3t^3 + w_2t^2 + w_1t + w_0, |
| W(t) = w4*t^4 + w3*t^3 + w2*t^2 + w1*t + w0} |
| @end display |
| |
| The @m{w_i,w[i]} are going to be determined, and when they are they'll give |
| the final result using @math{w=W(b)}, since |
| @m{xy=X(b)Y(b),x*y=X(b)*Y(b)=W(b)}. The coefficients will be roughly |
| @math{b^2} each, and the final @math{W(b)} will be an addition like, |
| |
| @tex |
| \def\GMPbox#1#2{% |
| \moveright #1\GMPboxwidth |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox{% |
| \GMPvrule |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth {\hfil$#2$\hfil}% |
| \vrule}% |
| \hrule |
| }} |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 6\GMPboxwidth {high \hfil low}% |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \GMPbox{0}{w_4} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{1}{w_3} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{2}{w_2} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{3}{w_1} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{4}{w_0} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| high low |
| +-------+-------+ |
| | w4 | |
| +-------+-------+ |
| +--------+-------+ |
| | w3 | |
| +--------+-------+ |
| +--------+-------+ |
| | w2 | |
| +--------+-------+ |
| +--------+-------+ |
| | w1 | |
| +--------+-------+ |
| +-------+-------+ |
| | w0 | |
| +-------+-------+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| The @m{w_i,w[i]} coefficients could be formed by a simple set of cross |
| products, like @m{w_4=x_2y_2,w4=x2*y2}, @m{w_3=x_2y_1+x_1y_2,w3=x2*y1+x1*y2}, |
| @m{w_2=x_2y_0+x_1y_1+x_0y_2,w2=x2*y0+x1*y1+x0*y2} etc, but this would need all |
| nine @m{x_iy_j,x[i]*y[j]} for @math{i,j=0,1,2}, and would be equivalent merely |
| to a basecase multiply. Instead the following approach is used. |
| |
| @math{X(t)} and @math{Y(t)} are evaluated and multiplied at 5 points, giving |
| values of @math{W(t)} at those points. In GMP the following points are used, |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {@m{t=\infty,t=inf}M} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item Point @tab Value |
| @item @math{t=0} @tab @m{x_0y_0,x0 * y0}, which gives @ms{w,0} immediately |
| @item @math{t=1} @tab @m{(x_2+x_1+x_0)(y_2+y_1+y_0),(x2+x1+x0) * (y2+y1+y0)} |
| @item @math{t=-1} @tab @m{(x_2-x_1+x_0)(y_2-y_1+y_0),(x2-x1+x0) * (y2-y1+y0)} |
| @item @math{t=2} @tab @m{(4x_2+2x_1+x_0)(4y_2+2y_1+y_0),(4*x2+2*x1+x0) * (4*y2+2*y1+y0)} |
| @item @m{t=\infty,t=inf} @tab @m{x_2y_2,x2 * y2}, which gives @ms{w,4} immediately |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| At @math{t=-1} the values can be negative and that's handled using the |
| absolute values and tracking the sign separately. At @m{t=\infty,t=inf} the |
| value is actually @m{\lim_{t\to\infty} {X(t)Y(t)\over t^4}, X(t)*Y(t)/t^4 in |
| the limit as t approaches infinity}, but it's much easier to think of as |
| simply @m{x_2y_2,x2*y2} giving @ms{w,4} immediately (much like |
| @m{x_0y_0,x0*y0} at @math{t=0} gives @ms{w,0} immediately). |
| |
| Each of the points substituted into |
| @m{W(t)=w_4t^4+\cdots+w_0,W(t)=w4*t^4+@dots{}+w0} gives a linear combination |
| of the @m{w_i,w[i]} coefficients, and the value of those combinations has just |
| been calculated. |
| |
| @tex |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| $\matrix{% |
| W(0) & = & & & & & & & & & w_0 \cr |
| W(1) & = & w_4 & + & w_3 & + & w_2 & + & w_1 & + & w_0 \cr |
| W(-1) & = & w_4 & - & w_3 & + & w_2 & - & w_1 & + & w_0 \cr |
| W(2) & = & 16w_4 & + & 8w_3 & + & 4w_2 & + & 2w_1 & + & w_0 \cr |
| W(\infty) & = & w_4 \cr |
| }$} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| W(0) = w0 |
| W(1) = w4 + w3 + w2 + w1 + w0 |
| W(-1) = w4 - w3 + w2 - w1 + w0 |
| W(2) = 16*w4 + 8*w3 + 4*w2 + 2*w1 + w0 |
| W(inf) = w4 |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| This is a set of five equations in five unknowns, and some elementary linear |
| algebra quickly isolates each @m{w_i,w[i]}. This involves adding or |
| subtracting one @math{W(t)} value from another, and a couple of divisions by |
| powers of 2 and one division by 3, the latter using the special |
| @code{mpn_divexact_by3} (@pxref{Exact Division}). |
| |
| The conversion of @math{W(t)} values to the coefficients is interpolation. A |
| polynomial of degree 4 like @math{W(t)} is uniquely determined by values known |
| at 5 different points. The points are arbitrary and can be chosen to make the |
| linear equations come out with a convenient set of steps for quickly isolating |
| the @m{w_i,w[i]}. |
| |
| Squaring follows the same procedure as multiplication, but there's only one |
| @math{X(t)} and it's evaluated at the 5 points, and those values squared to |
| give values of @math{W(t)}. The interpolation is then identical, and in fact |
| the same @code{toom_interpolate_5pts} subroutine is used for both squaring and |
| multiplying. |
| |
| Toom-3 is asymptotically @math{O(N^@W{1.465})}, the exponent being |
| @m{\log5/\log3,log(5)/log(3)}, representing 5 recursive multiplies of 1/3 the |
| original size each. This is an improvement over Karatsuba at |
| @math{O(N^@W{1.585})}, though Toom does more work in the evaluation and |
| interpolation and so it only realizes its advantage above a certain size. |
| |
| Near the crossover between Toom-3 and Karatsuba there's generally a range of |
| sizes where the difference between the two is small. |
| @code{MUL_TOOM33_THRESHOLD} is a somewhat arbitrary point in that range and |
| successive runs of the tune program can give different values due to small |
| variations in measuring. A graph of time versus size for the two shows the |
| effect, see @file{tune/README}. |
| |
| At the fairly small sizes where the Toom-3 thresholds occur it's worth |
| remembering that the asymptotic behaviour for Karatsuba and Toom-3 can't be |
| expected to make accurate predictions, due of course to the big influence of |
| all sorts of overheads, and the fact that only a few recursions of each are |
| being performed. Even at large sizes there's a good chance machine dependent |
| effects like cache architecture will mean actual performance deviates from |
| what might be predicted. |
| |
| The formula given for the Karatsuba algorithm (@pxref{Karatsuba |
| Multiplication}) has an equivalent for Toom-3 involving only five multiplies, |
| but this would be complicated and unenlightening. |
| |
| An alternate view of Toom-3 can be found in Zuras (@pxref{References}), using |
| a vector to represent the @math{x} and @math{y} splits and a matrix |
| multiplication for the evaluation and interpolation stages. The matrix |
| inverses are not meant to be actually used, and they have elements with values |
| much greater than in fact arise in the interpolation steps. The diagram shown |
| for the 3-way is attractive, but again doesn't have to be implemented that way |
| and for example with a bit of rearrangement just one division by 6 can be |
| done. |
| |
| |
| @node Toom 4-Way Multiplication, Higher degree Toom'n'half, Toom 3-Way Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Toom 4-Way Multiplication |
| @cindex Toom multiplication |
| |
| Karatsuba and Toom-3 split the operands into 2 and 3 coefficients, |
| respectively. Toom-4 analogously splits the operands into 4 coefficients. |
| Using the notation from the section on Toom-3 multiplication, we form two |
| polynomials: |
| |
| @display |
| @group |
| @m{X(t) = x_3t^3 + x_2t^2 + x_1t + x_0, |
| X(t) = x3*t^3 + x2*t^2 + x1*t + x0} |
| @m{Y(t) = y_3t^3 + y_2t^2 + y_1t + y_0, |
| Y(t) = y3*t^3 + y2*t^2 + y1*t + y0} |
| @end group |
| @end display |
| |
| @math{X(t)} and @math{Y(t)} are evaluated and multiplied at 7 points, giving |
| values of @math{W(t)} at those points. In GMP the following points are used, |
| |
| @quotation |
| @multitable {@m{t=-1/2,t=inf}M} {MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM} |
| @item Point @tab Value |
| @item @math{t=0} @tab @m{x_0y_0,x0 * y0}, which gives @ms{w,0} immediately |
| @item @math{t=1/2} @tab @m{(x_3+2x_2+4x_1+8x_0)(y_3+2y_2+4y_1+8y_0),(x3+2*x2+4*x1+8*x0) * (y3+2*y2+4*y1+8*y0)} |
| @item @math{t=-1/2} @tab @m{(-x_3+2x_2-4x_1+8x_0)(-y_3+2y_2-4y_1+8y_0),(-x3+2*x2-4*x1+8*x0) * (-y3+2*y2-4*y1+8*y0)} |
| @item @math{t=1} @tab @m{(x_3+x_2+x_1+x_0)(y_3+y_2+y_1+y_0),(x3+x2+x1+x0) * (y3+y2+y1+y0)} |
| @item @math{t=-1} @tab @m{(-x_3+x_2-x_1+x_0)(-y_3+y_2-y_1+y_0),(-x3+x2-x1+x0) * (-y3+y2-y1+y0)} |
| @item @math{t=2} @tab @m{(8x_3+4x_2+2x_1+x_0)(8y_3+4y_2+2y_1+y_0),(8*x3+4*x2+2*x1+x0) * (8*y3+4*y2+2*y1+y0)} |
| @item @m{t=\infty,t=inf} @tab @m{x_3y_3,x3 * y3}, which gives @ms{w,6} immediately |
| @end multitable |
| @end quotation |
| |
| The number of additions and subtractions for Toom-4 is much larger than for Toom-3. |
| But several subexpressions occur multiple times, for example @m{x_2+x_0,x2+x0}, occurs |
| for both @math{t=1} and @math{t=-1}. |
| |
| Toom-4 is asymptotically @math{O(N^@W{1.404})}, the exponent being |
| @m{\log7/\log4,log(7)/log(4)}, representing 7 recursive multiplies of 1/4 the |
| original size each. |
| |
| |
| @node Higher degree Toom'n'half, FFT Multiplication, Toom 4-Way Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Higher degree Toom'n'half |
| @cindex Toom multiplication |
| |
| The Toom algorithms described above (@pxref{Toom 3-Way Multiplication}, |
| @pxref{Toom 4-Way Multiplication}) generalizes to split into an arbitrary |
| number of pieces. In general a split of two equally long operands into |
| @math{r} pieces leads to evaluations and pointwise multiplications done at |
| @m{2r-1,2*r-1} points. To fully exploit symmetries it would be better to have |
| a multiple of 4 points, that's why for higher degree Toom'n'half is used. |
| |
| Toom'n'half means that the existence of one more piece is considered for a |
| single operand. It can be virtual, i.e. zero, or real, when the two operand |
| are not exactly balanced. By choosing an even @math{r}, |
| Toom-@m{r{1\over2},r+1/2} requires @math{2r} points, a multiple of four. |
| |
| The quadruplets of points include 0, @m{\infty,inf}, +1, -1 and |
| @m{\pm2^i,+-2^i}, @m{\pm2^{-i},+-2^-i} . Each of them giving shortcuts for the |
| evaluation phase and for some steps in the interpolation phase. Further tricks |
| are used to reduce the memory footprint of the whole multiplication algorithm |
| to a memory buffer equal in size to the result of the product. |
| |
| Current GMP uses both Toom-6'n'half and Toom-8'n'half. |
| |
| |
| @node FFT Multiplication, Other Multiplication, Higher degree Toom'n'half, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection FFT Multiplication |
| @cindex FFT multiplication |
| @cindex Fast Fourier Transform |
| |
| At large to very large sizes a Fermat style FFT multiplication is used, |
| following Sch@"onhage and Strassen (@pxref{References}). Descriptions of FFTs |
| in various forms can be found in many textbooks, for instance Knuth section |
| 4.3.3 part C or Lipson chapter IX@. A brief description of the form used in |
| GMP is given here. |
| |
| The multiplication done is @m{xy \bmod 2^N+1, x*y mod 2^N+1}, for a given |
| @math{N}. A full product @m{xy,x*y} is obtained by choosing @m{N \ge |
| \mathop{\rm bits}(x)+\mathop{\rm bits}(y), N>=bits(x)+bits(y)} and padding |
| @math{x} and @math{y} with high zero limbs. The modular product is the native |
| form for the algorithm, so padding to get a full product is unavoidable. |
| |
| The algorithm follows a split, evaluate, pointwise multiply, interpolate and |
| combine similar to that described above for Karatsuba and Toom-3. A @math{k} |
| parameter controls the split, with an FFT-@math{k} splitting into @math{2^k} |
| pieces of @math{M=N/2^k} bits each. @math{N} must be a multiple of |
| @m{2^k\times@code{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}, (2^k)*@nicode{mp_bits_per_limb}} so |
| the split falls on limb boundaries, avoiding bit shifts in the split and |
| combine stages. |
| |
| The evaluations, pointwise multiplications, and interpolation, are all done |
| modulo @m{2^{N'}+1, 2^N'+1} where @math{N'} is @math{2M+k+3} rounded up to a |
| multiple of @math{2^k} and of @code{mp_bits_per_limb}. The results of |
| interpolation will be the following negacyclic convolution of the input |
| pieces, and the choice of @math{N'} ensures these sums aren't truncated. |
| @tex |
| $$ w_n = \sum_{{i+j = b2^k+n}\atop{b=0,1}} (-1)^b x_i y_j $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| --- |
| \ b |
| w[n] = / (-1) * x[i] * y[j] |
| --- |
| i+j==b*2^k+n |
| b=0,1 |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| The points used for the evaluation are @math{g^i} for @math{i=0} to |
| @math{2^k-1} where @m{g=2^{2N'/2^k}, g=2^(2N'/2^k)}. @math{g} is a |
| @m{2^k,2^k'}th root of unity mod @m{2^{N'}+1,2^N'+1}, which produces necessary |
| cancellations at the interpolation stage, and it's also a power of 2 so the |
| fast Fourier transforms used for the evaluation and interpolation do only |
| shifts, adds and negations. |
| |
| The pointwise multiplications are done modulo @m{2^{N'}+1, 2^N'+1} and either |
| recurse into a further FFT or use a plain multiplication (Toom-3, Karatsuba or |
| basecase), whichever is optimal at the size @math{N'}. The interpolation is |
| an inverse fast Fourier transform. The resulting set of sums of @m{x_iy_j, |
| x[i]*y[j]} are added at appropriate offsets to give the final result. |
| |
| Squaring is the same, but @math{x} is the only input so it's one transform at |
| the evaluate stage and the pointwise multiplies are squares. The |
| interpolation is the same. |
| |
| For a mod @math{2^N+1} product, an FFT-@math{k} is an @m{O(N^{k/(k-1)}), |
| O(N^(k/(k-1)))} algorithm, the exponent representing @math{2^k} recursed |
| modular multiplies each @m{1/2^{k-1},1/2^(k-1)} the size of the original. |
| Each successive @math{k} is an asymptotic improvement, but overheads mean each |
| is only faster at bigger and bigger sizes. In the code, @code{MUL_FFT_TABLE} |
| and @code{SQR_FFT_TABLE} are the thresholds where each @math{k} is used. Each |
| new @math{k} effectively swaps some multiplying for some shifts, adds and |
| overheads. |
| |
| A mod @math{2^N+1} product can be formed with a normal |
| @math{N@cross{}N@rightarrow{}2N} bit multiply plus a subtraction, so an FFT |
| and Toom-3 etc can be compared directly. A @math{k=4} FFT at |
| @math{O(N^@W{1.333})} can be expected to be the first faster than Toom-3 at |
| @math{O(N^@W{1.465})}. In practice this is what's found, with |
| @code{MUL_FFT_MODF_THRESHOLD} and @code{SQR_FFT_MODF_THRESHOLD} being between |
| 300 and 1000 limbs, depending on the CPU@. So far it's been found that only |
| very large FFTs recurse into pointwise multiplies above these sizes. |
| |
| When an FFT is to give a full product, the change of @math{N} to @math{2N} |
| doesn't alter the theoretical complexity for a given @math{k}, but for the |
| purposes of considering where an FFT might be first used it can be assumed |
| that the FFT is recursing into a normal multiply and that on that basis it's |
| doing @math{2^k} recursed multiplies each @m{1/2^{k-2},1/2^(k-2)} the size of |
| the inputs, making it @m{O(N^{k/(k-2)}), O(N^(k/(k-2)))}. This would mean |
| @math{k=7} at @math{O(N^@W{1.4})} would be the first FFT faster than Toom-3. |
| In practice @code{MUL_FFT_THRESHOLD} and @code{SQR_FFT_THRESHOLD} have been |
| found to be in the @math{k=8} range, somewhere between 3000 and 10000 limbs. |
| |
| The way @math{N} is split into @math{2^k} pieces and then @math{2M+k+3} is |
| rounded up to a multiple of @math{2^k} and @code{mp_bits_per_limb} means that |
| when @math{2^k@ge{}@nicode{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}} the effective @math{N} is a |
| multiple of @m{2^{2k-1},2^(2k-1)} bits. The @math{+k+3} means some values of |
| @math{N} just under such a multiple will be rounded to the next. The |
| complexity calculations above assume that a favourable size is used, meaning |
| one which isn't padded through rounding, and it's also assumed that the extra |
| @math{+k+3} bits are negligible at typical FFT sizes. |
| |
| The practical effect of the @m{2^{2k-1},2^(2k-1)} constraint is to introduce a |
| step-effect into measured speeds. For example @math{k=8} will round @math{N} |
| up to a multiple of 32768 bits, so for a 32-bit limb there'll be 512 limb |
| groups of sizes for which @code{mpn_mul_n} runs at the same speed. Or for |
| @math{k=9} groups of 2048 limbs, @math{k=10} groups of 8192 limbs, etc. In |
| practice it's been found each @math{k} is used at quite small multiples of its |
| size constraint and so the step effect is quite noticeable in a time versus |
| size graph. |
| |
| The threshold determinations currently measure at the mid-points of size |
| steps, but this is sub-optimal since at the start of a new step it can happen |
| that it's better to go back to the previous @math{k} for a while. Something |
| more sophisticated for @code{MUL_FFT_TABLE} and @code{SQR_FFT_TABLE} will be |
| needed. |
| |
| |
| @node Other Multiplication, Unbalanced Multiplication, FFT Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Other Multiplication |
| @cindex Toom multiplication |
| |
| The Toom algorithms described above (@pxref{Toom 3-Way Multiplication}, |
| @pxref{Toom 4-Way Multiplication}) generalizes to split into an arbitrary |
| number of pieces, as per Knuth section 4.3.3 algorithm C@. This is not |
| currently used. The notes here are merely for interest. |
| |
| In general a split into @math{r+1} pieces is made, and evaluations and |
| pointwise multiplications done at @m{2r+1,2*r+1} points. A 4-way split does 7 |
| pointwise multiplies, 5-way does 9, etc. Asymptotically an @math{(r+1)}-way |
| algorithm is @m{O(N^{log(2r+1)/log(r+1)}), O(N^(log(2*r+1)/log(r+1)))}. Only |
| the pointwise multiplications count towards big-@math{O} complexity, but the |
| time spent in the evaluate and interpolate stages grows with @math{r} and has |
| a significant practical impact, with the asymptotic advantage of each @math{r} |
| realized only at bigger and bigger sizes. The overheads grow as |
| @m{O(Nr),O(N*r)}, whereas in an @math{r=2^k} FFT they grow only as @m{O(N \log |
| r), O(N*log(r))}. |
| |
| Knuth algorithm C evaluates at points 0,1,2,@dots{},@m{2r,2*r}, but exercise 4 |
| uses @math{-r},@dots{},0,@dots{},@math{r} and the latter saves some small |
| multiplies in the evaluate stage (or rather trades them for additions), and |
| has a further saving of nearly half the interpolate steps. The idea is to |
| separate odd and even final coefficients and then perform algorithm C steps C7 |
| and C8 on them separately. The divisors at step C7 become @math{j^2} and the |
| multipliers at C8 become @m{2tj-j^2,2*t*j-j^2}. |
| |
| Splitting odd and even parts through positive and negative points can be |
| thought of as using @math{-1} as a square root of unity. If a 4th root of |
| unity was available then a further split and speedup would be possible, but no |
| such root exists for plain integers. Going to complex integers with |
| @m{i=\sqrt{-1}, i=sqrt(-1)} doesn't help, essentially because in Cartesian |
| form it takes three real multiplies to do a complex multiply. The existence |
| of @m{2^k,2^k'}th roots of unity in a suitable ring or field lets the fast |
| Fourier transform keep splitting and get to @m{O(N \log r), O(N*log(r))}. |
| |
| Floating point FFTs use complex numbers approximating Nth roots of unity. |
| Some processors have special support for such FFTs. But these are not used in |
| GMP since it's very difficult to guarantee an exact result (to some number of |
| bits). An occasional difference of 1 in the last bit might not matter to a |
| typical signal processing algorithm, but is of course of vital importance to |
| GMP. |
| |
| |
| @node Unbalanced Multiplication, , Other Multiplication, Multiplication Algorithms |
| @subsection Unbalanced Multiplication |
| @cindex Unbalanced multiplication |
| |
| Multiplication of operands with different sizes, both below |
| @code{MUL_TOOM22_THRESHOLD} are done with plain schoolbook multiplication |
| (@pxref{Basecase Multiplication}). |
| |
| For really large operands, we invoke FFT directly. |
| |
| For operands between these sizes, we use Toom inspired algorithms suggested by |
| Alberto Zanoni and Marco Bodrato. The idea is to split the operands into |
| polynomials of different degree. GMP currently splits the smaller operand |
| onto 2 coefficients, i.e., a polynomial of degree 1, but the larger operand |
| can be split into 2, 3, or 4 coefficients, i.e., a polynomial of degree 1 to |
| 3. |
| |
| @c FIXME: This is mighty ugly, but a cleaner @need triggers texinfo bugs that |
| @c screws up layout here and there in the rest of the manual. |
| @c @tex |
| @c \goodbreak |
| @c @end tex |
| @node Division Algorithms, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms, Multiplication Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Division Algorithms |
| @cindex Division algorithms |
| |
| @menu |
| * Single Limb Division:: |
| * Basecase Division:: |
| * Divide and Conquer Division:: |
| * Block-Wise Barrett Division:: |
| * Exact Division:: |
| * Exact Remainder:: |
| * Small Quotient Division:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Single Limb Division, Basecase Division, Division Algorithms, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Single Limb Division |
| |
| N@cross{}1 division is implemented using repeated 2@cross{}1 divisions from |
| high to low, either with a hardware divide instruction or a multiplication by |
| inverse, whichever is best on a given CPU. |
| |
| The multiply by inverse follows ``Improved division by invariant integers'' by |
| M@"oller and Granlund (@pxref{References}) and is implemented as |
| @code{udiv_qrnnd_preinv} in @file{gmp-impl.h}. The idea is to have a |
| fixed-point approximation to @math{1/d} (see @code{invert_limb}) and then |
| multiply by the high limb (plus one bit) of the dividend to get a quotient |
| @math{q}. With @math{d} normalized (high bit set), @math{q} is no more than 1 |
| too small. Subtracting @m{qd,q*d} from the dividend gives a remainder, and |
| reveals whether @math{q} or @math{q-1} is correct. |
| |
| The result is a division done with two multiplications and four or five |
| arithmetic operations. On CPUs with low latency multipliers this can be much |
| faster than a hardware divide, though the cost of calculating the inverse at |
| the start may mean it's only better on inputs bigger than say 4 or 5 limbs. |
| |
| When a divisor must be normalized, either for the generic C |
| @code{__udiv_qrnnd_c} or the multiply by inverse, the division performed is |
| actually @m{a2^k,a*2^k} by @m{d2^k,d*2^k} where @math{a} is the dividend and |
| @math{k} is the power necessary to have the high bit of @m{d2^k,d*2^k} set. |
| The bit shifts for the dividend are usually accomplished ``on the fly'' |
| meaning by extracting the appropriate bits at each step. Done this way the |
| quotient limbs come out aligned ready to store. When only the remainder is |
| wanted, an alternative is to take the dividend limbs unshifted and calculate |
| @m{r = a \bmod d2^k, r = a mod d*2^k} followed by an extra final step @m{r2^k |
| \bmod d2^k, r*2^k mod d*2^k}. This can help on CPUs with poor bit shifts or |
| few registers. |
| |
| The multiply by inverse can be done two limbs at a time. The calculation is |
| basically the same, but the inverse is two limbs and the divisor treated as if |
| padded with a low zero limb. This means more work, since the inverse will |
| need a 2@cross{}2 multiply, but the four 1@cross{}1s to do that are |
| independent and can therefore be done partly or wholly in parallel. Likewise |
| for a 2@cross{}1 calculating @m{qd,q*d}. The net effect is to process two |
| limbs with roughly the same two multiplies worth of latency that one limb at a |
| time gives. This extends to 3 or 4 limbs at a time, though the extra work to |
| apply the inverse will almost certainly soon reach the limits of multiplier |
| throughput. |
| |
| A similar approach in reverse can be taken to process just half a limb at a |
| time if the divisor is only a half limb. In this case the 1@cross{}1 multiply |
| for the inverse effectively becomes two @m{{1\over2}\times1, (1/2)x1} for each |
| limb, which can be a saving on CPUs with a fast half limb multiply, or in fact |
| if the only multiply is a half limb, and especially if it's not pipelined. |
| |
| |
| @node Basecase Division, Divide and Conquer Division, Single Limb Division, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Basecase Division |
| |
| Basecase N@cross{}M division is like long division done by hand, but in base |
| @m{2\GMPraise{@code{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}}, 2^mp_bits_per_limb}. See Knuth |
| section 4.3.1 algorithm D, and @file{mpn/generic/sb_divrem_mn.c}. |
| |
| Briefly stated, while the dividend remains larger than the divisor, a high |
| quotient limb is formed and the N@cross{}1 product @m{qd,q*d} subtracted at |
| the top end of the dividend. With a normalized divisor (most significant bit |
| set), each quotient limb can be formed with a 2@cross{}1 division and a |
| 1@cross{}1 multiplication plus some subtractions. The 2@cross{}1 division is |
| by the high limb of the divisor and is done either with a hardware divide or a |
| multiply by inverse (the same as in @ref{Single Limb Division}) whichever is |
| faster. Such a quotient is sometimes one too big, requiring an addback of the |
| divisor, but that happens rarely. |
| |
| With Q=N@minus{}M being the number of quotient limbs, this is an |
| @m{O(QM),O(Q*M)} algorithm and will run at a speed similar to a basecase |
| Q@cross{}M multiplication, differing in fact only in the extra multiply and |
| divide for each of the Q quotient limbs. |
| |
| |
| @node Divide and Conquer Division, Block-Wise Barrett Division, Basecase Division, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Divide and Conquer Division |
| |
| For divisors larger than @code{DC_DIV_QR_THRESHOLD}, division is done by dividing. |
| Or to be precise by a recursive divide and conquer algorithm based on work by |
| Moenck and Borodin, Jebelean, and Burnikel and Ziegler (@pxref{References}). |
| |
| The algorithm consists essentially of recognising that a 2N@cross{}N division |
| can be done with the basecase division algorithm (@pxref{Basecase Division}), |
| but using N/2 limbs as a base, not just a single limb. This way the |
| multiplications that arise are (N/2)@cross{}(N/2) and can take advantage of |
| Karatsuba and higher multiplication algorithms (@pxref{Multiplication |
| Algorithms}). The two ``digits'' of the quotient are formed by recursive |
| N@cross{}(N/2) divisions. |
| |
| If the (N/2)@cross{}(N/2) multiplies are done with a basecase multiplication |
| then the work is about the same as a basecase division, but with more function |
| call overheads and with some subtractions separated from the multiplies. |
| These overheads mean that it's only when N/2 is above |
| @code{MUL_TOOM22_THRESHOLD} that divide and conquer is of use. |
| |
| @code{DC_DIV_QR_THRESHOLD} is based on the divisor size N, so it will be somewhere |
| above twice @code{MUL_TOOM22_THRESHOLD}, but how much above depends on the |
| CPU@. An optimized @code{mpn_mul_basecase} can lower @code{DC_DIV_QR_THRESHOLD} a |
| little by offering a ready-made advantage over repeated @code{mpn_submul_1} |
| calls. |
| |
| Divide and conquer is asymptotically @m{O(M(N)\log N),O(M(N)*log(N))} where |
| @math{M(N)} is the time for an N@cross{}N multiplication done with FFTs. The |
| actual time is a sum over multiplications of the recursed sizes, as can be |
| seen near the end of section 2.2 of Burnikel and Ziegler. For example, within |
| the Toom-3 range, divide and conquer is @m{2.63M(N), 2.63*M(N)}. With higher |
| algorithms the @math{M(N)} term improves and the multiplier tends to @m{\log |
| N, log(N)}. In practice, at moderate to large sizes, a 2N@cross{}N division |
| is about 2 to 4 times slower than an N@cross{}N multiplication. |
| |
| |
| @node Block-Wise Barrett Division, Exact Division, Divide and Conquer Division, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Block-Wise Barrett Division |
| |
| For the largest divisions, a block-wise Barrett division algorithm is used. |
| Here, the divisor is inverted to a precision determined by the relative size of |
| the dividend and divisor. Blocks of quotient limbs are then generated by |
| multiplying blocks from the dividend by the inverse. |
| |
| Our block-wise algorithm computes a smaller inverse than in the plain Barrett |
| algorithm. For a @math{2n/n} division, the inverse will be just @m{\lceil n/2 |
| \rceil, ceil(n/2)} limbs. |
| |
| |
| @node Exact Division, Exact Remainder, Block-Wise Barrett Division, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Exact Division |
| |
| |
| A so-called exact division is when the dividend is known to be an exact |
| multiple of the divisor. Jebelean's exact division algorithm uses this |
| knowledge to make some significant optimizations (@pxref{References}). |
| |
| The idea can be illustrated in decimal for example with 368154 divided by |
| 543. Because the low digit of the dividend is 4, the low digit of the |
| quotient must be 8. This is arrived at from @m{4 \mathord{\times} 7 \bmod 10, |
| 4*7 mod 10}, using the fact 7 is the modular inverse of 3 (the low digit of |
| the divisor), since @m{3 \mathord{\times} 7 \mathop{\equiv} 1 \bmod 10, 3*7 |
| @equiv{} 1 mod 10}. So @m{8\mathord{\times}543 = 4344,8*543=4344} can be |
| subtracted from the dividend leaving 363810. Notice the low digit has become |
| zero. |
| |
| The procedure is repeated at the second digit, with the next quotient digit 7 |
| (@m{1 \mathord{\times} 7 \bmod 10, 7 @equiv{} 1*7 mod 10}), subtracting |
| @m{7\mathord{\times}543 = 3801,7*543=3801}, leaving 325800. And finally at |
| the third digit with quotient digit 6 (@m{8 \mathord{\times} 7 \bmod 10, 8*7 |
| mod 10}), subtracting @m{6\mathord{\times}543 = 3258,6*543=3258} leaving 0. |
| So the quotient is 678. |
| |
| Notice however that the multiplies and subtractions don't need to extend past |
| the low three digits of the dividend, since that's enough to determine the |
| three quotient digits. For the last quotient digit no subtraction is needed |
| at all. On a 2N@cross{}N division like this one, only about half the work of |
| a normal basecase division is necessary. |
| |
| For an N@cross{}M exact division producing Q=N@minus{}M quotient limbs, the |
| saving over a normal basecase division is in two parts. Firstly, each of the |
| Q quotient limbs needs only one multiply, not a 2@cross{}1 divide and |
| multiply. Secondly, the crossproducts are reduced when @math{Q>M} to |
| @m{QM-M(M+1)/2,Q*M-M*(M+1)/2}, or when @math{Q@le{}M} to @m{Q(Q-1)/2, |
| Q*(Q-1)/2}. Notice the savings are complementary. If Q is big then many |
| divisions are saved, or if Q is small then the crossproducts reduce to a small |
| number. |
| |
| The modular inverse used is calculated efficiently by @code{binvert_limb} in |
| @file{gmp-impl.h}. This does four multiplies for a 32-bit limb, or six for a |
| 64-bit limb. @file{tune/modlinv.c} has some alternate implementations that |
| might suit processors better at bit twiddling than multiplying. |
| |
| The sub-quadratic exact division described by Jebelean in ``Exact Division |
| with Karatsuba Complexity'' is not currently implemented. It uses a |
| rearrangement similar to the divide and conquer for normal division |
| (@pxref{Divide and Conquer Division}), but operating from low to high. A |
| further possibility not currently implemented is ``Bidirectional Exact Integer |
| Division'' by Krandick and Jebelean which forms quotient limbs from both the |
| high and low ends of the dividend, and can halve once more the number of |
| crossproducts needed in a 2N@cross{}N division. |
| |
| A special case exact division by 3 exists in @code{mpn_divexact_by3}, |
| supporting Toom-3 multiplication and @code{mpq} canonicalizations. It forms |
| quotient digits with a multiply by the modular inverse of 3 (which is |
| @code{0xAA..AAB}) and uses two comparisons to determine a borrow for the next |
| limb. The multiplications don't need to be on the dependent chain, as long as |
| the effect of the borrows is applied, which can help chips with pipelined |
| multipliers. |
| |
| |
| @node Exact Remainder, Small Quotient Division, Exact Division, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Exact Remainder |
| @cindex Exact remainder |
| |
| If the exact division algorithm is done with a full subtraction at each stage |
| and the dividend isn't a multiple of the divisor, then low zero limbs are |
| produced but with a remainder in the high limbs. For dividend @math{a}, |
| divisor @math{d}, quotient @math{q}, and @m{b = 2 |
| \GMPraise{@code{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}}, b = 2^mp_bits_per_limb}, this remainder |
| @math{r} is of the form |
| @tex |
| $$ a = qd + r b^n $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| a = q*d + r*b^n |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| @math{n} represents the number of zero limbs produced by the subtractions, |
| that being the number of limbs produced for @math{q}. @math{r} will be in the |
| range @math{0@le{}r<d} and can be viewed as a remainder, but one shifted up by |
| a factor of @math{b^n}. |
| |
| Carrying out full subtractions at each stage means the same number of cross |
| products must be done as a normal division, but there's still some single limb |
| divisions saved. When @math{d} is a single limb some simplifications arise, |
| providing good speedups on a number of processors. |
| |
| The functions @code{mpn_divexact_by3}, @code{mpn_modexact_1_odd} and the |
| internal @code{mpn_redc_X} functions differ subtly in how they return @math{r}, |
| leading to some negations in the above formula, but all are essentially the |
| same. |
| |
| @cindex Divisibility algorithm |
| @cindex Congruence algorithm |
| Clearly @math{r} is zero when @math{a} is a multiple of @math{d}, and this |
| leads to divisibility or congruence tests which are potentially more efficient |
| than a normal division. |
| |
| The factor of @math{b^n} on @math{r} can be ignored in a GCD when @math{d} is |
| odd, hence the use of @code{mpn_modexact_1_odd} by @code{mpn_gcd_1} and |
| @code{mpz_kronecker_ui} etc (@pxref{Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms}). |
| |
| Montgomery's REDC method for modular multiplications uses operands of the form |
| of @m{xb^{-n}, x*b^-n} and @m{yb^{-n}, y*b^-n} and on calculating @m{(xb^{-n}) |
| (yb^{-n}), (x*b^-n)*(y*b^-n)} uses the factor of @math{b^n} in the exact |
| remainder to reach a product in the same form @m{(xy)b^{-n}, (x*y)*b^-n} |
| (@pxref{Modular Powering Algorithm}). |
| |
| Notice that @math{r} generally gives no useful information about the ordinary |
| remainder @math{a @bmod d} since @math{b^n @bmod d} could be anything. If |
| however @math{b^n @equiv{} 1 @bmod d}, then @math{r} is the negative of the |
| ordinary remainder. This occurs whenever @math{d} is a factor of |
| @math{b^n-1}, as for example with 3 in @code{mpn_divexact_by3}. For a 32 or |
| 64 bit limb other such factors include 5, 17 and 257, but no particular use |
| has been found for this. |
| |
| |
| @node Small Quotient Division, , Exact Remainder, Division Algorithms |
| @subsection Small Quotient Division |
| |
| An N@cross{}M division where the number of quotient limbs Q=N@minus{}M is |
| small can be optimized somewhat. |
| |
| An ordinary basecase division normalizes the divisor by shifting it to make |
| the high bit set, shifting the dividend accordingly, and shifting the |
| remainder back down at the end of the calculation. This is wasteful if only a |
| few quotient limbs are to be formed. Instead a division of just the top |
| @m{\rm2Q,2*Q} limbs of the dividend by the top Q limbs of the divisor can be |
| used to form a trial quotient. This requires only those limbs normalized, not |
| the whole of the divisor and dividend. |
| |
| A multiply and subtract then applies the trial quotient to the M@minus{}Q |
| unused limbs of the divisor and N@minus{}Q dividend limbs (which includes Q |
| limbs remaining from the trial quotient division). The starting trial |
| quotient can be 1 or 2 too big, but all cases of 2 too big and most cases of 1 |
| too big are detected by first comparing the most significant limbs that will |
| arise from the subtraction. An addback is done if the quotient still turns |
| out to be 1 too big. |
| |
| This whole procedure is essentially the same as one step of the basecase |
| algorithm done in a Q limb base, though with the trial quotient test done only |
| with the high limbs, not an entire Q limb ``digit'' product. The correctness |
| of this weaker test can be established by following the argument of Knuth |
| section 4.3.1 exercise 20 but with the @m{v_2 \GMPhat q > b \GMPhat r |
| + u_2, v2*q>b*r+u2} condition appropriately relaxed. |
| |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @node Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms, Powering Algorithms, Division Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Greatest Common Divisor |
| @cindex Greatest common divisor algorithms |
| @cindex GCD algorithms |
| |
| @menu |
| * Binary GCD:: |
| * Lehmer's Algorithm:: |
| * Subquadratic GCD:: |
| * Extended GCD:: |
| * Jacobi Symbol:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Binary GCD, Lehmer's Algorithm, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms |
| @subsection Binary GCD |
| |
| At small sizes GMP uses an @math{O(N^2)} binary style GCD@. This is described |
| in many textbooks, for example Knuth section 4.5.2 algorithm B@. It simply |
| consists of successively reducing odd operands @math{a} and @math{b} using |
| |
| @quotation |
| @math{a,b = @abs{}(a-b),@min{}(a,b)} @* |
| strip factors of 2 from @math{a} |
| @end quotation |
| |
| The Euclidean GCD algorithm, as per Knuth algorithms E and A, repeatedly |
| computes the quotient @m{q = \lfloor a/b \rfloor, q = floor(a/b)} and replaces |
| @math{a,b} by @math{v, u - q v}. The binary algorithm has so far been found to |
| be faster than the Euclidean algorithm everywhere. One reason the binary |
| method does well is that the implied quotient at each step is usually small, |
| so often only one or two subtractions are needed to get the same effect as a |
| division. Quotients 1, 2 and 3 for example occur 67.7% of the time, see Knuth |
| section 4.5.3 Theorem E. |
| |
| When the implied quotient is large, meaning @math{b} is much smaller than |
| @math{a}, then a division is worthwhile. This is the basis for the initial |
| @math{a @bmod b} reductions in @code{mpn_gcd} and @code{mpn_gcd_1} (the latter |
| for both N@cross{}1 and 1@cross{}1 cases). But after that initial reduction, |
| big quotients occur too rarely to make it worth checking for them. |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| The final @math{1@cross{}1} GCD in @code{mpn_gcd_1} is done in the generic C |
| code as described above. For two N-bit operands, the algorithm takes about |
| 0.68 iterations per bit. For optimum performance some attention needs to be |
| paid to the way the factors of 2 are stripped from @math{a}. |
| |
| Firstly it may be noted that in twos complement the number of low zero bits on |
| @math{a-b} is the same as @math{b-a}, so counting or testing can begin on |
| @math{a-b} without waiting for @math{@abs{}(a-b)} to be determined. |
| |
| A loop stripping low zero bits tends not to branch predict well, since the |
| condition is data dependent. But on average there's only a few low zeros, so |
| an option is to strip one or two bits arithmetically then loop for more (as |
| done for AMD K6). Or use a lookup table to get a count for several bits then |
| loop for more (as done for AMD K7). An alternative approach is to keep just |
| one of @math{a} or @math{b} odd and iterate |
| |
| @quotation |
| @math{a,b = @abs{}(a-b), @min{}(a,b)} @* |
| @math{a = a/2} if even @* |
| @math{b = b/2} if even |
| @end quotation |
| |
| This requires about 1.25 iterations per bit, but stripping of a single bit at |
| each step avoids any branching. Repeating the bit strip reduces to about 0.9 |
| iterations per bit, which may be a worthwhile tradeoff. |
| |
| Generally with the above approaches a speed of perhaps 6 cycles per bit can be |
| achieved, which is still not terribly fast with for instance a 64-bit GCD |
| taking nearly 400 cycles. It's this sort of time which means it's not usually |
| advantageous to combine a set of divisibility tests into a GCD. |
| |
| Currently, the binary algorithm is used for GCD only when @math{N < 3}. |
| |
| @node Lehmer's Algorithm, Subquadratic GCD, Binary GCD, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @subsection Lehmer's algorithm |
| |
| Lehmer's improvement of the Euclidean algorithms is based on the observation |
| that the initial part of the quotient sequence depends only on the most |
| significant parts of the inputs. The variant of Lehmer's algorithm used in GMP |
| splits off the most significant two limbs, as suggested, e.g., in ``A |
| Double-Digit Lehmer-Euclid Algorithm'' by Jebelean (@pxref{References}). The |
| quotients of two double-limb inputs are collected as a 2 by 2 matrix with |
| single-limb elements. This is done by the function @code{mpn_hgcd2}. The |
| resulting matrix is applied to the inputs using @code{mpn_mul_1} and |
| @code{mpn_submul_1}. Each iteration usually reduces the inputs by almost one |
| limb. In the rare case of a large quotient, no progress can be made by |
| examining just the most significant two limbs, and the quotient is computed |
| using plain division. |
| |
| The resulting algorithm is asymptotically @math{O(N^2)}, just as the Euclidean |
| algorithm and the binary algorithm. The quadratic part of the work are |
| the calls to @code{mpn_mul_1} and @code{mpn_submul_1}. For small sizes, the |
| linear work is also significant. There are roughly @math{N} calls to the |
| @code{mpn_hgcd2} function. This function uses a couple of important |
| optimizations: |
| |
| @itemize |
| @item |
| It uses the same relaxed notion of correctness as @code{mpn_hgcd} (see next |
| section). This means that when called with the most significant two limbs of |
| two large numbers, the returned matrix does not always correspond exactly to |
| the initial quotient sequence for the two large numbers; the final quotient |
| may sometimes be one off. |
| |
| @item |
| It takes advantage of the fact the quotients are usually small. The division |
| operator is not used, since the corresponding assembler instruction is very |
| slow on most architectures. (This code could probably be improved further, it |
| uses many branches that are unfriendly to prediction). |
| |
| @item |
| It switches from double-limb calculations to single-limb calculations half-way |
| through, when the input numbers have been reduced in size from two limbs to |
| one and a half. |
| |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @node Subquadratic GCD, Extended GCD, Lehmer's Algorithm, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms |
| @subsection Subquadratic GCD |
| |
| For inputs larger than @code{GCD_DC_THRESHOLD}, GCD is computed via the HGCD |
| (Half GCD) function, as a generalization to Lehmer's algorithm. |
| |
| Let the inputs @math{a,b} be of size @math{N} limbs each. Put @m{S=\lfloor N/2 |
| \rfloor + 1, S = floor(N/2) + 1}. Then HGCD(a,b) returns a transformation |
| matrix @math{T} with non-negative elements, and reduced numbers @math{(c;d) = |
| T^{-1} (a;b)}. The reduced numbers @math{c,d} must be larger than @math{S} |
| limbs, while their difference @math{abs(c-d)} must fit in @math{S} limbs. The |
| matrix elements will also be of size roughly @math{N/2}. |
| |
| The HGCD base case uses Lehmer's algorithm, but with the above stop condition |
| that returns reduced numbers and the corresponding transformation matrix |
| half-way through. For inputs larger than @code{HGCD_THRESHOLD}, HGCD is |
| computed recursively, using the divide and conquer algorithm in ``On |
| Sch@"onhage's algorithm and subquadratic integer GCD computation'' by M@"oller |
| (@pxref{References}). The recursive algorithm consists of these main |
| steps. |
| |
| @itemize |
| |
| @item |
| Call HGCD recursively, on the most significant @math{N/2} limbs. Apply the |
| resulting matrix @math{T_1} to the full numbers, reducing them to a size just |
| above @math{3N/2}. |
| |
| @item |
| Perform a small number of division or subtraction steps to reduce the numbers |
| to size below @math{3N/2}. This is essential mainly for the unlikely case of |
| large quotients. |
| |
| @item |
| Call HGCD recursively, on the most significant @math{N/2} limbs of the reduced |
| numbers. Apply the resulting matrix @math{T_2} to the full numbers, reducing |
| them to a size just above @math{N/2}. |
| |
| @item |
| Compute @math{T = T_1 T_2}. |
| |
| @item |
| Perform a small number of division and subtraction steps to satisfy the |
| requirements, and return. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| GCD is then implemented as a loop around HGCD, similarly to Lehmer's |
| algorithm. Where Lehmer repeatedly chops off the top two limbs, calls |
| @code{mpn_hgcd2}, and applies the resulting matrix to the full numbers, the |
| sub-quadratic GCD chops off the most significant third of the limbs (the |
| proportion is a tuning parameter, and @math{1/3} seems to be more efficient |
| than, e.g, @math{1/2}), calls @code{mpn_hgcd}, and applies the resulting |
| matrix. Once the input numbers are reduced to size below |
| @code{GCD_DC_THRESHOLD}, Lehmer's algorithm is used for the rest of the work. |
| |
| The asymptotic running time of both HGCD and GCD is @m{O(M(N)\log N),O(M(N)*log(N))}, |
| where @math{M(N)} is the time for multiplying two @math{N}-limb numbers. |
| |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| |
| @node Extended GCD, Jacobi Symbol, Subquadratic GCD, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms |
| @subsection Extended GCD |
| |
| The extended GCD function, or GCDEXT, calculates @math{@gcd{}(a,b)} and also |
| cofactors @math{x} and @math{y} satisfying @m{ax+by=\gcd(a@C{}b), |
| a*x+b*y=gcd(a@C{}b)}. All the algorithms used for plain GCD are extended to |
| handle this case. The binary algorithm is used only for single-limb GCDEXT. |
| Lehmer's algorithm is used for sizes up to @code{GCDEXT_DC_THRESHOLD}. Above |
| this threshold, GCDEXT is implemented as a loop around HGCD, but with more |
| book-keeping to keep track of the cofactors. This gives the same asymptotic |
| running time as for GCD and HGCD, @m{O(M(N)\log N),O(M(N)*log(N))} |
| |
| One difference to plain GCD is that while the inputs @math{a} and @math{b} are |
| reduced as the algorithm proceeds, the cofactors @math{x} and @math{y} grow in |
| size. This makes the tuning of the chopping-point more difficult. The current |
| code chops off the most significant half of the inputs for the call to HGCD in |
| the first iteration, and the most significant two thirds for the remaining |
| calls. This strategy could surely be improved. Also the stop condition for the |
| loop, where Lehmer's algorithm is invoked once the inputs are reduced below |
| @code{GCDEXT_DC_THRESHOLD}, could maybe be improved by taking into account the |
| current size of the cofactors. |
| |
| @node Jacobi Symbol, , Extended GCD, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms |
| @subsection Jacobi Symbol |
| @cindex Jacobi symbol algorithm |
| |
| @c Editor Note: I don't see other people defining the inputs, it would be nice |
| @c here because the code uses (a/b) where other references use (n/k) |
| |
| Jacobi symbol @m{\left(a \over b\right), (@var{a}/@var{b})} |
| |
| Initially if either operand fits in a single limb, a reduction is done with |
| either @code{mpn_mod_1} or @code{mpn_modexact_1_odd}, followed by the binary |
| algorithm on a single limb. The binary algorithm is well suited to a single limb, |
| and the whole calculation in this case is quite efficient. |
| |
| For inputs larger than @code{GCD_DC_THRESHOLD}, @code{mpz_jacobi}, |
| @code{mpz_legendre} and @code{mpz_kronecker} are computed via the HGCD (Half |
| GCD) function, as a generalization to Lehmer's algorithm. |
| |
| Most GCD algorithms reduce @math{a} and @math{b} by repeatatily computing the |
| quotient @m{q = \lfloor a/b \rfloor, q = floor(a/b)} and iteratively replacing |
| |
| @c Couldn't figure out macros with commas. |
| @tex |
| $$ a, b = b, a - q * b$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @math{a, b = b, a - q * b} |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| Different algorithms use different methods for calculating q, but the core |
| algorithm is the same if we use @ref{Lehmer's Algorithm} or |
| @ref{Subquadratic GCD, HGCD}. |
| |
| At each step it is possible to compute if the reduction inverts the Jacobi |
| symbol based on the two least significant bits of @var{a} and @var{b}. For |
| more details see ``Efficient computation of the Jacobi symbol'' by |
| M@"oller (@pxref{References}). |
| |
| A small set of bits is thus used to track state |
| @itemize |
| @item |
| current sign of result (1 bit) |
| |
| @item |
| two least significant bits of @var{a} and @var{b} (4 bits) |
| |
| @item |
| a pointer to which input is currently the denominator (1 bit) |
| @end itemize |
| |
| In all the routines sign changes for the result are accumulated using fast bit |
| twiddling which avoids conditional jumps. |
| |
| The final result is calculated after verifying the inputs are coprime (GCD = 1) |
| by raising @m{(-1)^e,(-1)^e} |
| |
| Much of the HGCD code is shared directly with the HGCD implementations, such |
| as the 2x2 matrix calculation, @xref{Lehmer's Algorithm} basecase and |
| @code{GCD_DC_THRESHOLD}. |
| |
| The asymptotic running time is @m{O(M(N)\log N),O(M(N)*log(N))}, where |
| @math{M(N)} is the time for multiplying two @math{N}-limb numbers. |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @node Powering Algorithms, Root Extraction Algorithms, Greatest Common Divisor Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Powering Algorithms |
| @cindex Powering algorithms |
| |
| @menu |
| * Normal Powering Algorithm:: |
| * Modular Powering Algorithm:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Normal Powering Algorithm, Modular Powering Algorithm, Powering Algorithms, Powering Algorithms |
| @subsection Normal Powering |
| |
| Normal @code{mpz} or @code{mpf} powering uses a simple binary algorithm, |
| successively squaring and then multiplying by the base when a 1 bit is seen in |
| the exponent, as per Knuth section 4.6.3. The ``left to right'' |
| variant described there is used rather than algorithm A, since it's just as |
| easy and can be done with somewhat less temporary memory. |
| |
| |
| @node Modular Powering Algorithm, , Normal Powering Algorithm, Powering Algorithms |
| @subsection Modular Powering |
| |
| Modular powering is implemented using a @math{2^k}-ary sliding window |
| algorithm, as per ``Handbook of Applied Cryptography'' algorithm 14.85 |
| (@pxref{References}). @math{k} is chosen according to the size of the |
| exponent. Larger exponents use larger values of @math{k}, the choice being |
| made to minimize the average number of multiplications that must supplement |
| the squaring. |
| |
| The modular multiplies and squarings use either a simple division or the REDC |
| method by Montgomery (@pxref{References}). REDC is a little faster, |
| essentially saving N single limb divisions in a fashion similar to an exact |
| remainder (@pxref{Exact Remainder}). |
| |
| |
| @node Root Extraction Algorithms, Radix Conversion Algorithms, Powering Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Root Extraction Algorithms |
| @cindex Root extraction algorithms |
| |
| @menu |
| * Square Root Algorithm:: |
| * Nth Root Algorithm:: |
| * Perfect Square Algorithm:: |
| * Perfect Power Algorithm:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Square Root Algorithm, Nth Root Algorithm, Root Extraction Algorithms, Root Extraction Algorithms |
| @subsection Square Root |
| @cindex Square root algorithm |
| @cindex Karatsuba square root algorithm |
| |
| Square roots are taken using the ``Karatsuba Square Root'' algorithm by Paul |
| Zimmermann (@pxref{References}). |
| |
| An input @math{n} is split into four parts of @math{k} bits each, so with |
| @math{b=2^k} we have @m{n = a_3b^3 + a_2b^2 + a_1b + a_0, n = a3*b^3 + a2*b^2 |
| + a1*b + a0}. Part @ms{a,3} must be ``normalized'' so that either the high or |
| second highest bit is set. In GMP, @math{k} is kept on a limb boundary and |
| the input is left shifted (by an even number of bits) to normalize. |
| |
| The square root of the high two parts is taken, by recursive application of |
| the algorithm (bottoming out in a one-limb Newton's method), |
| @tex |
| $$ s',r' = \mathop{\rm sqrtrem} \> (a_3b + a_2) $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| s1,r1 = sqrtrem (a3*b + a2) |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| This is an approximation to the desired root and is extended by a division to |
| give @math{s},@math{r}, |
| @tex |
| $$\eqalign{ |
| q,u &= \mathop{\rm divrem} \> (r'b + a_1, 2s') \cr |
| s &= s'b + q \cr |
| r &= ub + a_0 - q^2 |
| }$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| q,u = divrem (r1*b + a1, 2*s1) |
| s = s1*b + q |
| r = u*b + a0 - q^2 |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| The normalization requirement on @ms{a,3} means at this point @math{s} is |
| either correct or 1 too big. @math{r} is negative in the latter case, so |
| @tex |
| $$\eqalign{ |
| \mathop{\rm if} \; r &< 0 \; \mathop{\rm then} \cr |
| r &\leftarrow r + 2s - 1 \cr |
| s &\leftarrow s - 1 |
| }$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| if r < 0 then |
| r = r + 2*s - 1 |
| s = s - 1 |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| The algorithm is expressed in a divide and conquer form, but as noted in the |
| paper it can also be viewed as a discrete variant of Newton's method, or as a |
| variation on the schoolboy method (no longer taught) for square roots two |
| digits at a time. |
| |
| If the remainder @math{r} is not required then usually only a few high limbs |
| of @math{r} and @math{u} need to be calculated to determine whether an |
| adjustment to @math{s} is required. This optimization is not currently |
| implemented. |
| |
| In the Karatsuba multiplication range this algorithm is @m{O({3\over2} |
| M(N/2)),O(1.5*M(N/2))}, where @math{M(n)} is the time to multiply two numbers |
| of @math{n} limbs. In the FFT multiplication range this grows to a bound of |
| @m{O(6 M(N/2)),O(6*M(N/2))}. In practice a factor of about 1.5 to 1.8 is |
| found in the Karatsuba and Toom-3 ranges, growing to 2 or 3 in the FFT range. |
| |
| The algorithm does all its calculations in integers and the resulting |
| @code{mpn_sqrtrem} is used for both @code{mpz_sqrt} and @code{mpf_sqrt}. |
| The extended precision given by @code{mpf_sqrt_ui} is obtained by |
| padding with zero limbs. |
| |
| |
| @node Nth Root Algorithm, Perfect Square Algorithm, Square Root Algorithm, Root Extraction Algorithms |
| @subsection Nth Root |
| @cindex Root extraction algorithm |
| @cindex Nth root algorithm |
| |
| Integer Nth roots are taken using Newton's method with the following |
| iteration, where @math{A} is the input and @math{n} is the root to be taken. |
| @tex |
| $$a_{i+1} = {1\over n} \left({A \over a_i^{n-1}} + (n-1)a_i \right)$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| 1 A |
| a[i+1] = - * ( --------- + (n-1)*a[i] ) |
| n a[i]^(n-1) |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| The initial approximation @m{a_1,a[1]} is generated bitwise by successively |
| powering a trial root with or without new 1 bits, aiming to be just above the |
| true root. The iteration converges quadratically when started from a good |
| approximation. When @math{n} is large more initial bits are needed to get |
| good convergence. The current implementation is not particularly well |
| optimized. |
| |
| |
| @node Perfect Square Algorithm, Perfect Power Algorithm, Nth Root Algorithm, Root Extraction Algorithms |
| @subsection Perfect Square |
| @cindex Perfect square algorithm |
| |
| A significant fraction of non-squares can be quickly identified by checking |
| whether the input is a quadratic residue modulo small integers. |
| |
| @code{mpz_perfect_square_p} first tests the input mod 256, which means just |
| examining the low byte. Only 44 different values occur for squares mod 256, |
| so 82.8% of inputs can be immediately identified as non-squares. |
| |
| On a 32-bit system similar tests are done mod 9, 5, 7, 13 and 17, for a total |
| 99.25% of inputs identified as non-squares. On a 64-bit system 97 is tested |
| too, for a total 99.62%. |
| |
| These moduli are chosen because they're factors of @math{2^@W{24}-1} (or |
| @math{2^@W{48}-1} for 64-bits), and such a remainder can be quickly taken just |
| using additions (see @code{mpn_mod_34lsub1}). |
| |
| When nails are in use moduli are instead selected by the @file{gen-psqr.c} |
| program and applied with an @code{mpn_mod_1}. The same @math{2^@W{24}-1} or |
| @math{2^@W{48}-1} could be done with nails using some extra bit shifts, but |
| this is not currently implemented. |
| |
| In any case each modulus is applied to the @code{mpn_mod_34lsub1} or |
| @code{mpn_mod_1} remainder and a table lookup identifies non-squares. By |
| using a ``modexact'' style calculation, and suitably permuted tables, just one |
| multiply each is required, see the code for details. Moduli are also combined |
| to save operations, so long as the lookup tables don't become too big. |
| @file{gen-psqr.c} does all the pre-calculations. |
| |
| A square root must still be taken for any value that passes these tests, to |
| verify it's really a square and not one of the small fraction of non-squares |
| that get through (i.e.@: a pseudo-square to all the tested bases). |
| |
| Clearly more residue tests could be done, @code{mpz_perfect_square_p} only |
| uses a compact and efficient set. Big inputs would probably benefit from more |
| residue testing, small inputs might be better off with less. The assumed |
| distribution of squares versus non-squares in the input would affect such |
| considerations. |
| |
| |
| @node Perfect Power Algorithm, , Perfect Square Algorithm, Root Extraction Algorithms |
| @subsection Perfect Power |
| @cindex Perfect power algorithm |
| |
| Detecting perfect powers is required by some factorization algorithms. |
| Currently @code{mpz_perfect_power_p} is implemented using repeated Nth root |
| extractions, though naturally only prime roots need to be considered. |
| (@xref{Nth Root Algorithm}.) |
| |
| If a prime divisor @math{p} with multiplicity @math{e} can be found, then only |
| roots which are divisors of @math{e} need to be considered, much reducing the |
| work necessary. To this end divisibility by a set of small primes is checked. |
| |
| |
| @node Radix Conversion Algorithms, Other Algorithms, Root Extraction Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Radix Conversion |
| @cindex Radix conversion algorithms |
| |
| Radix conversions are less important than other algorithms. A program |
| dominated by conversions should probably use a different data representation. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Binary to Radix:: |
| * Radix to Binary:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Binary to Radix, Radix to Binary, Radix Conversion Algorithms, Radix Conversion Algorithms |
| @subsection Binary to Radix |
| |
| Conversions from binary to a power-of-2 radix use a simple and fast |
| @math{O(N)} bit extraction algorithm. |
| |
| Conversions from binary to other radices use one of two algorithms. Sizes |
| below @code{GET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} use a basic @math{O(N^2)} method. |
| Repeated divisions by @math{b^n} are made, where @math{b} is the radix and |
| @math{n} is the biggest power that fits in a limb. But instead of simply |
| using the remainder @math{r} from such divisions, an extra divide step is done |
| to give a fractional limb representing @math{r/b^n}. The digits of @math{r} |
| can then be extracted using multiplications by @math{b} rather than divisions. |
| Special case code is provided for decimal, allowing multiplications by 10 to |
| optimize to shifts and adds. |
| |
| Above @code{GET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} a sub-quadratic algorithm is used. |
| For an input @math{t}, powers @m{b^{n2^i},b^(n*2^i)} of the radix are |
| calculated, until a power between @math{t} and @m{\sqrt{t},sqrt(t)} is |
| reached. @math{t} is then divided by that largest power, giving a quotient |
| which is the digits above that power, and a remainder which is those below. |
| These two parts are in turn divided by the second highest power, and so on |
| recursively. When a piece has been divided down to less than |
| @code{GET_STR_DC_THRESHOLD} limbs, the basecase algorithm described above is |
| used. |
| |
| The advantage of this algorithm is that big divisions can make use of the |
| sub-quadratic divide and conquer division (@pxref{Divide and Conquer |
| Division}), and big divisions tend to have less overheads than lots of |
| separate single limb divisions anyway. But in any case the cost of |
| calculating the powers @m{b^{n2^i},b^(n*2^i)} must first be overcome. |
| |
| @code{GET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} and @code{GET_STR_DC_THRESHOLD} represent |
| the same basic thing, the point where it becomes worth doing a big division to |
| cut the input in half. @code{GET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} includes the cost |
| of calculating the radix power required, whereas @code{GET_STR_DC_THRESHOLD} |
| assumes that's already available, which is the case when recursing. |
| |
| Since the base case produces digits from least to most significant but they |
| want to be stored from most to least, it's necessary to calculate in advance |
| how many digits there will be, or at least be sure not to underestimate that. |
| For GMP the number of input bits is multiplied by @code{chars_per_bit_exactly} |
| from @code{mp_bases}, rounding up. The result is either correct or one too |
| big. |
| |
| Examining some of the high bits of the input could increase the chance of |
| getting the exact number of digits, but an exact result every time would not |
| be practical, since in general the difference between numbers 100@dots{} and |
| 99@dots{} is only in the last few bits and the work to identify 99@dots{} |
| might well be almost as much as a full conversion. |
| |
| The @math{r/b^n} scheme described above for using multiplications to bring out |
| digits might be useful for more than a single limb. Some brief experiments |
| with it on the base case when recursing didn't give a noticeable improvement, |
| but perhaps that was only due to the implementation. Something similar would |
| work for the sub-quadratic divisions too, though there would be the cost of |
| calculating a bigger radix power. |
| |
| Another possible improvement for the sub-quadratic part would be to arrange |
| for radix powers that balanced the sizes of quotient and remainder produced, |
| i.e.@: the highest power would be an @m{b^{nk},b^(n*k)} approximately equal to |
| @m{\sqrt{t},sqrt(t)}, not restricted to a @math{2^i} factor. That ought to |
| smooth out a graph of times against sizes, but may or may not be a net |
| speedup. |
| |
| |
| @node Radix to Binary, , Binary to Radix, Radix Conversion Algorithms |
| @subsection Radix to Binary |
| |
| @strong{This section needs to be rewritten, it currently describes the |
| algorithms used before GMP 4.3.} |
| |
| Conversions from a power-of-2 radix into binary use a simple and fast |
| @math{O(N)} bitwise concatenation algorithm. |
| |
| Conversions from other radices use one of two algorithms. Sizes below |
| @code{SET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} use a basic @math{O(N^2)} method. Groups |
| of @math{n} digits are converted to limbs, where @math{n} is the biggest |
| power of the base @math{b} which will fit in a limb, then those groups are |
| accumulated into the result by multiplying by @math{b^n} and adding. This |
| saves multi-precision operations, as per Knuth section 4.4 part E |
| (@pxref{References}). Some special case code is provided for decimal, giving |
| the compiler a chance to optimize multiplications by 10. |
| |
| Above @code{SET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} a sub-quadratic algorithm is used. |
| First groups of @math{n} digits are converted into limbs. Then adjacent |
| limbs are combined into limb pairs with @m{xb^n+y,x*b^n+y}, where @math{x} |
| and @math{y} are the limbs. Adjacent limb pairs are combined into quads |
| similarly with @m{xb^{2n}+y,x*b^(2n)+y}. This continues until a single block |
| remains, that being the result. |
| |
| The advantage of this method is that the multiplications for each @math{x} are |
| big blocks, allowing Karatsuba and higher algorithms to be used. But the cost |
| of calculating the powers @m{b^{n2^i},b^(n*2^i)} must be overcome. |
| @code{SET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} usually ends up quite big, around 5000 digits, and on |
| some processors much bigger still. |
| |
| @code{SET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} is based on the input digits (and tuned |
| for decimal), though it might be better based on a limb count, so as to be |
| independent of the base. But that sort of count isn't used by the base case |
| and so would need some sort of initial calculation or estimate. |
| |
| The main reason @code{SET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} is so much bigger than the |
| corresponding @code{GET_STR_PRECOMPUTE_THRESHOLD} is that @code{mpn_mul_1} is |
| much faster than @code{mpn_divrem_1} (often by a factor of 5, or more). |
| |
| |
| @need 1000 |
| @node Other Algorithms, Assembly Coding, Radix Conversion Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Other Algorithms |
| |
| @menu |
| * Prime Testing Algorithm:: |
| * Factorial Algorithm:: |
| * Binomial Coefficients Algorithm:: |
| * Fibonacci Numbers Algorithm:: |
| * Lucas Numbers Algorithm:: |
| * Random Number Algorithms:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Prime Testing Algorithm, Factorial Algorithm, Other Algorithms, Other Algorithms |
| @subsection Prime Testing |
| @cindex Prime testing algorithms |
| |
| The primality testing in @code{mpz_probab_prime_p} (@pxref{Number Theoretic |
| Functions}) first does some trial division by small factors and then uses the |
| Miller-Rabin probabilistic primality testing algorithm, as described in Knuth |
| section 4.5.4 algorithm P (@pxref{References}). |
| |
| For an odd input @math{n}, and with @math{n = q@GMPmultiply{}2^k+1} where |
| @math{q} is odd, this algorithm selects a random base @math{x} and tests |
| whether @math{x^q @bmod{} n} is 1 or @math{-1}, or an @m{x^{q2^j} \bmod n, |
| x^(q*2^j) mod n} is @math{1}, for @math{1@le{}j@le{}k}. If so then @math{n} |
| is probably prime, if not then @math{n} is definitely composite. |
| |
| Any prime @math{n} will pass the test, but some composites do too. Such |
| composites are known as strong pseudoprimes to base @math{x}. No @math{n} is |
| a strong pseudoprime to more than @math{1/4} of all bases (see Knuth exercise |
| 22), hence with @math{x} chosen at random there's no more than a @math{1/4} |
| chance a ``probable prime'' will in fact be composite. |
| |
| In fact strong pseudoprimes are quite rare, making the test much more |
| powerful than this analysis would suggest, but @math{1/4} is all that's proven |
| for an arbitrary @math{n}. |
| |
| |
| @node Factorial Algorithm, Binomial Coefficients Algorithm, Prime Testing Algorithm, Other Algorithms |
| @subsection Factorial |
| @cindex Factorial algorithm |
| |
| Factorials are calculated by a combination of two algorithms. An idea is |
| shared among them: to compute the odd part of the factorial; a final step |
| takes account of the power of @math{2} term, by shifting. |
| |
| For small @math{n}, the odd factor of @math{n!} is computed with the simple |
| observation that it is equal to the product of all positive odd numbers |
| smaller than @math{n} times the odd factor of @m{\lfloor n/2\rfloor!, [n/2]!}, |
| where @m{\lfloor x\rfloor, [x]} is the integer part of @math{x}, and so on |
| recursively. The procedure can be best illustrated with an example, |
| |
| @quotation |
| @math{23! = (23.21.19.17.15.13.11.9.7.5.3)(11.9.7.5.3)(5.3)2^{19}} |
| @end quotation |
| |
| Current code collects all the factors in a single list, with a loop and no |
| recursion, and compute the product, with no special care for repeated chunks. |
| |
| When @math{n} is larger, computation pass trough prime sieving. An helper |
| function is used, as suggested by Peter Luschny: |
| @tex |
| $$\mathop{\rm msf}(n) = {n!\over\lfloor n/2\rfloor!^2\cdot2^k} = \prod_{p=3}^{n} |
| p^{\mathop{\rm L}(p,n)} $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| n |
| ----- |
| n! | | L(p,n) |
| msf(n) = -------------- = | | p |
| [n/2]!^2.2^k p=3 |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| Where @math{p} ranges on odd prime numbers. The exponent @math{k} is chosen to |
| obtain an odd integer number: @math{k} is the number of 1 bits in the binary |
| representation of @m{\lfloor n/2\rfloor, [n/2]}. The function L@math{(p,n)} |
| can be defined as zero when @math{p} is composite, and, for any prime |
| @math{p}, it is computed with: |
| @tex |
| $$\mathop{\rm L}(p,n) = \sum_{i>0}\left\lfloor{n\over p^i}\right\rfloor\bmod2 |
| \leq\log_p(n)$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| --- |
| \ n |
| L(p,n) = / [---] mod 2 <= log (n) . |
| --- p^i p |
| i>0 |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| With this helper function, we are able to compute the odd part of @math{n!} |
| using the recursion implied by @m{n!=\lfloor n/2\rfloor!^2\cdot\mathop{\rm |
| msf}(n)\cdot2^k , n!=[n/2]!^2*msf(n)*2^k}. The recursion stops using the |
| small-@math{n} algorithm on some @m{\lfloor n/2^i\rfloor, [n/2^i]}. |
| |
| Both the above algorithms use binary splitting to compute the product of many |
| small factors. At first as many products as possible are accumulated in a |
| single register, generating a list of factors that fit in a machine word. This |
| list is then split into halves, and the product is computed recursively. |
| |
| Such splitting is more efficient than repeated N@cross{}1 multiplies since it |
| forms big multiplies, allowing Karatsuba and higher algorithms to be used. |
| And even below the Karatsuba threshold a big block of work can be more |
| efficient for the basecase algorithm. |
| |
| |
| @node Binomial Coefficients Algorithm, Fibonacci Numbers Algorithm, Factorial Algorithm, Other Algorithms |
| @subsection Binomial Coefficients |
| @cindex Binomial coefficient algorithm |
| |
| Binomial coefficients @m{\left({n}\atop{k}\right), C(n@C{}k)} are calculated |
| by first arranging @math{k @le{} n/2} using @m{\left({n}\atop{k}\right) = |
| \left({n}\atop{n-k}\right), C(n@C{}k) = C(n@C{}n-k)} if necessary, and then |
| evaluating the following product simply from @math{i=2} to @math{i=k}. |
| @tex |
| $$ \left({n}\atop{k}\right) = (n-k+1) \prod_{i=2}^{k} {{n-k+i} \over i} $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| k (n-k+i) |
| C(n,k) = (n-k+1) * prod ------- |
| i=2 i |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| It's easy to show that each denominator @math{i} will divide the product so |
| far, so the exact division algorithm is used (@pxref{Exact Division}). |
| |
| The numerators @math{n-k+i} and denominators @math{i} are first accumulated |
| into as many fit a limb, to save multi-precision operations, though for |
| @code{mpz_bin_ui} this applies only to the divisors, since @math{n} is an |
| @code{mpz_t} and @math{n-k+i} in general won't fit in a limb at all. |
| |
| |
| @node Fibonacci Numbers Algorithm, Lucas Numbers Algorithm, Binomial Coefficients Algorithm, Other Algorithms |
| @subsection Fibonacci Numbers |
| @cindex Fibonacci number algorithm |
| |
| The Fibonacci functions @code{mpz_fib_ui} and @code{mpz_fib2_ui} are designed |
| for calculating isolated @m{F_n,F[n]} or @m{F_n,F[n]},@m{F_{n-1},F[n-1]} |
| values efficiently. |
| |
| For small @math{n}, a table of single limb values in @code{__gmp_fib_table} is |
| used. On a 32-bit limb this goes up to @m{F_{47},F[47]}, or on a 64-bit limb |
| up to @m{F_{93},F[93]}. For convenience the table starts at @m{F_{-1},F[-1]}. |
| |
| Beyond the table, values are generated with a binary powering algorithm, |
| calculating a pair @m{F_n,F[n]} and @m{F_{n-1},F[n-1]} working from high to |
| low across the bits of @math{n}. The formulas used are |
| @tex |
| $$\eqalign{ |
| F_{2k+1} &= 4F_k^2 - F_{k-1}^2 + 2(-1)^k \cr |
| F_{2k-1} &= F_k^2 + F_{k-1}^2 \cr |
| F_{2k} &= F_{2k+1} - F_{2k-1} |
| }$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| F[2k+1] = 4*F[k]^2 - F[k-1]^2 + 2*(-1)^k |
| F[2k-1] = F[k]^2 + F[k-1]^2 |
| |
| F[2k] = F[2k+1] - F[2k-1] |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| At each step, @math{k} is the high @math{b} bits of @math{n}. If the next bit |
| of @math{n} is 0 then @m{F_{2k},F[2k]},@m{F_{2k-1},F[2k-1]} is used, or if |
| it's a 1 then @m{F_{2k+1},F[2k+1]},@m{F_{2k},F[2k]} is used, and the process |
| repeated until all bits of @math{n} are incorporated. Notice these formulas |
| require just two squares per bit of @math{n}. |
| |
| It'd be possible to handle the first few @math{n} above the single limb table |
| with simple additions, using the defining Fibonacci recurrence @m{F_{k+1} = |
| F_k + F_{k-1}, F[k+1]=F[k]+F[k-1]}, but this is not done since it usually |
| turns out to be faster for only about 10 or 20 values of @math{n}, and |
| including a block of code for just those doesn't seem worthwhile. If they |
| really mattered it'd be better to extend the data table. |
| |
| Using a table avoids lots of calculations on small numbers, and makes small |
| @math{n} go fast. A bigger table would make more small @math{n} go fast, it's |
| just a question of balancing size against desired speed. For GMP the code is |
| kept compact, with the emphasis primarily on a good powering algorithm. |
| |
| @code{mpz_fib2_ui} returns both @m{F_n,F[n]} and @m{F_{n-1},F[n-1]}, but |
| @code{mpz_fib_ui} is only interested in @m{F_n,F[n]}. In this case the last |
| step of the algorithm can become one multiply instead of two squares. One of |
| the following two formulas is used, according as @math{n} is odd or even. |
| @tex |
| $$\eqalign{ |
| F_{2k} &= F_k (F_k + 2F_{k-1}) \cr |
| F_{2k+1} &= (2F_k + F_{k-1}) (2F_k - F_{k-1}) + 2(-1)^k |
| }$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| F[2k] = F[k]*(F[k]+2F[k-1]) |
| |
| F[2k+1] = (2F[k]+F[k-1])*(2F[k]-F[k-1]) + 2*(-1)^k |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| @m{F_{2k+1},F[2k+1]} here is the same as above, just rearranged to be a |
| multiply. For interest, the @m{2(-1)^k, 2*(-1)^k} term both here and above |
| can be applied just to the low limb of the calculation, without a carry or |
| borrow into further limbs, which saves some code size. See comments with |
| @code{mpz_fib_ui} and the internal @code{mpn_fib2_ui} for how this is done. |
| |
| |
| @node Lucas Numbers Algorithm, Random Number Algorithms, Fibonacci Numbers Algorithm, Other Algorithms |
| @subsection Lucas Numbers |
| @cindex Lucas number algorithm |
| |
| @code{mpz_lucnum2_ui} derives a pair of Lucas numbers from a pair of Fibonacci |
| numbers with the following simple formulas. |
| @tex |
| $$\eqalign{ |
| L_k &= F_k + 2F_{k-1} \cr |
| L_{k-1} &= 2F_k - F_{k-1} |
| }$$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| L[k] = F[k] + 2*F[k-1] |
| L[k-1] = 2*F[k] - F[k-1] |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| @code{mpz_lucnum_ui} is only interested in @m{L_n,L[n]}, and some work can be |
| saved. Trailing zero bits on @math{n} can be handled with a single square |
| each. |
| @tex |
| $$ L_{2k} = L_k^2 - 2(-1)^k $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| L[2k] = L[k]^2 - 2*(-1)^k |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| And the lowest 1 bit can be handled with one multiply of a pair of Fibonacci |
| numbers, similar to what @code{mpz_fib_ui} does. |
| @tex |
| $$ L_{2k+1} = 5F_{k-1} (2F_k + F_{k-1}) - 4(-1)^k $$ |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| |
| @example |
| L[2k+1] = 5*F[k-1]*(2*F[k]+F[k-1]) - 4*(-1)^k |
| @end example |
| |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| |
| @node Random Number Algorithms, , Lucas Numbers Algorithm, Other Algorithms |
| @subsection Random Numbers |
| @cindex Random number algorithms |
| |
| For the @code{urandomb} functions, random numbers are generated simply by |
| concatenating bits produced by the generator. As long as the generator has |
| good randomness properties this will produce well-distributed @math{N} bit |
| numbers. |
| |
| For the @code{urandomm} functions, random numbers in a range @math{0@le{}R<N} |
| are generated by taking values @math{R} of @m{\lceil \log_2 N \rceil, |
| ceil(log2(N))} bits each until one satisfies @math{R<N}. This will normally |
| require only one or two attempts, but the attempts are limited in case the |
| generator is somehow degenerate and produces only 1 bits or similar. |
| |
| @cindex Mersenne twister algorithm |
| The Mersenne Twister generator is by Matsumoto and Nishimura |
| (@pxref{References}). It has a non-repeating period of @math{2^@W{19937}-1}, |
| which is a Mersenne prime, hence the name of the generator. The state is 624 |
| words of 32-bits each, which is iterated with one XOR and shift for each |
| 32-bit word generated, making the algorithm very fast. Randomness properties |
| are also very good and this is the default algorithm used by GMP. |
| |
| @cindex Linear congruential algorithm |
| Linear congruential generators are described in many text books, for instance |
| Knuth volume 2 (@pxref{References}). With a modulus @math{M} and parameters |
| @math{A} and @math{C}, an integer state @math{S} is iterated by the formula |
| @math{S @leftarrow{} A@GMPmultiply{}S+C @bmod{} M}. At each step the new |
| state is a linear function of the previous, mod @math{M}, hence the name of |
| the generator. |
| |
| In GMP only moduli of the form @math{2^N} are supported, and the current |
| implementation is not as well optimized as it could be. Overheads are |
| significant when @math{N} is small, and when @math{N} is large clearly the |
| multiply at each step will become slow. This is not a big concern, since the |
| Mersenne Twister generator is better in every respect and is therefore |
| recommended for all normal applications. |
| |
| For both generators the current state can be deduced by observing enough |
| output and applying some linear algebra (over GF(2) in the case of the |
| Mersenne Twister). This generally means raw output is unsuitable for |
| cryptographic applications without further hashing or the like. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Coding, , Other Algorithms, Algorithms |
| @section Assembly Coding |
| @cindex Assembly coding |
| |
| The assembly subroutines in GMP are the most significant source of speed at |
| small to moderate sizes. At larger sizes algorithm selection becomes more |
| important, but of course speedups in low level routines will still speed up |
| everything proportionally. |
| |
| Carry handling and widening multiplies that are important for GMP can't be |
| easily expressed in C@. GCC @code{asm} blocks help a lot and are provided in |
| @file{longlong.h}, but hand coding low level routines invariably offers a |
| speedup over generic C by a factor of anything from 2 to 10. |
| |
| @menu |
| * Assembly Code Organisation:: |
| * Assembly Basics:: |
| * Assembly Carry Propagation:: |
| * Assembly Cache Handling:: |
| * Assembly Functional Units:: |
| * Assembly Floating Point:: |
| * Assembly SIMD Instructions:: |
| * Assembly Software Pipelining:: |
| * Assembly Loop Unrolling:: |
| * Assembly Writing Guide:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Code Organisation, Assembly Basics, Assembly Coding, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Code Organisation |
| @cindex Assembly code organisation |
| @cindex Code organisation |
| |
| The various @file{mpn} subdirectories contain machine-dependent code, written |
| in C or assembly. The @file{mpn/generic} subdirectory contains default code, |
| used when there's no machine-specific version of a particular file. |
| |
| Each @file{mpn} subdirectory is for an ISA family. Generally 32-bit and |
| 64-bit variants in a family cannot share code and have separate directories. |
| Within a family further subdirectories may exist for CPU variants. |
| |
| In each directory a @file{nails} subdirectory may exist, holding code with |
| nails support for that CPU variant. A @code{NAILS_SUPPORT} directive in each |
| file indicates the nails values the code handles. Nails code only exists |
| where it's faster, or promises to be faster, than plain code. There's no |
| effort put into nails if they're not going to enhance a given CPU. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Basics, Assembly Carry Propagation, Assembly Code Organisation, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Assembly Basics |
| |
| @code{mpn_addmul_1} and @code{mpn_submul_1} are the most important routines |
| for overall GMP performance. All multiplications and divisions come down to |
| repeated calls to these. @code{mpn_add_n}, @code{mpn_sub_n}, |
| @code{mpn_lshift} and @code{mpn_rshift} are next most important. |
| |
| On some CPUs assembly versions of the internal functions |
| @code{mpn_mul_basecase} and @code{mpn_sqr_basecase} give significant speedups, |
| mainly through avoiding function call overheads. They can also potentially |
| make better use of a wide superscalar processor, as can bigger primitives like |
| @code{mpn_addmul_2} or @code{mpn_addmul_4}. |
| |
| The restrictions on overlaps between sources and destinations |
| (@pxref{Low-level Functions}) are designed to facilitate a variety of |
| implementations. For example, knowing @code{mpn_add_n} won't have partly |
| overlapping sources and destination means reading can be done far ahead of |
| writing on superscalar processors, and loops can be vectorized on a vector |
| processor, depending on the carry handling. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Carry Propagation, Assembly Cache Handling, Assembly Basics, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Carry Propagation |
| @cindex Assembly carry propagation |
| |
| The problem that presents most challenges in GMP is propagating carries from |
| one limb to the next. In functions like @code{mpn_addmul_1} and |
| @code{mpn_add_n}, carries are the only dependencies between limb operations. |
| |
| On processors with carry flags, a straightforward CISC style @code{adc} is |
| generally best. AMD K6 @code{mpn_addmul_1} however is an example of an |
| unusual set of circumstances where a branch works out better. |
| |
| On RISC processors generally an add and compare for overflow is used. This |
| sort of thing can be seen in @file{mpn/generic/aors_n.c}. Some carry |
| propagation schemes require 4 instructions, meaning at least 4 cycles per |
| limb, but other schemes may use just 1 or 2. On wide superscalar processors |
| performance may be completely determined by the number of dependent |
| instructions between carry-in and carry-out for each limb. |
| |
| On vector processors good use can be made of the fact that a carry bit only |
| very rarely propagates more than one limb. When adding a single bit to a |
| limb, there's only a carry out if that limb was @code{0xFF@dots{}FF} which on |
| random data will be only 1 in @m{2\GMPraise{@code{mp\_bits\_per\_limb}}, |
| 2^mp_bits_per_limb}. @file{mpn/cray/add_n.c} is an example of this, it adds |
| all limbs in parallel, adds one set of carry bits in parallel and then only |
| rarely needs to fall through to a loop propagating further carries. |
| |
| On the x86s, GCC (as of version 2.95.2) doesn't generate particularly good code |
| for the RISC style idioms that are necessary to handle carry bits in |
| C@. Often conditional jumps are generated where @code{adc} or @code{sbb} forms |
| would be better. And so unfortunately almost any loop involving carry bits |
| needs to be coded in assembly for best results. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Cache Handling, Assembly Functional Units, Assembly Carry Propagation, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Cache Handling |
| @cindex Assembly cache handling |
| |
| GMP aims to perform well both on operands that fit entirely in L1 cache and |
| those which don't. |
| |
| Basic routines like @code{mpn_add_n} or @code{mpn_lshift} are often used on |
| large operands, so L2 and main memory performance is important for them. |
| @code{mpn_mul_1} and @code{mpn_addmul_1} are mostly used for multiply and |
| square basecases, so L1 performance matters most for them, unless assembly |
| versions of @code{mpn_mul_basecase} and @code{mpn_sqr_basecase} exist, in |
| which case the remaining uses are mostly for larger operands. |
| |
| For L2 or main memory operands, memory access times will almost certainly be |
| more than the calculation time. The aim therefore is to maximize memory |
| throughput, by starting a load of the next cache line while processing the |
| contents of the previous one. Clearly this is only possible if the chip has a |
| lock-up free cache or some sort of prefetch instruction. Most current chips |
| have both these features. |
| |
| Prefetching sources combines well with loop unrolling, since a prefetch can be |
| initiated once per unrolled loop (or more than once if the loop covers more |
| than one cache line). |
| |
| On CPUs without write-allocate caches, prefetching destinations will ensure |
| individual stores don't go further down the cache hierarchy, limiting |
| bandwidth. Of course for calculations which are slow anyway, like |
| @code{mpn_divrem_1}, write-throughs might be fine. |
| |
| The distance ahead to prefetch will be determined by memory latency versus |
| throughput. The aim of course is to have data arriving continuously, at peak |
| throughput. Some CPUs have limits on the number of fetches or prefetches in |
| progress. |
| |
| If a special prefetch instruction doesn't exist then a plain load can be used, |
| but in that case care must be taken not to attempt to read past the end of an |
| operand, since that might produce a segmentation violation. |
| |
| Some CPUs or systems have hardware that detects sequential memory accesses and |
| initiates suitable cache movements automatically, making life easy. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Functional Units, Assembly Floating Point, Assembly Cache Handling, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Functional Units |
| |
| When choosing an approach for an assembly loop, consideration is given to |
| what operations can execute simultaneously and what throughput can thereby be |
| achieved. In some cases an algorithm can be tweaked to accommodate available |
| resources. |
| |
| Loop control will generally require a counter and pointer updates, costing as |
| much as 5 instructions, plus any delays a branch introduces. CPU addressing |
| modes might reduce pointer updates, perhaps by allowing just one updating |
| pointer and others expressed as offsets from it, or on CISC chips with all |
| addressing done with the loop counter as a scaled index. |
| |
| The final loop control cost can be amortised by processing several limbs in |
| each iteration (@pxref{Assembly Loop Unrolling}). This at least ensures loop |
| control isn't a big fraction the work done. |
| |
| Memory throughput is always a limit. If perhaps only one load or one store |
| can be done per cycle then 3 cycles/limb will the top speed for ``binary'' |
| operations like @code{mpn_add_n}, and any code achieving that is optimal. |
| |
| Integer resources can be freed up by having the loop counter in a float |
| register, or by pressing the float units into use for some multiplying, |
| perhaps doing every second limb on the float side (@pxref{Assembly Floating |
| Point}). |
| |
| Float resources can be freed up by doing carry propagation on the integer |
| side, or even by doing integer to float conversions in integers using bit |
| twiddling. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Floating Point, Assembly SIMD Instructions, Assembly Functional Units, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Floating Point |
| @cindex Assembly floating Point |
| |
| Floating point arithmetic is used in GMP for multiplications on CPUs with poor |
| integer multipliers. It's mostly useful for @code{mpn_mul_1}, |
| @code{mpn_addmul_1} and @code{mpn_submul_1} on 64-bit machines, and |
| @code{mpn_mul_basecase} on both 32-bit and 64-bit machines. |
| |
| With IEEE 53-bit double precision floats, integer multiplications producing up |
| to 53 bits will give exact results. Breaking a 64@cross{}64 multiplication |
| into eight 16@cross{}@math{32@rightarrow{}48} bit pieces is convenient. With |
| some care though six 21@cross{}@math{32@rightarrow{}53} bit products can be |
| used, if one of the lower two 21-bit pieces also uses the sign bit. |
| |
| For the @code{mpn_mul_1} family of functions on a 64-bit machine, the |
| invariant single limb is split at the start, into 3 or 4 pieces. Inside the |
| loop, the bignum operand is split into 32-bit pieces. Fast conversion of |
| these unsigned 32-bit pieces to floating point is highly machine-dependent. |
| In some cases, reading the data into the integer unit, zero-extending to |
| 64-bits, then transferring to the floating point unit back via memory is the |
| only option. |
| |
| Converting partial products back to 64-bit limbs is usually best done as a |
| signed conversion. Since all values are smaller than @m{2^{53},2^53}, signed |
| and unsigned are the same, but most processors lack unsigned conversions. |
| |
| @sp 2 |
| |
| Here is a diagram showing 16@cross{}32 bit products for an @code{mpn_mul_1} or |
| @code{mpn_addmul_1} with a 64-bit limb. The single limb operand V is split |
| into four 16-bit parts. The multi-limb operand U is split in the loop into |
| two 32-bit parts. |
| |
| @tex |
| \global\newdimen\GMPbits \global\GMPbits=0.18em |
| \def\GMPbox#1#2#3{% |
| \hbox{% |
| \hbox to 128\GMPbits{\hfil |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox to 48\GMPbits {\GMPvrule \hfil$#2$\hfil \vrule}% |
| \hrule}% |
| \hskip #1\GMPbits}% |
| \raise \GMPboxdepth \hbox{\hskip 2em #3}}} |
| % |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox{% |
| \hbox to 128\GMPbits {\hfil |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox to 64\GMPbits{% |
| \GMPvrule \hfil$v48$\hfil |
| \vrule \hfil$v32$\hfil |
| \vrule \hfil$v16$\hfil |
| \vrule \hfil$v00$\hfil |
| \vrule} |
| \hrule}}% |
| \raise \GMPboxdepth \hbox{\hskip 2em V Operand}} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \hbox{% |
| \hbox to 128\GMPbits {\hfil |
| \raise \GMPboxdepth \hbox{$\times$\hskip 1.5em}% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox to 64\GMPbits {% |
| \GMPvrule \hfil$u32$\hfil |
| \vrule \hfil$u00$\hfil |
| \vrule}% |
| \hrule}}% |
| \raise \GMPboxdepth \hbox{\hskip 2em U Operand (one limb)}}% |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \hbox{\vbox to 2ex{\hrule width 128\GMPbits}}% |
| \GMPbox{0}{u00 \times v00}{$p00$\hskip 1.5em 48-bit products}% |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{16}{u00 \times v16}{$p16$} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{32}{u00 \times v32}{$p32$} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{48}{u00 \times v48}{$p48$} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{32}{u32 \times v00}{$r32$} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{48}{u32 \times v16}{$r48$} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{64}{u32 \times v32}{$r64$} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{80}{u32 \times v48}{$r80$} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| +---+---+---+---+ |
| |v48|v32|v16|v00| V operand |
| +---+---+---+---+ |
| |
| +-------+---+---+ |
| x | u32 | u00 | U operand (one limb) |
| +---------------+ |
| |
| --------------------------------- |
| |
| +-----------+ |
| | u00 x v00 | p00 48-bit products |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u00 x v16 | p16 |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u00 x v32 | p32 |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u00 x v48 | p48 |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u32 x v00 | r32 |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u32 x v16 | r48 |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u32 x v32 | r64 |
| +-----------+ |
| +-----------+ |
| | u32 x v48 | r80 |
| +-----------+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @math{p32} and @math{r32} can be summed using floating-point addition, and |
| likewise @math{p48} and @math{r48}. @math{p00} and @math{p16} can be summed |
| with @math{r64} and @math{r80} from the previous iteration. |
| |
| For each loop then, four 49-bit quantities are transferred to the integer unit, |
| aligned as follows, |
| |
| @tex |
| % GMPbox here should be 49 bits wide, but use 51 to better show p16+r80' |
| % crossing into the upper 64 bits. |
| \def\GMPbox#1#2#3{% |
| \hbox{% |
| \hbox to 128\GMPbits {% |
| \hfil |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox to 51\GMPbits {\GMPvrule \hfil$#2$\hfil \vrule}% |
| \hrule}% |
| \hskip #1\GMPbits}% |
| \raise \GMPboxdepth \hbox{\hskip 1.5em $#3$\hfil}% |
| }} |
| \newbox\b \setbox\b\hbox{64 bits}% |
| \newdimen\bw \bw=\wd\b \advance\bw by 2em |
| \newdimen\x \x=128\GMPbits |
| \advance\x by -2\bw |
| \divide\x by4 |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 128\GMPbits {% |
| \GMPvrule |
| \raise 0.5ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox to \x {}}% |
| \hfil 64 bits\hfil |
| \raise 0.5ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox to \x {}}% |
| \vrule |
| \raise 0.5ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox to \x {}}% |
| \hfil 64 bits\hfil |
| \raise 0.5ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox to \x {}}% |
| \vrule}% |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \GMPbox{0}{p00+r64'}{i00} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{16}{p16+r80'}{i16} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{32}{p32+r32}{i32} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \GMPbox{48}{p48+r48}{i48} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| @group |
| |-----64bits----|-----64bits----| |
| +------------+ |
| | p00 + r64' | i00 |
| +------------+ |
| +------------+ |
| | p16 + r80' | i16 |
| +------------+ |
| +------------+ |
| | p32 + r32 | i32 |
| +------------+ |
| +------------+ |
| | p48 + r48 | i48 |
| +------------+ |
| @end group |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| The challenge then is to sum these efficiently and add in a carry limb, |
| generating a low 64-bit result limb and a high 33-bit carry limb (@math{i48} |
| extends 33 bits into the high half). |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly SIMD Instructions, Assembly Software Pipelining, Assembly Floating Point, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection SIMD Instructions |
| @cindex Assembly SIMD |
| |
| The single-instruction multiple-data support in current microprocessors is |
| aimed at signal processing algorithms where each data point can be treated |
| more or less independently. There's generally not much support for |
| propagating the sort of carries that arise in GMP. |
| |
| SIMD multiplications of say four 16@cross{}16 bit multiplies only do as much |
| work as one 32@cross{}32 from GMP's point of view, and need some shifts and |
| adds besides. But of course if say the SIMD form is fully pipelined and uses |
| less instruction decoding then it may still be worthwhile. |
| |
| On the x86 chips, MMX has so far found a use in @code{mpn_rshift} and |
| @code{mpn_lshift}, and is used in a special case for 16-bit multipliers in the |
| P55 @code{mpn_mul_1}. SSE2 is used for Pentium 4 @code{mpn_mul_1}, |
| @code{mpn_addmul_1}, and @code{mpn_submul_1}. |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Software Pipelining, Assembly Loop Unrolling, Assembly SIMD Instructions, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Software Pipelining |
| @cindex Assembly software pipelining |
| |
| Software pipelining consists of scheduling instructions around the branch |
| point in a loop. For example a loop might issue a load not for use in the |
| present iteration but the next, thereby allowing extra cycles for the data to |
| arrive from memory. |
| |
| Naturally this is wanted only when doing things like loads or multiplies that |
| take several cycles to complete, and only where a CPU has multiple functional |
| units so that other work can be done in the meantime. |
| |
| A pipeline with several stages will have a data value in progress at each |
| stage and each loop iteration moves them along one stage. This is like |
| juggling. |
| |
| If the latency of some instruction is greater than the loop time then it will |
| be necessary to unroll, so one register has a result ready to use while |
| another (or multiple others) are still in progress. (@pxref{Assembly Loop |
| Unrolling}). |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Loop Unrolling, Assembly Writing Guide, Assembly Software Pipelining, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Loop Unrolling |
| @cindex Assembly loop unrolling |
| |
| Loop unrolling consists of replicating code so that several limbs are |
| processed in each loop. At a minimum this reduces loop overheads by a |
| corresponding factor, but it can also allow better register usage, for example |
| alternately using one register combination and then another. Judicious use of |
| @command{m4} macros can help avoid lots of duplication in the source code. |
| |
| Any amount of unrolling can be handled with a loop counter that's decremented |
| by @math{N} each time, stopping when the remaining count is less than the |
| further @math{N} the loop will process. Or by subtracting @math{N} at the |
| start, the termination condition becomes when the counter @math{C} is less |
| than 0 (and the count of remaining limbs is @math{C+N}). |
| |
| Alternately for a power of 2 unroll the loop count and remainder can be |
| established with a shift and mask. This is convenient if also making a |
| computed jump into the middle of a large loop. |
| |
| The limbs not a multiple of the unrolling can be handled in various ways, for |
| example |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| A simple loop at the end (or the start) to process the excess. Care will be |
| wanted that it isn't too much slower than the unrolled part. |
| |
| @item |
| A set of binary tests, for example after an 8-limb unrolling, test for 4 more |
| limbs to process, then a further 2 more or not, and finally 1 more or not. |
| This will probably take more code space than a simple loop. |
| |
| @item |
| A @code{switch} statement, providing separate code for each possible excess, |
| for example an 8-limb unrolling would have separate code for 0 remaining, 1 |
| remaining, etc, up to 7 remaining. This might take a lot of code, but may be |
| the best way to optimize all cases in combination with a deep pipelined loop. |
| |
| @item |
| A computed jump into the middle of the loop, thus making the first iteration |
| handle the excess. This should make times smoothly increase with size, which |
| is attractive, but setups for the jump and adjustments for pointers can be |
| tricky and could become quite difficult in combination with deep pipelining. |
| @end itemize |
| |
| |
| @node Assembly Writing Guide, , Assembly Loop Unrolling, Assembly Coding |
| @subsection Writing Guide |
| @cindex Assembly writing guide |
| |
| This is a guide to writing software pipelined loops for processing limb |
| vectors in assembly. |
| |
| First determine the algorithm and which instructions are needed. Code it |
| without unrolling or scheduling, to make sure it works. On a 3-operand CPU |
| try to write each new value to a new register, this will greatly simplify later |
| steps. |
| |
| Then note for each instruction the functional unit and/or issue port |
| requirements. If an instruction can use either of two units, like U0 or U1 |
| then make a category ``U0/U1''. Count the total using each unit (or combined |
| unit), and count all instructions. |
| |
| Figure out from those counts the best possible loop time. The goal will be to |
| find a perfect schedule where instruction latencies are completely hidden. |
| The total instruction count might be the limiting factor, or perhaps a |
| particular functional unit. It might be possible to tweak the instructions to |
| help the limiting factor. |
| |
| Suppose the loop time is @math{N}, then make @math{N} issue buckets, with the |
| final loop branch at the end of the last. Now fill the buckets with dummy |
| instructions using the functional units desired. Run this to make sure the |
| intended speed is reached. |
| |
| Now replace the dummy instructions with the real instructions from the slow |
| but correct loop you started with. The first will typically be a load |
| instruction. Then the instruction using that value is placed in a bucket an |
| appropriate distance down. Run the loop again, to check it still runs at |
| target speed. |
| |
| Keep placing instructions, frequently measuring the loop. After a few you |
| will need to wrap around from the last bucket back to the top of the loop. If |
| you used the new-register for new-value strategy above then there will be no |
| register conflicts. If not then take care not to clobber something already in |
| use. Changing registers at this time is very error prone. |
| |
| The loop will overlap two or more of the original loop iterations, and the |
| computation of one vector element result will be started in one iteration of |
| the new loop, and completed one or several iterations later. |
| |
| The final step is to create feed-in and wind-down code for the loop. A good |
| way to do this is to make a copy (or copies) of the loop at the start and |
| delete those instructions which don't have valid antecedents, and at the end |
| replicate and delete those whose results are unwanted (including any further |
| loads). |
| |
| The loop will have a minimum number of limbs loaded and processed, so the |
| feed-in code must test if the request size is smaller and skip either to a |
| suitable part of the wind-down or to special code for small sizes. |
| |
| |
| @node Internals, Contributors, Algorithms, Top |
| @chapter Internals |
| @cindex Internals |
| |
| @strong{This chapter is provided only for informational purposes and the |
| various internals described here may change in future GMP releases. |
| Applications expecting to be compatible with future releases should use only |
| the documented interfaces described in previous chapters.} |
| |
| @menu |
| * Integer Internals:: |
| * Rational Internals:: |
| * Float Internals:: |
| * Raw Output Internals:: |
| * C++ Interface Internals:: |
| @end menu |
| |
| @node Integer Internals, Rational Internals, Internals, Internals |
| @section Integer Internals |
| @cindex Integer internals |
| |
| @code{mpz_t} variables represent integers using sign and magnitude, in space |
| dynamically allocated and reallocated. The fields are as follows. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @code{_mp_size} |
| The number of limbs, or the negative of that when representing a negative |
| integer. Zero is represented by @code{_mp_size} set to zero, in which case |
| the @code{_mp_d} data is undefined. |
| |
| @item @code{_mp_d} |
| A pointer to an array of limbs which is the magnitude. These are stored |
| ``little endian'' as per the @code{mpn} functions, so @code{_mp_d[0]} is the |
| least significant limb and @code{_mp_d[ABS(_mp_size)-1]} is the most |
| significant. Whenever @code{_mp_size} is non-zero, the most significant limb |
| is non-zero. |
| |
| Currently there's always at least one readable limb, so for instance |
| @code{mpz_get_ui} can fetch @code{_mp_d[0]} unconditionally (though its value |
| is undefined if @code{_mp_size} is zero). |
| |
| @item @code{_mp_alloc} |
| @code{_mp_alloc} is the number of limbs currently allocated at @code{_mp_d}, |
| and normally @code{_mp_alloc >= ABS(_mp_size)}. When an @code{mpz} routine |
| is about to (or might be about to) increase @code{_mp_size}, it checks |
| @code{_mp_alloc} to see whether there's enough space, and reallocates if not. |
| @code{MPZ_REALLOC} is generally used for this. |
| |
| @code{mpz_t} variables initialised with the @code{mpz_roinit_n} function or |
| the @code{MPZ_ROINIT_N} macro have @code{_mp_alloc = 0} but can have a |
| non-zero @code{_mp_size}. They can only be used as read-only constants. See |
| @ref{Integer Special Functions} for details. |
| @end table |
| |
| The various bitwise logical functions like @code{mpz_and} behave as if |
| negative values were twos complement. But sign and magnitude is always used |
| internally, and necessary adjustments are made during the calculations. |
| Sometimes this isn't pretty, but sign and magnitude are best for other |
| routines. |
| |
| Some internal temporary variables are setup with @code{MPZ_TMP_INIT} and these |
| have @code{_mp_d} space obtained from @code{TMP_ALLOC} rather than the memory |
| allocation functions. Care is taken to ensure that these are big enough that |
| no reallocation is necessary (since it would have unpredictable consequences). |
| |
| @code{_mp_size} and @code{_mp_alloc} are @code{int}, although @code{mp_size_t} |
| is usually a @code{long}. This is done to make the fields just 32 bits on |
| some 64 bits systems, thereby saving a few bytes of data space but still |
| providing plenty of range. |
| |
| |
| @node Rational Internals, Float Internals, Integer Internals, Internals |
| @section Rational Internals |
| @cindex Rational internals |
| |
| @code{mpq_t} variables represent rationals using an @code{mpz_t} numerator and |
| denominator (@pxref{Integer Internals}). |
| |
| The canonical form adopted is denominator positive (and non-zero), no common |
| factors between numerator and denominator, and zero uniquely represented as |
| 0/1. |
| |
| It's believed that casting out common factors at each stage of a calculation |
| is best in general. A GCD is an @math{O(N^2)} operation so it's better to do |
| a few small ones immediately than to delay and have to do a big one later. |
| Knowing the numerator and denominator have no common factors can be used for |
| example in @code{mpq_mul} to make only two cross GCDs necessary, not four. |
| |
| This general approach to common factors is badly sub-optimal in the presence |
| of simple factorizations or little prospect for cancellation, but GMP has no |
| way to know when this will occur. As per @ref{Efficiency}, that's left to |
| applications. The @code{mpq_t} framework might still suit, with |
| @code{mpq_numref} and @code{mpq_denref} for direct access to the numerator and |
| denominator, or of course @code{mpz_t} variables can be used directly. |
| |
| |
| @node Float Internals, Raw Output Internals, Rational Internals, Internals |
| @section Float Internals |
| @cindex Float internals |
| |
| Efficient calculation is the primary aim of GMP floats and the use of whole |
| limbs and simple rounding facilitates this. |
| |
| @code{mpf_t} floats have a variable precision mantissa and a single machine |
| word signed exponent. The mantissa is represented using sign and magnitude. |
| |
| @c FIXME: The arrow heads don't join to the lines exactly. |
| @tex |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxwidth \GMPboxwidth=5em |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxheight \GMPboxheight=3ex |
| \def\centreline{\hbox{\raise 0.8ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox{\hfil}}}} |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \hbox to 5\GMPboxwidth {most significant limb \hfil least significant limb} |
| \vskip 0.7ex |
| \def\GMPcentreline#1{\hbox{\raise 0.5 ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox to #1 {}}}} |
| \hbox { |
| \hbox to 3\GMPboxwidth {% |
| \setbox 0 = \hbox{@code{\_mp\_exp}}% |
| \dimen0=3\GMPboxwidth |
| \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 |
| \divide\dimen0 by 2 |
| \advance\dimen0 by -1em |
| \setbox1 = \hbox{$\rightarrow$}% |
| \dimen1=\dimen0 |
| \advance\dimen1 by -\wd1 |
| \GMPcentreline{\dimen0}% |
| \hfil |
| \box0% |
| \hfil |
| \GMPcentreline{\dimen1{}}% |
| \box1} |
| \hbox to 2\GMPboxwidth {\hfil @code{\_mp\_d}}} |
| \vskip 0.5ex |
| \vbox {% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox{% |
| \vrule height 2ex depth 1ex |
| \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {}% |
| \vrule |
| \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {}% |
| \vrule |
| \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {}% |
| \vrule |
| \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {}% |
| \vrule |
| \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {}% |
| \vrule} |
| \hrule |
| } |
| \hbox {% |
| \hbox to 0.8 pt {} |
| \hbox to 3\GMPboxwidth {% |
| \hfil $\cdot$} \hbox {$\leftarrow$ radix point\hfil}} |
| \hbox to 5\GMPboxwidth{% |
| \setbox 0 = \hbox{@code{\_mp\_size}}% |
| \dimen0 = 5\GMPboxwidth |
| \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 |
| \divide\dimen0 by 2 |
| \advance\dimen0 by -1em |
| \dimen1 = \dimen0 |
| \setbox1 = \hbox{$\leftarrow$}% |
| \setbox2 = \hbox{$\rightarrow$}% |
| \advance\dimen0 by -\wd1 |
| \advance\dimen1 by -\wd2 |
| \hbox to 0.3 em {}% |
| \box1 |
| \GMPcentreline{\dimen0}% |
| \hfil |
| \box0 |
| \hfil |
| \GMPcentreline{\dimen1}% |
| \box2} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| most least |
| significant significant |
| limb limb |
| |
| _mp_d |
| |---- _mp_exp ---> | |
| _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ |
| |_____|_____|_____|_____|_____| |
| . <------------ radix point |
| |
| <-------- _mp_size ---------> |
| @sp 1 |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| @noindent |
| The fields are as follows. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item @code{_mp_size} |
| The number of limbs currently in use, or the negative of that when |
| representing a negative value. Zero is represented by @code{_mp_size} and |
| @code{_mp_exp} both set to zero, and in that case the @code{_mp_d} data is |
| unused. (In the future @code{_mp_exp} might be undefined when representing |
| zero.) |
| |
| @item @code{_mp_prec} |
| The precision of the mantissa, in limbs. In any calculation the aim is to |
| produce @code{_mp_prec} limbs of result (the most significant being non-zero). |
| |
| @item @code{_mp_d} |
| A pointer to the array of limbs which is the absolute value of the mantissa. |
| These are stored ``little endian'' as per the @code{mpn} functions, so |
| @code{_mp_d[0]} is the least significant limb and |
| @code{_mp_d[ABS(_mp_size)-1]} the most significant. |
| |
| The most significant limb is always non-zero, but there are no other |
| restrictions on its value, in particular the highest 1 bit can be anywhere |
| within the limb. |
| |
| @code{_mp_prec+1} limbs are allocated to @code{_mp_d}, the extra limb being |
| for convenience (see below). There are no reallocations during a calculation, |
| only in a change of precision with @code{mpf_set_prec}. |
| |
| @item @code{_mp_exp} |
| The exponent, in limbs, determining the location of the implied radix point. |
| Zero means the radix point is just above the most significant limb. Positive |
| values mean a radix point offset towards the lower limbs and hence a value |
| @math{@ge{} 1}, as for example in the diagram above. Negative exponents mean |
| a radix point further above the highest limb. |
| |
| Naturally the exponent can be any value, it doesn't have to fall within the |
| limbs as the diagram shows, it can be a long way above or a long way below. |
| Limbs other than those included in the @code{@{_mp_d,_mp_size@}} data |
| are treated as zero. |
| @end table |
| |
| The @code{_mp_size} and @code{_mp_prec} fields are @code{int}, although the |
| @code{mp_size_t} type is usually a @code{long}. The @code{_mp_exp} field is |
| usually @code{long}. This is done to make some fields just 32 bits on some 64 |
| bits systems, thereby saving a few bytes of data space but still providing |
| plenty of precision and a very large range. |
| |
| |
| @sp 1 |
| @noindent |
| The following various points should be noted. |
| |
| @table @asis |
| @item Low Zeros |
| The least significant limbs @code{_mp_d[0]} etc can be zero, though such low |
| zeros can always be ignored. Routines likely to produce low zeros check and |
| avoid them to save time in subsequent calculations, but for most routines |
| they're quite unlikely and aren't checked. |
| |
| @item Mantissa Size Range |
| The @code{_mp_size} count of limbs in use can be less than @code{_mp_prec} if |
| the value can be represented in less. This means low precision values or |
| small integers stored in a high precision @code{mpf_t} can still be operated |
| on efficiently. |
| |
| @code{_mp_size} can also be greater than @code{_mp_prec}. Firstly a value is |
| allowed to use all of the @code{_mp_prec+1} limbs available at @code{_mp_d}, |
| and secondly when @code{mpf_set_prec_raw} lowers @code{_mp_prec} it leaves |
| @code{_mp_size} unchanged and so the size can be arbitrarily bigger than |
| @code{_mp_prec}. |
| |
| @item Rounding |
| All rounding is done on limb boundaries. Calculating @code{_mp_prec} limbs |
| with the high non-zero will ensure the application requested minimum precision |
| is obtained. |
| |
| The use of simple ``trunc'' rounding towards zero is efficient, since there's |
| no need to examine extra limbs and increment or decrement. |
| |
| @item Bit Shifts |
| Since the exponent is in limbs, there are no bit shifts in basic operations |
| like @code{mpf_add} and @code{mpf_mul}. When differing exponents are |
| encountered all that's needed is to adjust pointers to line up the relevant |
| limbs. |
| |
| Of course @code{mpf_mul_2exp} and @code{mpf_div_2exp} will require bit shifts, |
| but the choice is between an exponent in limbs which requires shifts there, or |
| one in bits which requires them almost everywhere else. |
| |
| @item Use of @code{_mp_prec+1} Limbs |
| The extra limb on @code{_mp_d} (@code{_mp_prec+1} rather than just |
| @code{_mp_prec}) helps when an @code{mpf} routine might get a carry from its |
| operation. @code{mpf_add} for instance will do an @code{mpn_add} of |
| @code{_mp_prec} limbs. If there's no carry then that's the result, but if |
| there is a carry then it's stored in the extra limb of space and |
| @code{_mp_size} becomes @code{_mp_prec+1}. |
| |
| Whenever @code{_mp_prec+1} limbs are held in a variable, the low limb is not |
| needed for the intended precision, only the @code{_mp_prec} high limbs. But |
| zeroing it out or moving the rest down is unnecessary. Subsequent routines |
| reading the value will simply take the high limbs they need, and this will be |
| @code{_mp_prec} if their target has that same precision. This is no more than |
| a pointer adjustment, and must be checked anyway since the destination |
| precision can be different from the sources. |
| |
| Copy functions like @code{mpf_set} will retain a full @code{_mp_prec+1} limbs |
| if available. This ensures that a variable which has @code{_mp_size} equal to |
| @code{_mp_prec+1} will get its full exact value copied. Strictly speaking |
| this is unnecessary since only @code{_mp_prec} limbs are needed for the |
| application's requested precision, but it's considered that an @code{mpf_set} |
| from one variable into another of the same precision ought to produce an exact |
| copy. |
| |
| @item Application Precisions |
| @code{__GMPF_BITS_TO_PREC} converts an application requested precision to an |
| @code{_mp_prec}. The value in bits is rounded up to a whole limb then an |
| extra limb is added since the most significant limb of @code{_mp_d} is only |
| non-zero and therefore might contain only one bit. |
| |
| @code{__GMPF_PREC_TO_BITS} does the reverse conversion, and removes the extra |
| limb from @code{_mp_prec} before converting to bits. The net effect of |
| reading back with @code{mpf_get_prec} is simply the precision rounded up to a |
| multiple of @code{mp_bits_per_limb}. |
| |
| Note that the extra limb added here for the high only being non-zero is in |
| addition to the extra limb allocated to @code{_mp_d}. For example with a |
| 32-bit limb, an application request for 250 bits will be rounded up to 8 |
| limbs, then an extra added for the high being only non-zero, giving an |
| @code{_mp_prec} of 9. @code{_mp_d} then gets 10 limbs allocated. Reading |
| back with @code{mpf_get_prec} will take @code{_mp_prec} subtract 1 limb and |
| multiply by 32, giving 256 bits. |
| |
| Strictly speaking, the fact the high limb has at least one bit means that a |
| float with, say, 3 limbs of 32-bits each will be holding at least 65 bits, but |
| for the purposes of @code{mpf_t} it's considered simply to be 64 bits, a nice |
| multiple of the limb size. |
| @end table |
| |
| |
| @node Raw Output Internals, C++ Interface Internals, Float Internals, Internals |
| @section Raw Output Internals |
| @cindex Raw output internals |
| |
| @noindent |
| @code{mpz_out_raw} uses the following format. |
| |
| @tex |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxwidth \GMPboxwidth=5em |
| \global\newdimen\GMPboxheight \GMPboxheight=3ex |
| \def\centreline{\hbox{\raise 0.8ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox{\hfil}}}} |
| \GMPdisplay{% |
| \vbox{% |
| \def\GMPcentreline#1{\hbox{\raise 0.5 ex \vbox{\hrule \hbox to #1 {}}}} |
| \vbox {% |
| \hrule |
| \hbox{% |
| \vrule height 2.5ex depth 1.5ex |
| \hbox to \GMPboxwidth {\hfil size\hfil}% |
| \vrule |
| \hbox to 3\GMPboxwidth {\hfil data bytes\hfil}% |
| \vrule} |
| \hrule} |
| }} |
| @end tex |
| @ifnottex |
| @example |
| +------+------------------------+ |
| | size | data bytes | |
| +------+------------------------+ |
| @end example |
| @end ifnottex |
| |
| The size is 4 bytes written most significant byte first, being the number of |
| subsequent data bytes, or the twos complement negative of that when a negative |
| integer is represented. The data bytes are the absolute value of the integer, |
| written most significant byte first. |
| |
| The most significant data byte is always non-zero, so the output is the same |
| on all systems, irrespective of limb size. |
| |
| In GMP 1, leading zero bytes were written to pad the data bytes to a multiple |
| of the limb size. @code{mpz_inp_raw} will still accept this, for |
| compatibility. |
| |
| The use of ``big endian'' for both the size and data fields is deliberate, it |
| makes the data easy to read in a hex dump of a file. Unfortunately it also |
| means that the limb data must be reversed when reading or writing, so neither |
| a big endian nor little endian system can just read and write @code{_mp_d}. |
| |
| |
| @node C++ Interface Internals, , Raw Output Internals, Internals |
| @section C++ Interface Internals |
| @cindex C++ interface internals |
| |
| A system of expression templates is used to ensure something like @code{a=b+c} |
| turns into a simple call to @code{mpz_add} etc. For @code{mpf_class} |
| the scheme also ensures the precision of the final |
| destination is used for any temporaries within a statement like |
| @code{f=w*x+y*z}. These are important features which a naive implementation |
| cannot provide. |
| |
| A simplified description of the scheme follows. The true scheme is |
| complicated by the fact that expressions have different return types. For |
| detailed information, refer to the source code. |
| |
| To perform an operation, say, addition, we first define a ``function object'' |
| evaluating it, |
| |
| @example |
| struct __gmp_binary_plus |
| @{ |
| static void eval(mpf_t f, const mpf_t g, const mpf_t h) |
| @{ |
| mpf_add(f, g, h); |
| @} |
| @}; |
| @end example |
| |
| @noindent |
| And an ``additive expression'' object, |
| |
| @example |
| __gmp_expr<__gmp_binary_expr<mpf_class, mpf_class, __gmp_binary_plus> > |
| operator+(const mpf_class &f, const mpf_class &g) |
| @{ |
| return __gmp_expr |
| <__gmp_binary_expr<mpf_class, mpf_class, __gmp_binary_plus> >(f, g); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| The seemingly redundant @code{__gmp_expr<__gmp_binary_expr<@dots{}>>} is used to |
| encapsulate any possible kind of expression into a single template type. In |
| fact even @code{mpf_class} etc are @code{typedef} specializations of |
| @code{__gmp_expr}. |
| |
| Next we define assignment of @code{__gmp_expr} to @code{mpf_class}. |
| |
| @example |
| template <class T> |
| mpf_class & mpf_class::operator=(const __gmp_expr<T> &expr) |
| @{ |
| expr.eval(this->get_mpf_t(), this->precision()); |
| return *this; |
| @} |
| |
| template <class Op> |
| void __gmp_expr<__gmp_binary_expr<mpf_class, mpf_class, Op> >::eval |
| (mpf_t f, mp_bitcnt_t precision) |
| @{ |
| Op::eval(f, expr.val1.get_mpf_t(), expr.val2.get_mpf_t()); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| where @code{expr.val1} and @code{expr.val2} are references to the expression's |
| operands (here @code{expr} is the @code{__gmp_binary_expr} stored within the |
| @code{__gmp_expr}). |
| |
| This way, the expression is actually evaluated only at the time of assignment, |
| when the required precision (that of @code{f}) is known. Furthermore the |
| target @code{mpf_t} is now available, thus we can call @code{mpf_add} directly |
| with @code{f} as the output argument. |
| |
| Compound expressions are handled by defining operators taking subexpressions |
| as their arguments, like this: |
| |
| @example |
| template <class T, class U> |
| __gmp_expr |
| <__gmp_binary_expr<__gmp_expr<T>, __gmp_expr<U>, __gmp_binary_plus> > |
| operator+(const __gmp_expr<T> &expr1, const __gmp_expr<U> &expr2) |
| @{ |
| return __gmp_expr |
| <__gmp_binary_expr<__gmp_expr<T>, __gmp_expr<U>, __gmp_binary_plus> > |
| (expr1, expr2); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| And the corresponding specializations of @code{__gmp_expr::eval}: |
| |
| @example |
| template <class T, class U, class Op> |
| void __gmp_expr |
| <__gmp_binary_expr<__gmp_expr<T>, __gmp_expr<U>, Op> >::eval |
| (mpf_t f, mp_bitcnt_t precision) |
| @{ |
| // declare two temporaries |
| mpf_class temp1(expr.val1, precision), temp2(expr.val2, precision); |
| Op::eval(f, temp1.get_mpf_t(), temp2.get_mpf_t()); |
| @} |
| @end example |
| |
| The expression is thus recursively evaluated to any level of complexity and |
| all subexpressions are evaluated to the precision of @code{f}. |
| |
| |
| @node Contributors, References, Internals, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @appendix Contributors |
| @cindex Contributors |
| |
| Torbj@"orn Granlund wrote the original GMP library and is still the main |
| developer. Code not explicitly attributed to others, was contributed by |
| Torbj@"orn. Several other individuals and organizations have contributed |
| GMP. Here is a list in chronological order on first contribution: |
| |
| Gunnar Sj@"odin and Hans Riesel helped with mathematical problems in early |
| versions of the library. |
| |
| Richard Stallman helped with the interface design and revised the first |
| version of this manual. |
| |
| Brian Beuning and Doug Lea helped with testing of early versions of the |
| library and made creative suggestions. |
| |
| John Amanatides of York University in Canada contributed the function |
| @code{mpz_probab_prime_p}. |
| |
| Paul Zimmermann wrote the REDC-based mpz_powm code, the Sch@"onhage-Strassen |
| FFT multiply code, and the Karatsuba square root code. He also improved the |
| Toom3 code for GMP 4.2. Paul sparked the development of GMP 2, with his |
| comparisons between bignum packages. The ECMNET project Paul is organizing |
| was a driving force behind many of the optimizations in GMP 3. Paul also |
| wrote the new GMP 4.3 nth root code (with Torbj@"orn). |
| |
| Ken Weber (Kent State University, Universidade Federal do Rio Grande do Sul) |
| contributed now defunct versions of @code{mpz_gcd}, @code{mpz_divexact}, |
| @code{mpn_gcd}, and @code{mpn_bdivmod}, partially supported by CNPq (Brazil) |
| grant 301314194-2. |
| |
| Per Bothner of Cygnus Support helped to set up GMP to use Cygnus' configure. |
| He has also made valuable suggestions and tested numerous intermediary |
| releases. |
| |
| Joachim Hollman was involved in the design of the @code{mpf} interface, and in |
| the @code{mpz} design revisions for version 2. |
| |
| Bennet Yee contributed the initial versions of @code{mpz_jacobi} and |
| @code{mpz_legendre}. |
| |
| Andreas Schwab contributed the files @file{mpn/m68k/lshift.S} and |
| @file{mpn/m68k/rshift.S} (now in @file{.asm} form). |
| |
| Robert Harley of Inria, France and David Seal of ARM, England, suggested clever |
| improvements for population count. Robert also wrote highly optimized |
| Karatsuba and 3-way Toom multiplication functions for GMP 3, and contributed |
| the ARM assembly code. |
| |
| Torsten Ekedahl of the Mathematical department of Stockholm University provided |
| significant inspiration during several phases of the GMP development. His |
| mathematical expertise helped improve several algorithms. |
| |
| Linus Nordberg wrote the new configure system based on autoconf and |
| implemented the new random functions. |
| |
| Kevin Ryde worked on a large number of things: optimized x86 code, m4 asm |
| macros, parameter tuning, speed measuring, the configure system, function |
| inlining, divisibility tests, bit scanning, Jacobi symbols, Fibonacci and Lucas |
| number functions, printf and scanf functions, perl interface, demo expression |
| parser, the algorithms chapter in the manual, @file{gmpasm-mode.el}, and |
| various miscellaneous improvements elsewhere. |
| |
| Kent Boortz made the Mac OS 9 port. |
| |
| Steve Root helped write the optimized alpha 21264 assembly code. |
| |
| Gerardo Ballabio wrote the @file{gmpxx.h} C++ class interface and the C++ |
| @code{istream} input routines. |
| |
| Jason Moxham rewrote @code{mpz_fac_ui}. |
| |
| Pedro Gimeno implemented the Mersenne Twister and made other random number |
| improvements. |
| |
| Niels M@"oller wrote the sub-quadratic GCD, extended GCD and jacobi code, the |
| quadratic Hensel division code, and (with Torbj@"orn) the new divide and |
| conquer division code for GMP 4.3. Niels also helped implement the new Toom |
| multiply code for GMP 4.3 and implemented helper functions to simplify Toom |
| evaluations for GMP 5.0. He wrote the original version of mpn_mulmod_bnm1, and |
| he is the main author of the mini-gmp package used for gmp bootstrapping. |
| |
| Alberto Zanoni and Marco Bodrato suggested the unbalanced multiply strategy, |
| and found the optimal strategies for evaluation and interpolation in Toom |
| multiplication. |
| |
| Marco Bodrato helped implement the new Toom multiply code for GMP 4.3 and |
| implemented most of the new Toom multiply and squaring code for 5.0. |
| He is the main author of the current mpn_mulmod_bnm1, mpn_mullo_n, and |
| mpn_sqrlo. Marco also wrote the functions mpn_invert and mpn_invertappr, |
| and improved the speed of integer root extraction. He is the author of |
| mini-mpq, an additional layer to mini-gmp; of most of the combinatorial |
| functions and the BPSW primality testing implementation, for both the |
| main library and the mini-gmp package. |
| |
| David Harvey suggested the internal function @code{mpn_bdiv_dbm1}, implementing |
| division relevant to Toom multiplication. He also worked on fast assembly |
| sequences, in particular on a fast AMD64 @code{mpn_mul_basecase}. He wrote |
| the internal middle product functions @code{mpn_mulmid_basecase}, |
| @code{mpn_toom42_mulmid}, @code{mpn_mulmid_n} and related helper routines. |
| |
| Martin Boij wrote @code{mpn_perfect_power_p}. |
| |
| Marc Glisse improved @file{gmpxx.h}: use fewer temporaries (faster), |
| specializations of @code{numeric_limits} and @code{common_type}, C++11 |
| features (move constructors, explicit bool conversion, UDL), make the |
| conversion from @code{mpq_class} to @code{mpz_class} explicit, optimize |
| operations where one argument is a small compile-time constant, replace |
| some heap allocations by stack allocations. He also fixed the eofbit |
| handling of C++ streams, and removed one division from @file{mpq/aors.c}. |
| |
| David S Miller wrote assembly code for SPARC T3 and T4. |
| |
| Mark Sofroniou cleaned up the types of mul_fft.c, letting it work for huge |
| operands. |
| |
| Ulrich Weigand ported GMP to the powerpc64le ABI. |
| |
| (This list is chronological, not ordered after significance. If you have |
| contributed to GMP but are not listed above, please tell |
| @email{gmp-devel@@gmplib.org} about the omission!) |
| |
| The development of floating point functions of GNU MP 2, were supported in part |
| by the ESPRIT-BRA (Basic Research Activities) 6846 project POSSO (POlynomial |
| System SOlving). |
| |
| The development of GMP 2, 3, and 4.0 was supported in part by the IDA Center |
| for Computing Sciences. |
| |
| The development of GMP 4.3, 5.0, and 5.1 was supported in part by the Swedish |
| Foundation for Strategic Research. |
| |
| Thanks go to Hans Thorsen for donating an SGI system for the GMP test system |
| environment. |
| |
| @node References, GNU Free Documentation License, Contributors, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @appendix References |
| @cindex References |
| |
| @c FIXME: In tex, the @uref's are unhyphenated, which is good for clarity, |
| @c but being long words they upset paragraph formatting (the preceding line |
| @c can get badly stretched). Would like an conditional @* style line break |
| @c if the uref is too long to fit on the last line of the paragraph, but it's |
| @c not clear how to do that. For now explicit @texlinebreak{}s are used on |
| @c paragraphs that come out bad. |
| |
| @section Books |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Jonathan M. Borwein and Peter B. Borwein, ``Pi and the AGM: A Study in |
| Analytic Number Theory and Computational Complexity'', Wiley, 1998. |
| |
| @item |
| Richard Crandall and Carl Pomerance, ``Prime Numbers: A Computational |
| Perspective'', 2nd edition, Springer-Verlag, 2005. |
| @texlinebreak{} @uref{https://www.math.dartmouth.edu/~carlp/} |
| |
| @item |
| Henri Cohen, ``A Course in Computational Algebraic Number Theory'', Graduate |
| Texts in Mathematics number 138, Springer-Verlag, 1993. |
| @texlinebreak{} @uref{https://www.math.u-bordeaux.fr/~cohen/} |
| |
| @item |
| Donald E. Knuth, ``The Art of Computer Programming'', volume 2, |
| ``Seminumerical Algorithms'', 3rd edition, Addison-Wesley, 1998. |
| @texlinebreak{} @uref{https://www-cs-faculty.stanford.edu/~knuth/taocp.html} |
| |
| @item |
| John D. Lipson, ``Elements of Algebra and Algebraic Computing'', |
| The Benjamin Cummings Publishing Company Inc, 1981. |
| |
| @item |
| Alfred J. Menezes, Paul C. van Oorschot and Scott A. Vanstone, ``Handbook of |
| Applied Cryptography'', @uref{http://www.cacr.math.uwaterloo.ca/hac/} |
| |
| @item |
| Richard M. Stallman and the GCC Developer Community, ``Using the GNU Compiler |
| Collection'', Free Software Foundation, 2008, available online |
| @uref{https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/}, and in the GCC package |
| @uref{https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/gcc/} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @section Papers |
| |
| @itemize @bullet |
| @item |
| Yves Bertot, Nicolas Magaud and Paul Zimmermann, ``A Proof of GMP Square |
| Root'', Journal of Automated Reasoning, volume 29, 2002, pp.@: 225-252. Also |
| available online as INRIA Research Report 4475, June 2002, |
| @uref{https://hal.inria.fr/docs/00/07/21/13/PDF/RR-4475.pdf} |
| |
| @item |
| Christoph Burnikel and Joachim Ziegler, ``Fast Recursive Division'', |
| Max-Planck-Institut fuer Informatik Research Report MPI-I-98-1-022, |
| @texlinebreak{} @uref{https://www.mpi-inf.mpg.de/~ziegler/TechRep.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Torbj@"orn Granlund and Peter L. Montgomery, ``Division by Invariant Integers |
| using Multiplication'', in Proceedings of the SIGPLAN PLDI'94 Conference, June |
| 1994. Also available @uref{https://gmplib.org/~tege/divcnst-pldi94.pdf}. |
| |
| @item |
| Niels M@"oller and Torbj@"orn Granlund, ``Improved division by invariant |
| integers'', IEEE Transactions on Computers, 11 June 2010. |
| @uref{https://gmplib.org/~tege/division-paper.pdf} |
| |
| @item |
| Torbj@"orn Granlund and Niels M@"oller, ``Division of integers large and |
| small'', to appear. |
| |
| @item |
| Tudor Jebelean, |
| ``An algorithm for exact division'', |
| Journal of Symbolic Computation, |
| volume 15, 1993, pp.@: 169-180. |
| Research report version available @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{ftp://ftp.risc.uni-linz.ac.at/pub/techreports/1992/92-35.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Tudor Jebelean, ``Exact Division with Karatsuba Complexity - Extended |
| Abstract'', RISC-Linz technical report 96-31, @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{ftp://ftp.risc.uni-linz.ac.at/pub/techreports/1996/96-31.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Tudor Jebelean, ``Practical Integer Division with Karatsuba Complexity'', |
| ISSAC 97, pp.@: 339-341. Technical report available @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{ftp://ftp.risc.uni-linz.ac.at/pub/techreports/1996/96-29.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Tudor Jebelean, ``A Generalization of the Binary GCD Algorithm'', ISSAC 93, |
| pp.@: 111-116. Technical report version available @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{ftp://ftp.risc.uni-linz.ac.at/pub/techreports/1993/93-01.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Tudor Jebelean, ``A Double-Digit Lehmer-Euclid Algorithm for Finding the GCD |
| of Long Integers'', Journal of Symbolic Computation, volume 19, 1995, |
| pp.@: 145-157. Technical report version also available @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{ftp://ftp.risc.uni-linz.ac.at/pub/techreports/1992/92-69.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Werner Krandick and Tudor Jebelean, ``Bidirectional Exact Integer Division'', |
| Journal of Symbolic Computation, volume 21, 1996, pp.@: 441-455. Early |
| technical report version also available |
| @uref{ftp://ftp.risc.uni-linz.ac.at/pub/techreports/1994/94-50.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Makoto Matsumoto and Takuji Nishimura, ``Mersenne Twister: A 623-dimensionally |
| equidistributed uniform pseudorandom number generator'', ACM Transactions on |
| Modelling and Computer Simulation, volume 8, January 1998, pp.@: 3-30. |
| Available online @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{http://www.math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp/~m-mat/MT/ARTICLES/mt.pdf} |
| |
| @item |
| R. Moenck and A. Borodin, ``Fast Modular Transforms via Division'', |
| Proceedings of the 13th Annual IEEE Symposium on Switching and Automata |
| Theory, October 1972, pp.@: 90-96. Reprinted as ``Fast Modular Transforms'', |
| Journal of Computer and System Sciences, volume 8, number 3, June 1974, |
| pp.@: 366-386. |
| |
| @item |
| Niels M@"oller, ``On Sch@"onhage's algorithm and subquadratic integer GCD |
| computation'', in Mathematics of Computation, volume 77, January 2008, pp.@: |
| 589-607, @uref{https://www.ams.org/journals/mcom/2008-77-261/S0025-5718-07-02017-0/home.html} |
| |
| @item |
| Peter L. Montgomery, ``Modular Multiplication Without Trial Division'', in |
| Mathematics of Computation, volume 44, number 170, April 1985. |
| |
| @item |
| Arnold Sch@"onhage and Volker Strassen, ``Schnelle Multiplikation grosser |
| Zahlen'', Computing 7, 1971, pp.@: 281-292. |
| |
| @item |
| Kenneth Weber, ``The accelerated integer GCD algorithm'', |
| ACM Transactions on Mathematical Software, |
| volume 21, number 1, March 1995, pp.@: 111-122. |
| |
| @item |
| Paul Zimmermann, ``Karatsuba Square Root'', INRIA Research Report 3805, |
| November 1999, @uref{https://hal.inria.fr/inria-00072854/PDF/RR-3805.pdf} |
| |
| @item |
| Paul Zimmermann, ``A Proof of GMP Fast Division and Square Root |
| Implementations'', @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{https://homepages.loria.fr/PZimmermann/papers/proof-div-sqrt.ps.gz} |
| |
| @item |
| Dan Zuras, ``On Squaring and Multiplying Large Integers'', ARITH-11: IEEE |
| Symposium on Computer Arithmetic, 1993, pp.@: 260 to 271. Reprinted as ``More |
| on Multiplying and Squaring Large Integers'', IEEE Transactions on Computers, |
| volume 43, number 8, August 1994, pp.@: 899-908. |
| |
| @item |
| Niels M@"oller, ``Efficient computation of the Jacobi symbol'', @texlinebreak{} |
| @uref{https://arxiv.org/abs/1907.07795} |
| @end itemize |
| |
| @node GNU Free Documentation License, Concept Index, References, Top |
| @appendix GNU Free Documentation License |
| @cindex GNU Free Documentation License |
| @cindex Free Documentation License |
| @cindex Documentation license |
| @include fdl-1.3.texi |
| |
| |
| @node Concept Index, Function Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @unnumbered Concept Index |
| @printindex cp |
| |
| @node Function Index, , Concept Index, Top |
| @comment node-name, next, previous, up |
| @unnumbered Function and Type Index |
| @printindex fn |
| |
| @bye |
| |
| @c Local variables: |
| @c fill-column: 78 |
| @c compile-command: "make gmp.info" |
| @c End: |